Cost Accounting Vol II PDF
Cost Accounting Vol II PDF
Cost Accounting Vol II PDF
INTEGRATED
PROFESSIONAL
COMPETENCE COURSE
Vol. II
PAPER
BOARD OF STUDIES
THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA
This study material has been prepared by the faculty of the Board of Studies. The
objective of the study material is to provide teaching material to the students to enable
them to obtain knowledge and skills in the subject. Students should also supplement their
study by reference to the recommended text books. In case students need any
clarifications or have any suggestions to make for further improvement of the material
contained herein, they may write to the Director of Studies.
All care has been taken to provide interpretations and discussions in a manner useful for
the students. However, the study material has not been specifically discussed by the
Council of the Institute or any of its Committees and the views expressed herein may not
be taken to necessarily represent the views of the Council or any of its Committees.
Permission of the Institute is essential for reproduction of any portion of this material.
THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA
All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced, stored in retrieval system, or
transmitted, in any form, or by any means, Electronic, Mechanical, photocopying, recording, or
otherwise, without prior permission in writing from the publisher.
Website
www.icai.org
bosnoida@icai.org
ISBN No.
978-81-8441-302-1
Published by
Printed by
FOREWORD
The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India, the second largest professional accountancy body
in the world, occupies a pivotal position in the Indian economy. As compared to other leading
professional accountancy bodies in the world, the Institute enjoys a unique position since it is
endowed with the authority not only to conduct examinations and grant license to qualified
members but it also imparts theoretical education through diverse methods such as provision of
study material, conducting revisionary classes, etc. In fact, the Institute is a pioneer in imparting
the education to students through distance education mode since its inception in 1949. Keeping in
view the fact that the students of chartered accountancy course are dispersed geographically in the
entire world, it is imminent that the Institute must make all efforts to retain its primacy in this
particular area.
While all out efforts are being made to leverage the technology for the benefit of students through
e-learning, Shiksha Portal, etc. by the Institute, it must continue to serve students through
comprehensive study material with the aim to inculcate the self-learning experience. In this
direction, I am happy to note that the study material has been thoroughly revised and made user
friendly by improving presentation, emphasis on significant issues, illustrations explaining the
concept step by step, etc. The inclusion of practical case studies intends to make it more
application-oriented and aims to enhance the knowledge of students in the practical environment.
A separate Practice Manual shall also enable the students to practice the subject on their own. It
is hoped that the revised study material would prove to be very useful for students and their
reliance on other external sources shall go down considerably. I am confident that the provision of
such education literature shall enable our potential chartered accountants to compete with the best
in the world.
PREFACE
With the fast changing business dynamics, fierce competition, globalization, complicated laws
and transactions, there is tremendous pressure on the Chartered Accountancy students to
acquire knowledge not only to clear examinations but also to build strong foundation for future
endeavours. To strengthen knowledge of students and further build confidence for examination,
the Board of Studies has developed the new study material. The new study material is
comprehensive enough so that the students dispersed not only within the country but in other parts
of the world as well can learn, understand and assimilate the subject through self-learning process.
With this avid objective, the study material has been divided in two volumes namely Volume I
dealing with the conceptual theoretical framework in detail and Volume II comprising of practice
manual. The main features of Volume I are as under:
The entire syllabus has been divided into ten chapters.
In each chapter, learning objectives have been stated.
In each chapter, the topic has been covered in a step by step approach.
A question bank has been included after each chapter in Volume I as well as many questions
for practice in Volume II.
Volume II of the Study Material comprises the Practice Manual. Main features of Volume II are as under:
Volume II comprising of practice manual Compilation of questions appearing during last
twenty examinations.
Important Definition, equation and formulae have been given before each topic for quick
recapitulation. Students are expected to attempt the questions and then compare it with the
actual answers.
Exercises have been given at the end of each topic for independent practice.
Aims to provide guidance as to the manner of writing an answer in the examination.
Matrix of the past examinations which will help the students in getting an idea about the trend
of questions being asked and relative weightage of each topics.
The Cost Accounting portion has ten chapters (Thirteen in Practice Manual) having an in
depth analysis of concepts relating to Material, Labour, Overheads and other important costing
techniques. Standard Costing, Marginal Costing and Budgeting have been included in the
syllabus at an introductory level.
We acknowledge the contributions made by CA. Parveen Kumar of M/s ASA Associates, Delhi
and his team including CA. Prateel Mittal, CA. Akriti Gomber and CA. Babita Rana towards the
improvement of the study material.
The concerned faculty member of Board of Studies Dr. N N Sengupta and Ms. Anu have put
their best efforts in making this study material lucid and student-friendly.
30th January, 2010
New Delhi
The study material has been divided into two parts, namely, Volume I dealing with conceptual
theoretical framework; and Volume II comprising of practice manual. The Study Material has been
designed having regard to the needs of home study and distance learning students in mind. The
students are expected to cover the entire syllabus and also do practice on their own while going
through the practice manual.
Volume I of the study material deals with the conceptual theoretical framework in detail. The main
features of Volume I are as under:
In each chapter, learning objectives have been stated. The learning objectives would enable
you to understand the sequence of various aspects dealt within the chapter before going into
the details so that you know the direction of your studies.
In each chapter, the topic has been covered in a step by step approach. The text has been
explained, where appropriate, through illustrations and practical problems. You should go
through the chapter carefully ensuring that you understand the topic and then can tackle the
exercises.
A question bank has been included after each chapter in Volume I as well as many questions
for practice in Volume II.
Volume II of the Study Material comprises the Practice Manual. Main features of Volume II are
as under:
Important Definition, equation and formulae have been given before each topic for quick
recapitulation. Students are expected to attempt the questions and then compare it with the
actual answers.
Exercises have been given at the end of each topic for independent practice.
Passing exams is partly a matter of intellectual ability, but however accomplished you are in that
respect you can improve your chances significantly by the use of appropriate study and revision
techniques. In this section we briefly outline some tips for effective study during the earlier stages.
Material Costing
Labour Costing
Overhead Costing
Non-Integrated Accounts
Method of Costing I (Job Costing, Contract Costing, Batch Costing and Operating
Costing)
Method of Costing II (Process Costing, Operation Costing and Joint Products & ByProducts)
Standard Costing
Marginal Costing
Make a study plan covering the entire syllabus and then decide how much time you can
allocate to the subject on daily/weekly basis.
Allocation of time must be done keeping in view your office commitments as well as social
needs and personal hobbies.
Maintain the time balance amongst various subjects such as purely descriptive type and
numerical-based papers. Allocate time in such a manner that your interest is well sustained
and you are able to score well in the final examination as well.
Always assess your preparation periodically, say, on monthly basis. If necessary, revise your
plan and allocate more time for the subject in which you feel deficient.
First of all, have an overview of the chapter to understand the broad contents and sequence of
various sub-topics.
Do the introspection while going through the chapter and ask various questions to yourself.
Read each chapter slowly to ensure that you understand and assimilate the main concept. If
need be, read once again with concentration and then try to attempt exercise at the end of the
chapter or given in the Practice Manual.
Recapitulate the main concept after going through each chapter by way of brief notes.
Prepare notes in the manner you feel comfortable covering all key points. Use mnemonic form
e.g. C V P denoting cost, valuation and price.
One may use highlighter/underlining the significant points or writing down in the margin.
The fact that how well you have understood the topic is your ability to attempt the questions
given in the exercises as well as in the practice manual. Make a serious attempt at producing
your own answers but at this stage do not be much concern about attempting the questions in
examination based conditions. In particular, at initial stages, it is more important to understand
and absorb the material thoroughly rather than to observe the time limits that would apply in
the actual examination conditions.
Always try to attempt the past year examination question paper under examination conditions.
Revision of material should never be selective in any case. Because broad coverage of the
syllabus is more important than preparing 2-3 chapters exhaustively.
Read through the text along with notes carefully. Try to remember the definition and important
formulae.
Examination Technique
Plan your time so that equal time is awarded for each mark. Keep sometime for revision as
well.
Always attempt to do all questions. Remember that six average answers fetch more marks
than five best answers. Therefore, it is important that you must finish each question within
allocated time.
Read the question carefully more than once before starting the answer to understand very
clearly as to what is required by the paper-setter.
Always be concise and write to the point and do not try to fill pages unnecessarily.
In case a question is not clear, you may state your assumptions and then answer the question.
While writing answers in respect of essay-type questions, try to make sub-readings so that it
catches the examiners eye. In case of case-study, be very precise and write your conclusion
in a clear manner.
Reference to standards, guidance notes, section of various legislation, etc be done in a clearcut manner.
Revise your answers carefully underline important points before leaving the examination hall.
Topics(Example)
Q.1
(3)
Q.25
(5)
Q.3
(3)
Chapter-4 Overheads
Chapter-5 Non-Integrated
Accounts
Chapter-3 Labour
Q.2
(4)
Q.3
(3)
Q.15
(3)
Q.16
(5)
Q.17
(6)
Q.34
(12)
Q.11)
(2)
May
1999
Chapter-2 Materials
Chapter
Q.6
(4)
Q.8
(4)
Q.19
(4)
Q.21
(6)
Q.6
(4)
Q.18
(4)
Q.24
(5)
Q.26
(4)
Q.27
(8)
Nov.
1999
Q.7
(5)
Q.13
(4)
Q.5
(4)
Q.13
(8)
Q.26
(4)
Q.4
(4)
Q.5
(2)
Q.6
(3)
Q.18
(4)
Q.19
(4)
Q.8
(4)
Q.9
(4)
May
2000
Q.8
(6)
Q.7
(4)
Q.20
(6)
Q.35
(8)
Q.12
(4)
Q.28
(2)
Nov.
2000
Q.6
(8)
Q.23
(4)
Q.27
(5)
Q.25
(4)
Q.19
(4)
Q.1
(5)
Q.8
(3)
Q.14
(8)
May
2001
Q.10
(2)
Q.11
(2)
Q.1
(4)
Q.9
(10)
Q.5
(2)
Q.10
(4)
Q.28
(3)
Q.32
(2)
Q.30
(8)
Q.9
(4)
Q.31
(10)
Nov.
2001
Q.9
(2)
Q.2
(4)
Q.12
(10)
Q.12
(4)
Q.22
(8)
Q.7
(4)
Q.29
(8)
Q.10
(2)
Q.32
(8)
May
2002
Q.1
(3)
Q.3
(4)
Q.11
(3)
Q.15
(3)
Q.16
(9)
Q.17
(9)
Q.15
(10)
Q.13
(8)
Q.7
(2)
Nov.
2002
Q.7
(5)
Q.24
(2)
Q.22
(9)
Q.26
(6)
Nov.
2002
Q.13
(8)
Q.18
(8)
Q.4
(3)
Q.23
(5)
Q.29
(2)
Q.30
(3)
May
2003
Q.2
(4)
Q.15
(2)
Q.10
(10)
Q.3
(4)
Q.4
(3)
Q.14
(10)
Q.3
(3)
Q.17
(8)
Q.22
(6)
Q.25
(4)
Nov.
2003
Q.4
(5)
Q.2
(4)
Q.28
(14)
Q.21
(8)
Q.21
(9)
May
2004
Q.5
(2)
Q.8
(4)
Q.11
(8)
Q.1
(3)
Q.2
(3)
Q.5
(3)
Q.6
(3)
Q.20
(3)
Q.27
(8)
Q.20
(6)
Q.23
(4)
Q.24
(2)
Nov.
2004
Q.14
(8)
Q.11
(4)
May
2005
Q.4
(4)
Q.15
(8)
Q.13
(4)
Nov.
2005
Q16
(8)
Q.33
(2)
Q.34
(14)
May
2006
Q.14
(4)
Q.31
(4)
Q.33
(4)
Q.12
(8)
Nov.
2006
Q.16
(4)
Q.17
(10)
Q.20
(3)
Q.34
(2)
Q.35
(15)
Q.39
(2)
Q.36
(4)
Q.41
(2)
Q.42
(3)
May
2007
Q.16 (i)
(ii)
(2)
Q.18
(2)
Q.19
(3)
Q.20
(2)
Q.35
(8)
Q.36
(2)
Q.37
(2)
Q.41
(3)
Q.29
(10)
Q.36
(2)
Q.37
(8)
Q.38
(2)
Q.18
(4)
Q.21
(3)
Q.37
(6)
Q.38
(4)
Q.43
(3)
Q.38
(5)
Q.39
(4)
Q.43
(3)
Q.47
(2)
Nov.
2007
Q.16
(2)
Q.21
(2)
Q.22
(2)
Q.19
(10)
Q.30
(10)
Q.44
(2)
Q.44
(8)
Q.45
(3)
May
2008
Q.23
(2)
Q.31
(6)
Q.32
(8)
Q.33
(6)
Q.40
(2)
Q.1
(3)
Q.22
(15)
Q.10
(3)
Q.40
(4)
Q.46
(8)
Q.40
(7)
Q.46
(2)
Nov.
2008
Q.17
(2)
Q.24
(2)
Q.6
(8)
Q.1
(10)
Q.3
(12)
Q.7
(8)
Q.1
(10)
Q.6
(4)
Q.8
(8)
Q.3
(6)
Q.4
(4)
Q.2
(12)
Q.6
(14)
Q.10
(8)
Q.3
(3)
Q.8
(4)
Q.2
(8)
Q.1
(2)
Q.2
(2)
Q.1
(3)
Q.5
(3)
Q.7
(10)
Q.9
(8)
Q.4
(10)
Q.8
(8)
Q.5
(12)
Q.3
(2)
Q.2
(2)
Q.5
(5)
Q.9
(6)
Q.4
(10)
Q.4
(4)
Q.3
(10)
Q.1
(13)
Q.5
(8)
Q.2
(2)
Q.4
(14)
Q.5
(8)
Q.11
(10)
Q.2
(2)
Q.12
(2)
Q.13
(4)
Q.16
(8)
Q.6
(10)
Q.7
(10)
Q.7
(10)
Q.10
(3)
Q.7
(8)
Q.1
(2)
Q.2
(15)
Q.1
(3)
Q.8
(10)
Q.11
(8)
Q.10
(3)
Q.9
(2)
Q.14
(6)
Q.17
(2)
Q.2
(3)
Q.3
(3)
Q.2
(15)
Q.3
(15)
Q.12
(8)
Q.6
(8)
Q.4
(8)
Q.5
(3)
Q.1
(2)
Q.4
(3)
Q.9
(12)
Q.13
(3)
Q.15
(3)
Q.19
(2)
Q.20
(3)
Q.8
(8)
COST ACCOUNTING
CHAPTER 1 BASIC CONCEPTS .................................................................... 1.1 1.18
CHAPTER 2 MATERIAL ................................................................................. 2.1 2.61
CHAPTER 3 LABOUR .................................................................................... 3.1 3.58
CHAPTER 4 OVERHEADS ............................................................................. 4.1 4.78
CHAPTER 5 NON INTEGRATED ACCOUNTS ................................................ 5.1 5.58
CHAPTER 6 METHOD OF COSTING (I)............................................................ 6.1 6.8
CHAPTER 7 METHOD OF COSTING (II) ........................................................ 7.1 7.38
CHAPTER 8 OPERATING COSTING .............................................................. 8.1 8.26
CHAPTER 9 PROCESS & OPERATION COSTING.......................................... 9.1 9.38
CHAPTER 10 JOINT PRODUCTS & BY PRODUCTS .................................. 10.1 10.37
CHAPTER 11 STANDARD COSTING.......................................................... 11.1 11.14
CHAPTER 12 MARGINAL COSTING ......................................................... 12.1 12.10
CHAPTER 13 BUDGETS AND BUDGETARY CONTROL .............................. 13.1 13.7
CHAPTER 1
BASIC CONCEPTS
BASIC CONCEPTS OF FORMULAE
BASIC CONCEPTS
Classification of Costs
1. Nature of Element
1.1
1.2
1.3
2. Traceability to Object
2.1
2.2
3. Functions
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
4. Variability
4.1
4.2
Cost Accounting
4.3
Semi- Variable Costs: Costs which are partly fixed and partly variable
5. Controllability
5.1
5.2
6. Normality
6.1
6.2
Abnormal Costs: Costs which are over and above normal costs
7. Decision Making
7.1
7.2
8. Cash Outflow
8.1
8.2
Types of Costing
1.
2.
Marginal Costing: Only Variable Costs or costs directly linked are charged to
the product or process
3.
4.
5.
Direct Costing: Direct Costs are charged to the product or process, Indirect
Costs are charged to the profit from the product or process.
6.
Absorption Costing:
product or process
Methods of Costing
1.
Job costing; Where all costs can be directly charged to a specific job
2.
Batch Costing: Where all costs can be directly charged to a group of products
1.2
Basic Concepts
(batch)
3.
Contract Costing: Similar to Job costing, but in this case the job is larger than
job costing.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Question 1
Enumerate the main objectives of introduction of a Cost Accounting System in a
manufacturing organisation
Answer
The main objectives of introduction of a Cost Accounting System in a manufacturing
organization are as follows:
(i)
Ascertainment of cost
Answer
(i)
Conversion cost:
It is the cost incurred to convert raw materials into finished goods. It is the sum of direct
wages, direct expenses and manufacturing overheads.
Cost Accounting
example, in the case of a decision relating to the replacement of a machine, the written
down value of the existing machine is a sunk cost, and therefore, not considered.
(iii) Opportunity cost:
It refers to the value of sacrifice made or benefit of opportunity foregone in accepting an
alternative course of action. For example, a firm financing its expansion plan by
withdrawing money from its bank deposits. In such a case the loss of interest on the bank
deposit is the opportunity cost for carrying out the expansion plan.
Question 3
What is meant by cost centre?
Answer
Cost Centre
It is the smallest area of responsibility or segment of activity for which costs are accumulated.
It can be defined as a location; person or an item of equipment or a group of these for which
costs are ascertained and used for the purpose of cost control. Cost centres are of two types
viz.., personal and impersonal.
Personal cost centre: It is a cost centre which consists of a person or a group of persons.
Impersonal cost centre: It is a cost centre which consists of a location or an item of equipment
or a group of these.
In a manufacturing concern there are two types of cost centres viz., production and service
cost centres.
Question 4
Discuss cost classification based on variability and controllability.
Answer
Cost classification based on variability
Fixed cost These are costs, which do not change in total despite changes of a cost driver. A
fixed cost is fixed only in relation to a given relevant range of the cost driver and a given time
span. Rent, insurance, depreciation of factory building and equipment are examples of fixed
costs where the final product produced is the cost object.
Variable costs These are costs which change in total in proportion to changes of cost driver.
Direct material, direct labour are examples of variable costs, in cases where the final product
produced is the cost object.
1.4
Basic Concepts
Semi-variable costs These are partly fixed and partly variable in relation to output e.g.
telephone and electricity bill.
Cost classification based on controllability
Controllable costs Are incurred in a particular responsibility center and relate to a defined
time span. They can be influenced by the action of the executive heading the responsibility
center e.g. direct costs.
Uncontrollable costs Are costs are influenced by the action of the responsibility center
manager e.g. expenditure incurred by the tool room are controllable by the foreman in charge
of that section, but the share of tool room expenditure which are apportioned to the machine
shop are not controllable by machine shop foreman.
Question 5
Discuss the essential of a good cost accounting system?
Answer
Essentials of a good cost accounting system:
It should be tailor-made, practical, simple and capable of meeting the requirements of a
business concern.
The data used by the system should be accurate, otherwise it may distort the output of
system.
Cost of installing & operating the system should justify the results.
Cost accounting system should have the support of top management of the concern.
The system should have the necessary support from all the users departments.
Question 6
Explain:
(i)
Sunk Costs
Sunk Costs: These are historical costs which are incurred in the past. These costs were
incurred for a decision made in the past and cannot be changed by any decision that will
1.5
Cost Accounting
be made in future. In other words, these costs plays no role in decision making, in the
current period. While considering the replacement of a plant, the depreciated book value
of the old plant is irrelevant, as the amount is a sunk cost which is to be written off at the
time of replacement.
(ii) Pre-production Costs: These costs forms the part of development cost, incurred in
making a trial production run, preliminary to formal production. These costs are incurred
when a new factory is in the process of establishment or a new project is undertaken or a
new product line or product is taken up, but there is no established or formal production
to which such costs may be charged. These costs are normally treated as deferred
revenue expenditure (except the portion which has been capitalised) and charged to the
costs of future production.
(iii) Research and Development Costs: Research costs are the costs incurred for the
discovery of new ideas or processes by experiment or otherwise and for using the results
of such experimentation on a commercial basis. Research costs are defined as the costs
of searching for new or improved products, new applications of materials, or improved
methods, processes, systems or services.
Development costs, are the costs of the process which begins with the implementation of
the decision to produce a new or improved product or to employ a new or improved
method and ends with the commencement of formal production of that product by that
method.
(iv) Training Costs: These costs comprises of wages and salaries of the trainees or
learners, pay and allowances of the training and teaching staff, payment of fees etc, for
training or for attending courses of studies sponsored by outside agencies and cost of
materials, tools and equipments used for training. Costs incurred for running the training
department, the losses arising due to the initial lower production, extra spoilage etc.
occuring while providing training facilities to the new recruits.
All these costs are booked under separate standing order numbers for the various
functions. Usually there is a service cost centre, known as the Training Section, to which
all the training costs are allocated. The total cost of training section is thereafter
apportioned to production centers.
Question 7
Enumerate the factors which are to be considered before installing a system of cost
accounting in a manufacturing organization.
1.6
Basic Concepts
Answer
Factors which are to be considered before installing a system of cost accounting in a
manufacturing organization are:
(i)
(ii) The organization of the company should be studied to understand the authority and
responsibilities of the managers.
(iii) The technical aspects and flow process should be taken into consideration.
(iv) The products to be manufactured should be studied.
(v) The marketing set up to be looked into for devising suitable control reports.
(vi) The possibility of integrating cost accounting system with financial accounting system
should be examined.
(vii) The procedure for collection and verification of reliability of the information should be
studied.
(viii) The degree of details of information required at each level of management should be
examined.
(ix) The maximum amount of information that would be sufficient and how the same should
be secured without too much clerical labour, especially the possibility of collection of data
on a separate printed form designed for each process; also the possibility of instruction
as regards filling up of the forms in writing to ensure that these would be faithfully carried
out.
(x) How the accuracy of the data collected can be verified? Who should be made
responsible for making such verification with regard to each operation and the form of
certification that should be given indicate verification that he has carried out.
(xi) The manner in which the benefits of introducing Cost Accounting could be explained to
various persons in the concern, specially those incharge of production department and
an awareness created for the necessity of promptitude, frequency and regularity in
collection of costing data.
Question 8
You have been asked to install a costing system in a manufacturing company. What practical
difficulties will you expect and how will you propose to overcome the same?
1.7
Cost Accounting
Answer
The practical difficulties with which a Cost Accountant is usually confronted with while
installing a costing system in a manufacturing company are as follows:
(i)
Lack of top management support: Installation of a costing system do not receive the
support of top management. They consider it as an interference in their work. They
believe that such, a system will involve additional paperwork. They also have a
misconcept in their minds that the system is meant for keeping a check on their activities.
(ii) Resistance from cost accounting departmental staff: The staff resists because of fear of
loosing their jobs and importance after the implementation of the new system.
(iii) Non cooperation from user departments: The foremen, supervisor and other staff
members may not cooperate in providing requisite data, as this would not only add to
their responsibilities but will also increase paper work of the entire team as well.
(iv) Shortage of trained staff: Since cost accounting systems installation involves specialised
work, there may be a shortage of trained staff.
To overcome these practical difficulties, necessary steps required are:
To sell the idea to top management To convince them of the utility of the system.
Resistance and non cooperation can be overcome by behavioral approach. To deal with
the staff concerned effectively.
Proper training should be given to the staff at each level
Regular meetings should be held with the cost accounting staff, user departments, staff
and top management to clarify their doubts / misgivings.
Question 9
Distinguish between controllable & uncontrollable costs?
Answer
Controllable costs and Uncontrollable costs:
Controllable costs are the costs which can be influenced by the action of a specified member
of the undertaking. Controllable costs incurred in a particular responsibility centre can be
influenced by the action of the executive heading that responsibility centre.
Uncontrollable costs are the costs which cannot be influenced by the action of a specified
member of an undertaking.
Question 10
Define Explicit costs. How is it different from implicit costs?
1.8
Basic Concepts
Answer
Explicit costs: These costs are also known as out of pocket costs. They refer to those costs
which involves immediate payment of cash. Salaries, wages, postage and telegram, interest
on loan etc. are some examples of explicit costs because they involve immediate cash
payment. These payments are recorded in the books of account and can be easily measured.
Main points of difference: The following are the main points of difference between explicit and
implicit costs.
(i)
Implicit costs do not involve any immediate cash payment. As such they are also known
as imputed costs or economic costs.
(ii) Implicit costs are not recorded in the books of account but yet, they are important for
certain types of managerial decisions such as equipment replacement and relative
profitability of two alternative courses of action.
Question 11
What are the main objectives of Cost Accounting?
Answer
The main objectives of Cost Accounting are as follows:
(i)
Ascertainment of cost.
1.9
Cost Accounting
Non-controllable costs: These are the costs which cannot be influenced by the action of a
specified member of an undertaking. For example, expenditure incurred by the Tool Room is
controllable by the Tool Room Manager but the share of Tool Room expenditure, which is
apportioned to the Machine Shop cannot be controlled by the manager of the Machine Shop.
However, the distinction between controllable and non-controllable costs is not very sharp and
is sometimes left to individual judgment to specify a cost as controllable or non-controllable in
relation to a particular individual manager.
Question 13
Discuss the four different methods of costing alongwith their applicability to concerned
industry?
Answer
Four different methods of costing along with their applicability to concerned industry have
been discussed as below:
1.
Job Costing: The objective under this method of costing is to ascertain the cost of each
job order. A job card is prepared for each job to accumulate costs. The cost of the job is
determined by adding all costs against the job it is incurred. This method of costing is
used in printing press, foundries and general engineering workshops, advertising etc.
2.
Batch Costing: This system of costing is used where small components/parts of the same
kind are required to be manufactured in large quantities. Here batch of similar products is
treated as a job and cost of such a job is ascertained as discussed under 1, above. If in a
cycle manufacturing unit, rims are produced in batches of 2,500 units each, then the cost
will be determined in relation to a batch of 2,500 units.
3.
Contract Costing: If a job is very big and takes a long time for its completion, then
method used for costing is known as Contract Costing. Here the cost of each contract is
ascertained separately. It is suitable for firms engaged in the construction of bridges,
roads, buildings etc.
4.
Question 14
Distinguish between:
Marginal Costing and Differential Costing
1.10
Basic Concepts
Answer
Marginal Costing and Differential Costing
Marginal Costing is defined as the Ascertainment of marginal costs and of the effect on profit
of changes in volume or type of output by differentiating between fixed costs and variable
costs.
Differential Costing is defined as the technique of costing which uses differential costs and/or
differential revenues for ascertaining the acceptability of an alternative. The technique may be
termed as incremental costing when the difference is increase in costs and decremental
costing when the difference is decrease in costs. The main points of distinction between
marginal costing and differential costing are as below:
(a) The technique of marginal costing requires a clear distinction between variable costs and
fixed costs whereas no such distinction is made in the case of differential costing.
(b) In marginal costing, margin of contribution and contribution ratio are the main yard sticks
for performance evaluation and for decision making whereas under differential costs
analysis, differential costs are compared with the incremental or decremental revenue (as
the case may be) for arriving at a decision.
(c) Differential cost analysis is possible in both absorption costing and marginal costing,
where as marginal costing in itself is a distinct technique.
(d) Marginal cost may be incorporated in the cost accounting system whereas differential
costs are worked out separately.
Question 15
Distinguish between Controllable and Uncontrollable costs.
Answer
Controllable costs and Uncontrollable costs: Direct costs comprising of direct labour, direct
material, direct expenses and some of the overheads are generally controllable by shop floor
management.
Uncontrollable costs are those costs which cannot be influenced by the action of a specified
member of an undertaking e.g. share to tool room expenditure which is apportioned to
machine shop is not to be controlled by the machine shop foreman.
Question 16
Answer any the following:
(i)
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
1.12
Basic Concepts
Question 19
What items are generally included in good uniform costing manual?
Answer
Uniform costing manual includes essential informations and instructions to implement
accounting procedures.
(a) Introduction: It includes objects and scope of the planning.
(b) Accounting procedure and planning includes rules, and general principle to be followed.
(c) Cost accounting planning includes methods of costing, relation between cost and
financial accounts and methods of integration.
Question 20
Explain in brief the explicit cost with examples.
Answer
Out of pocket cost, involving immediate payment of Cash. Salaries, Wages, Postage and
Telegram, Printing and Stationery, Interest on Loan are some examples of Explicit Costs.
Question 21
Discuss briefly the relevant costs with examples.
Answer
Relevant costs are those expected future cost which are essential but differ for alternative
course or action.
(a) Historical cost or sunk costs are irrelevant as they do not play any role in the decision
making process.
(b) Variable costs which will not differ under various alternatives are irrelevant.
Question 22
What are the main objectives of cost accounting?
Answer
The Main objectives of Cost Accounting are
1.
Ascertainment of cost.
2.
3.
4.
1.13
Cost Accounting
5.
6.
Question 23
Explain controllable and non-controllable cost with examples.
Answer
Controllable costs are those which can be influenced by the action of a specified member of
an undertaking. A business organization is usually divided into a number of responsibility
centres and each such centre is headed by an executive. Controllable costs incurred in a
particular responsibility centre can be influenced by the action of the executive heading that
responsibility centre. Direct costs comprising direct labour, direct materials, direct expenses
and some of the overhead are generally controllable by the shop level management.
Non-controllable costs are those which cannot be influenced by the action of a specified
member of an undertaking. For example, expenditure incurred by the tool room is controllable
by the tool room manager but the share of the tool room expense which is apportioned to the
machine shop cannot be controlled by the machine shop manager. It is only in relation to a
particular individual that a cost may be specified as controllable or not.
Note: 1. A supervisor may be unable to control the amount of managerial remuneration
allocated to his department but for the top management this would be a controllable
cost.
2. Depreciation would be a non-controllable cost in the short-term but controllable in
the long terms.
Question 24
State the unit of cost for the following industries
(a) Transport
(b) Power
(c) Hotel
(d) Hospital
Answer
Industry
Unit of Cost
(a) Transport
(b) Power
(c) Hotel
(d) Hospital
1.14
Basic Concepts
EXERCISE
Question 1
SV Ltd. Is a manufacturing company which has a sound system of financial accounting. The
management of the company therefore feels that there is no need for the installation of a cost
accounting system. Prepare a report to the management bringing out the distinction between
cost and financial accounting system and the need for the introduction of a sound cost
accounting system.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 1 i.e. Basic Concepts of Study Material.
Question 2
(a) Define the terms cost centre and cost unit.
(b) Given below is a list of ten industries. Give the method of costing and the unit of cost
against each industry.
(i)
Nursing Home
1.15
Cost Accounting
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 1 i.e. Basic Concepts of Study Material.
Question 4
(a) Match the following
(i) Total fixed cost
2. Incurred cost
4. Cost of conversion
(ii)
(iii)
Variable cost per unit varies with the increase or decrease in the volume of output.
(iv)
(v)
An item of cost that is direct for one business may be indirect for another
(vi)
1.16
Basic Concepts
Question 7
Distinguish between the following?
Controllable costs and uncontrollable costs.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 1 i.e. Basic Concepts of Study Material.
Question 8
(a) Describe briefly the role of the cost accountant in a manufacturing organisation.
(b) Distinguish between:
(i)
(ii) Bi-cycle
1.17
Cost Accounting
(b) Narrate the essential factors to be considered while designing and installing a Cost
Accounting System.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 1 i.e. Basic Concepts of Study Material.
Question 14
Specify the methods of costing and cost units applicable to the following industries:
(i)
Toy making
(ii) Cement
(iii) Radio
(iv) Bicycle
(v) Ship building
(vi) Hospital
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 1 i.e. Basic Concepts of Study Material.
1.18
CHAPTER 2
MATERIALS
BASIC CONCEPTS AND FORMULAE
Basic Concepts
1.
2.
Minimum Level: It indicates the lowest figure of inventory balance, which must be
maintained in hand at all times, so that there is no stoppage of production due to
non-availability of inventory.
3.
Re-order level: This level lies between minimum and the maximum levels in such a
way that before the material ordered is received into the stores, there is sufficient
quantity on hand to cover both normal and abnormal consumption situations.
4.
Danger level: It is the level at which normal issues of the raw material inventory are
stopped and emergency issues are only made.
5.
6.
Two bin system: Under this system each bin is divided into two parts - one, smaller
part, should stock the quantity equal to the minimum stock or even the re-ordering
level, and the other to keep the remaining quantity. Issues are made out of the
larger part; but as soon as it becomes necessary to use quantity out of the smaller
part of the bin, fresh order is placed.
7.
System of budgets: The exact quantity of various types of inventories and the time
when they would be required can be known by studying carefully production plans
and production schedules. Based on this, inventories requirement budget can be
prepared. Such a budget will discourage the unnecessary investment in inventories.
8.
Cost Accounting
9.
10.
Economic Order Quantity (EOQ): It is the calculation of optimum level quantity which
minimizes the total cost of Ordering and Delivery Cost and Carrying Cost.
11.
Review of slow and non-moving items: Disposing of as early as possible slow moving
items, in return with items needed for production to avoid unnecessary blockage of
resources.
12.
Input output ratio : Inventory control can also be exercised by the use of input
output ratio analysis. Input-output ratio is the ratio of the quantity of input of
material to production and the standard material content of the actual output.
13.
14.
Valuation of Material Issues: Several methods of pricing material issues have been
evolved which are as follows:
a)
First-in First-out method: The materials received first are to be issued first when
material requisition is received. Materials left as closing stock will be at the price of
latest purchases.
b)
Last-in First-out method: The materials purchased last are to be issued first
when material requisition is received. Closing stock is valued at the oldest stock
price.
c)
d)
Weighted Average Price Method: This method gives due weightage to quantities
purchased and the purchase price to determine the issue price.
Weighted Average Price = Total Cost of Materials received
Total Quantity purchased
15.
2.2
Materials
c)
d)
Defectives: Goods which can be rectified and turned out as good units by the
application of additional labour or other services.
Basic Formulas
1.
Maximum Level
2.
Minimum Level
3.
Reorder Level
5.
Danger Level
6.
EOQ =
7.
Ordering Cost
8.
Carrying Cost
Quantity ordered
Purchase Price for Inventory Carrying
2
Material Consumed
Average Inventory
2.3
Cost Accounting
11. To decide whether discount on purchase of material should be availed or not, compare
total inventory cost before discount and after discount. Total inventory cost will include
ordering cost, carrying cost and purchase cost.
12. Safety Stock
Annual Demand
(Max. lead time Normal / Average lead time)
365
13. Total Inventory Cost = Ordering Cost + Carrying Cost + Purchase Cost
Note: For calculation of total inventory carrying cost, average inventory should betaken as
half of EOQ. Average inventory cost is normally given as a percentage of cost per unit
Question 1
How are normal and abnormal loss of material arising during storage treated in Cost Accounts?
Answer
Cost Accounts treatment of normal and abnormal loss of material arising during storage.
The difference between the book balance and actual physical stock, which may either be gain or
loss, should be transferred to Inventory Adjustment Account pending scrutiny to ascertain the
reason for the difference.
If on scrutiny, the difference arrived at is considered as normal, then such a difference should be
transferred to overhead control account and if abnormal, it should be debited to costing profit and
loss account.
In the case of normal losses, an alternative method may be used. Under this method the price of
the material issued to production may be inflated so as to cover the normal loss.
Question 2
Distinguish clearly Bincards and Sores Ledger
Answer
Both bin cards and stores ledger are perpetual inventory records. None of them is a substitute for
the other. These two records may be distinguished from the following points of view:
(i)
Bin card is maintained by the store keeper, while the stores ledger is maintained by the cost
accounting department.
(ii)
Bin card is the stores recording document whereas the stores ledger is an accounting record.
(iii) Bin card contains information with regard to quantities i.e. their receipt, issue and balance
while the stores ledger contains both quantitative and value information in respect of their
receipts, issue and balance.
2.4
Materials
(iv) In the bin card entries are made at the time when transaction takes place. But in the stores
ledger entries are made only after the transaction has taken place.
(v)
(vi) Bin cards record each transaction but stores ledger records the same information in a
summarized form.
Question 3
What is Just in Time (JIT) purchases? What are the advantages of such purchases?
Answer
Just in time (JIT) purchases means the purchase of goods or materials such that delivery
immediately precedes their use.
Advantages of JIT purchases:
Main advantages of JIT purchases are as follows:
1.
The suppliers of goods or materials cooperates with the company and supply requisite
quantity of goods or materials for which order is placed before the start of production.
2.
JIT purchases results in cost savings for example, the costs of stock out, inventory carrying,
materials handling and breakage are reduced.
3.
Due to frequent purchases of raw materials, its issue price is likely to be very close to the
replacement price. Consequently the method of pricing to be followed for valuing material
issues becomes less important for companies using JIT purchasing.
4.
JIT purchasing are now attempting to extend daily deliveries to as many areas as possible so
that the goods spend less time in warehouses or on store shelves before they are exhausted.
Question 4
Discuss the accounting treatment of defectives in cost accounts
Answer
Accounting treatment of defectives in cost accounts:
Defectives refers to those units or portions of production, which do not meet the prescribed
specifications. Such units can be reworked or re-conditioned by the use of additional material,
labour and /or processing and brought to the point of either standard or sub-standard units.
The possible way of treating defectives in cost accounts are as below:
1.
When defectives are normal and it is not beneficial to identity them job-wise, then the
following methods may be used.
2.5
Cost Accounting
(a) Charged to good products: The cost of rectification of normal defectives is charged to
good units. This method is used when defectives rectified are normal.
(b) Charged to general overheads. If the department responsible for defectives cannot be
identified, the rework costs are charged to general overheads.
(c)
2.
When normal defectives are easily identifiable with specific job the rework costs are debited
to the identified job.
3.
When defectives are abnormal and are due to causes within the control of the organisation,
the rework cost should be charged to the Costing Profit and Loss Account.
Question 5
Discuss the concept of Economic Batch Quantity (EBQ)
Answer
Economic batch quantity: Production is usually done in batches and each batch can have any
number of units of a component in it. The optimum quantity for a batch is that quantity for which the
setting up and carrying costs are minimum. Such an optimum quantity is known as "Economic
batch quantity". The formula used to determine the economic batch quantity (EBQ) is:
EBQ =
where,
2 DS
C
Question 6
Explain the concept of "ABC Analysis" as a technique of inventory control
Answer
ABC Analysis: It is a system of selective inventory control whereby the measure of control over an
item of inventory varies with its usage value. It exercises discriminatory control over different items
of stores grouped on the basis of the investment involved,. Usually the items of material are
grouped into three categories viz; A, B and C according to their use value during a period. In other
words, the high use value items are controlled more closely than the items of low use value.
2.6
Materials
(i)
A Category of items consists of only a small percentage i.e., about 10 % of the total items of
material handled by the stores but require heavy investment i.e., about 70% of inventory
value, because of their high prices and heavy requirement.
(ii)
B Category of items comprises of about 20% of the total items of material handled by stores.
The percentage of investment required is about 20% of the total investment in inventories.
(iii) C category of items does not require much investment. It may be about 10% of total
inventory value but they are nearly 70% of the total items handled by stores.
A category of items can be controlled effectively by using a regular system, which ensures neither
over- stocking nor shortage of materials for production. Such a system plans its total material
requirements by making budgets. The stocks of materials are controlled by fixing certain levels like
maximum level, minimum level and re-order level. A reduction in inventory management costs is
achieved by determining economic order quantities after taking into account ordering cost and
carrying cost. To avoid shortages and to minimize heavy investment of funds in inventories, the
techniques of value analysis, variety reduction, standardization etc. are used along with aforesaid
techniques.
In the case of B category of items, as the sum involved is moderate, therefore, the same degree of
control as applied in A category of items is not warranted. The order for the items, belonging to
this category may be placed after reviewing their situation periodically. This category of items can
be controlled by routine control measures.
For C category of items, there is no need of exercising constant control. Orders for items in this
group may be placed either after six months or once in a year, after ascertaining consumption
requirements.
Question 7
Distinguish between Re-order level and Re-order quantity
Answer
Re-order level & Re-order quantity: Re-order level is defined as that level of an inventory item
where a fresh order for its replenishment is placed. Mathematically it can be determined by using
the following formulas:
Re-order level (ROL)
Alternatively:
Average
Average rate of
= Minimum level +
consumption
re order period
Re-order quantity (ROQ) is defined as that quantity of an inventory item for which order is placed
again and again. Economic order quantity is a re-order quantity but not vice-a-versa. It can be
determined by using the following mathematical expression:
2.7
Cost Accounting
EOQ = ROQ =
Question 8
Describe perpetual inventory records and continuous stock verification.
Answer
Perpetual inventory records and continuous stock verification:
Perpetual inventory records represents a system of records maintained by the stores department. It
in fact comprises of (i) Bin cards, and (ii) Stores Ledger.
Bin cards maintains a quantitative record of receipts, issues and closing balances of each item of
stores. Separate bin cards are maintained for each item. Each card is filled up with the physical
movement of goods i.e. on its receipt and issue.
Like bin cards the stores ledger is maintained to record all receipts and issues in respect of
materials. Entries in it are made with the help of goods received notes and material issue
requisitions.
A perpetual inventory record is usually checked by a programme of continuous stock verification.
Continuous stock verification means the physical checking of those inventory records (which are
maintained under perpetual inventory) with actual stock.
Perpetual inventory records helps in proper material control as discrepancies in physical stock and
book figures are regularly reconciled through continuous stock verification.
Question 9
How is slow moving and non-moving item of stores detected and what steps are necessary to
reduce such stocks?
Answer
Detection of slow moving and non-moving item of stores:
The existence of slow moving and non-moving item of stores can be detected in the following
ways.
(i)
By preparing and scanning periodic reports showing the status of different items or stores.
(ii)
By calculating the stock holding of various items in terms of number of days/ months of
consumption.
(iii) By computing ratios periodically, relating to the issues as a percentage of average stock held.
(iv) By implementing the use of a well designed information system.
2.8
Materials
Necessary steps to reduce stock of slow moving and non-moving item of stores:
(i)
Proper procedure and guidelines should be laid down for the disposal of non-moving items,
before they further deteriorates in value.
(ii)
Stores Ledger
Bincards are maintained in the stores and are Stores ledger is maintained in the cost accounts
department.
serving the purpose of stock register.
Entries in it are posted by the issue clerk. He
records the quantity about receipts, issues and
closing balance along with code number of
material, maximum, minimum and reorder
levels.
Question 11
Explain the advantages that would accrue in
Using the LIFO method of pricing for the valuation of raw material stock
Answer
(a) LIFO- Last-in-first-out: A method of pricing for the valuation of raw material stock. It is based
on the assumption that the items of the last batch(lot) purchased are the first to be issued.
Therefore, under this method, the price of the last batch(lot) of raw material is used for pricing
raw material issues until it is exhausted. If, however, the quantity of raw material issued is
more than the quantity of the latest lot, the price of the last but one lot and so on will be taken
for pricing the raw material issues.
The advantages that would accrue from the use of LIFO method of pricing the valuation of
raw materials, are as follows:-
2.9
Cost Accounting
(i)
The cost of materials used is nearer to the current market price. Thus the cost of goods
produced depends upon the trend of the market price of materials. This enables the
matching of cost of production with current sales revenues.
(ii)
Use of LIFO during the period of rising prices does not depict unnecessarily high profit in
the income statement; compared to the first-in-first-out or average methods. The profit
shown by the use of LIFO is relatively lower, because the cost of production takes into
account the rising trend of material prices.
(iii) When price of materials fall, the use of LIFO method accounts for rising the profits due
to lower material cost. Inspite of this finished product appears to be more competitive
and at market prices.
(iv) Over a period, the use of LIFO will iron out the fluctuations in profit.
(v)
During inflationary period, the use of LIFO will show the correct profit and thus avoid
paying unduly high taxes to some extent.
Question 12
(a) Discuss briefly the considerations governing the fixation of the maximum and minimum levels
of inventory.
(b) A company uses three raw materials A, B and C for a particular product for which the
following data apply :
Usage
per unit
of
product
(Kgs)
Reorder
Quantity
(Kgs)
10
10,000
5,000
Raw
Material
Price
per
Kg.
Delivery period
(in weeks)
Reorder
level
(Kgs)
Minimum
Average
Maximum
0.10
8,000
0.30
4,750
Rs.
Minimum
level
(Kgs)
C
6
10,000
0.15
2
3
4
2.000
Weekly production varies from 175 to 225 units, averaging 200 units of the said product. What
would be the following quantities:
(i)
Minimum Stock of A?
(ii)
Maximum Stock of B?
2.10
Materials
(a) Considerations for the fixation of maximum level of inventory.
Maximum level of an inventory item is its maximum quantity held in stock at any time. The
mathematical formula used for its determination is as follows:
Maximum level = Re-order level (Minimum Consumption Minimum Re-order period) +
Re-order quantity.
The important considerations which should govern the fixation of maximum level for various
inventory items are as follows:
(1) The fixation of maximum level of an inventory item requires information about re-order
level. The re-order level itself depends upon its maximum rate of consumption and
maximum delivery period. It in fact is the product of maximum consumption of inventory
item and its maximum delivery period.
(2) Knowledge about minimum consumption and minimum delivery period for each
inventory item should also be known.
(3) The determination of maximum level also requires the figure of economic order quantity.
Economic order quantity means the quantity of inventory to be ordered so that total
ordering and storage cost is minimum.
(4) Availability of funds, storage capacity, nature of items and their price also are important
for the fixation of minimum level.
(5) In the case of important materials due to their irregular supply, the maximum level
should be high.
Considerations for the fixation of minimum level of inventory
Minimum level indicates the lowest figures of inventory balance, which must be maintained in
hand at all times, so that there is no stoppage of production due to non-availability of
inventory. The formula used for its calculation is as follows:
Minimum level of inventory = Re-order level (Average rate of consumption Average
time of inventory delivery).
The main considerations for the fixation of minimum level of inventory are as follows:
1.
2.
3.
Average delivery period for each item. The period can be calculated by averaging the
maximum and minimum period.
2.11
Cost Accounting
(b) (i)
Minimum stock of A
Re-order level (Average rate of consumption Average time required to obtain
fresh delivery)
=
(ii)
Maximum stock of B
Re-order level (Minimum Consumption Minimum Re-order period) + Re-order
quantity
=
Re-order level of C
=
5,600 kgs.
4,000 16,250
= 10,125 kgs.
2
2.12
Materials
Working note
Maximum stock of A = ROL + ROQ (Minimum consumption Minimum
re-order period)
=
16,250 kgs.
Question 13
(a) EXE Limited has received an offer of quantity discounts on his order of materials as under:
Price per tonne
Tonnes
Rs.
Nos.
1,200
1,180
1,160
1,140
1,120
3,000 and above.
The annual requirement for the material is 5,000 tonnes. The ordering cost per order is Rs.
1,200 and the stock holding cost is estimated at 20% of material cost per annum. You are
required to complete the most economical purchase level.
(b) What will be your answer to the above question if there are no discount offered and the price
per tonne is Rs. 1,500?
Answer (a)
Total Annual
Order
No. of
Cost of Inventory S
Ordering
Carrying Cost
Requirement
Size
Orders
Cost
p.u. p.a.
S Rs. 1200
q
Total Cost
(units)
(S)
S
q
Rs.
Rs.
1
5000 units
400
12.5
60,00,000
5
15,000
(5,000 Rs.1200)
500
10
59,00,000
(4+5+6)
Rs.
Rs.
6
48,000
60,63,000
(5,000 Rs.1180)
59,000
(250 Rs. 236)
2.13
59,71,000
Cost Accounting
1,000
58,00,000
6,000
1,16,000
(5,000 Rs.1160)
2,000
2.5
57,00,000
2,28,000
(5,000 Rs.1140)
3,000
1.666
56,00,000
59,22,000
59,31,000
3,36,000
(5,000 Rs.1120)
59,38,000
The above table shows that the total cost of 5000 units including ordering and carrying cost is
minimum (Rs. 59,22,000) when the order size is 1000 units. Hence the most economical purchase
level is 1000 units.
(b) EOQ =
2SCo
Where S is the annual inventory requirement, Co, is the ordering cost
iC i
per order and iC1 is the carrying cost per unit per annum.
=
2 5000 Rs.1200
20% Rs.1500
200 tonnes
Question 14
A company has the option to procure a particular material from two sources:
Source I assures that defectives will not be more than 2% of supplied quantity.
Source II does not give any assurance, but on the basis of past experience of supplies received
from it, it is observed that defective percentage is 2.8%.
The material is supplied in lots of 1,000 units. Source II supplies the lot at a price, which is lower by
Rs. 100 as compared to Source I. The defective units of material can be rectified for use at a cost
of Rs. 5 per unit.
You are required to find out which of the two sources is more economical
Answer
Comparative Statement of procuring material from two sources
Material source
I
2
(Future estimate)
1,000
20
(1,000 units2%)
Defective (in %)
Units supplied (in one lot)
Total defective units in a lot
2.14
Material source
II
2.8
(Past experience)
1,000
28
(1,000 units 2.8%)
Materials
100
100
140
(20 units Rs. 5)
(28 units Rs. 5)
Total additional cost per lot (Rs.): [(A)+(B)]
200
140
Decision:
On comparing the total additional cost incurred per lot of 1,000 units, we observe
that it is more economical, if the required material units are procured from material
source II.
Question 15
What is material handling cost? How will you deal it in cost account?
Answer
Material handling cost: It refers to the expenses involved in receiving, storing, issuing and handling
materials. To deal with this cost in cost accounts there are two prevalent approaches as under:
First approach suggests the inclusion of these costs as part of the cost of materials by establishing
a separate material handling rate e.g., at the rate of percentage of the cost of material issued or by
using a separate material handling rate which may be established on the basis of weight of
materials issued.
Under another approach these costs may be included along with those of manufacturing overhead
and be charged over the products on the basis of direct labour or machine hours.
Question 16
At the time of physical stock taking, it was found that actual stock level was different from the
clerical or computer records. What can be possible reasons for such differences? How will you deal
with such differences?
Answer
Possible reasons for differences arising at the time of physical stock taking may be as follows when
it was found that actual stock level was different from that of the clerical or computer records:
(i)
Wrong entry might have been made in stores ledger account or bin card,
(ii) The items of materials might have been placed in the wrong physical location in the store,
(iii) Arithmetical errors might have been made while calculating the stores balances on the bin
cards or store-ledger when a manual system is operated,
(iv) Theft of stock.
When a discrepancy is found at the time of stock taking, the individual stores ledger account and
the bin card must be adjusted so that they are in agreement with the actual stock. For example, if
2.15
Cost Accounting
the actual stock is less than the clerical or computer record the quantity and value of the
appropriate store ledger account and bin card (quantity only) must be reduced and the difference in
cost be charged to a factory overhead account for stores losses.
Question 17
G. Ltd. produces a product which has a monthly demand of 4,000 units. The product requires a
component X which is purchased at Rs. 20. For every finished product, one unit of component is
required. The ordering cost is Rs. 120 per order and the holding cost is 10% p.a.
You are required to calculate:
(i)
(ii)
If the minimum lot size to be supplied is 4,000 units, what is the extra cost, the company has
to incur?
(iii) What is the minimum carrying cost, the company has to incur?
Answer
Economic order quantity:
S
(Annual requirement
C1
= Rs.20
Co
= Rs.120
(Holding cost)
E.O.Q. =
2SC 0
iC1
= 2,400 units
(ii) Extra cost incurred by the company
Total cost
1
S
Co + q (iC1)
q
2
48,000 units
1
Rs.120 + 4,000 units 10% Rs.20
2
4,000 units
2.16
Materials
Total cost =
48,000 units
1
Rs.120 + 2,400 units 10% Rs.20
2
2,400 units
(when order size is 2,400 units) = Rs. 2,400 + Rs. 2,400 = Rs. 4,800 (b)
Extra cost (a) (b)
1
2,400 units 10% Rs. 20 = Rs. 2,400
2
Question 18
PQR Tubes Ltd. are the manufacturer of picture tubes for T.V. The following are the details of their
operations during 1999-2000.
Ordering cost
20% p.a.
Cost of tubes
Normal usage
Minimum usage
Maximum usage
6 8 weeks
Required
(i)
Economic order quantity. If the supplier is willing to supply quarterly 1,500 units at a discount
of 5%, is it worth accepting?
(ii)
Re-order level
2.17
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
2 SC 0
iC1
E.O.Q =
(T.C.)q=102 units = Total purchase cost of 5,200+Total ordering cost + Total carrying cost
= 5,200 units Rs.500 +
5,200 units
1
Rs.100 102 units Rs. 100
102 units
2
1
5,200 units
Rs. 100 + 1,500 units
1,500 units
2
20% Rs.475
= Rs. 24,70,000 + Rs. 346.66 + Rs. 71,250
= Rs. 25,41,596.66 approx.
Decision: Since the total cost of inventory when supplier supplies quarterly 1,500 units at a
discount of 5% is less than that when the order size is of 102 units. Therefore, it is
advisable to accept the offer of 5% discount and save a sum of Rs. 68,601.34
(Rs. 26,10,198 Rs.25,41,596.66)
Note:
In the case of E.O.Q. the total ordering cost and the total carrying cost are always equal,
but in the above case it is not so because of the approximation made in arriving at the
figure of E.O.Q.
2.18
Materials
(ii) Re-order level (ROL)
=
1,600 tubes
Re-order level + Re-order quantity Minimum usage Minimum lead time to supply
1,402 tubes
900 tubes
Question 19
Distinguish clearly between bincard and stores ledger.
Answer
Distinction between bin card and store ledger.
Both bin card and stores ledger are perpetual inventory records. None of them is a substitute for
the other. These two records may be distinguished from the following points of view:
(i)
Bin card is maintained by the store-keeper, while the cost accounting department maintains
the stores ledger.
(ii)
Bin card is, the stores recording document whereas the stores ledger is an accounting record.
(iii) Bin card contains information with regard to quantities i.e. their receipt, issue and balance
while the stores ledger contains both quantitative and value information in respect of their
receipts, issue and balance.
(iv) In the bin card entries are made at the time when transaction takes place. But in the stores
ledger entries are made only after the transaction has taken place.
(v)
(vi) Bin cards record each transaction but stores ledger records the same information in a
summarized form.
Question 20
RST Limited has received an offer of quantity discount on its order of materials as under:
2.19
Cost Accounting
Price per tone
Tones number
Rs. 9,600
Less than 50
Rs. 9,360
Rs. 9,120
Rs. 8,880
Rs. 8,640
The annual requirement for the material is 500 tonnes. The ordering cost per order is Rs.12,500
and the stock holding cost is estimated at 25% of the material cost per annum.
Required
(i)
(ii)
Compute EOQ if there are no quantity discounts and the price per tonne is Rs.10,500.
Answer
(i)
Order
No. of
Cost of
size (Q)
orders purchase Ax
(Units) A/Q (Units) per unit cost
Carrying cost
A
Rs.12500
Q
Carrying cost
Q
C25%
2
Total cost
(3+4+5)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
10
12.5
48,00,000
1,56,250
48,000
50,04,250
40
9600 0.25
2
(5009600)
50
10
46,80,000
1,25,000
45,60,000
62,500
2.5
1,14,000
47,36,500
100
9120 0.25
2
(5009120)
200
48,63,500
50
9360 0.25
2
(5009360)
100
58,500
44,40,000
31,250
2,22,000
(5008880)
(2.512500)
200
8880 0.25
2
2.20
46,93,250
Materials
300
1.67
43,20,000
20,875
3,24,000
(5008640)
(1.6712500)
300
8640 0.25
2
46,64,875
The above table shows that the total cost of 500 units including ordering and carrying cost is
minimum (Rs. 46,64,875) where the order size is 300 units. Hence the most economical purchase
level is 300 units.
(ii)
EOQ =
2 AO
=
c i
2 500 12500
= 69 tonnes.
10500 25
Question 21
IPL Limited uses a small casting in one of its finished products. The castings are purchased from a
foundry. IPL Limited purchases 54,000 castings per year at a cost of
Rs. 800 per casting.
The castings are used evenly throughout the year in the production process on a
360-day-per-year basis. The company estimates that it costs Rs.9,000 to place a single purchase
order and about Rs.300 to carry one casting in inventory for a year. The high carrying costs result
from the need to keep the castings in carefully controlled temperature and humidity conditions, and
from the high cost of insurance.
Delivery from the foundry generally takes 6 days, but it can take as much as 10 days. The days of
delivery time and percentage of their occurrence are shown in the following tabulation:
Delivery time (days)
10
Percentage of occurrence
75
10
Required:
(I)
(ii)
Assume the company is willing to assume a 15% risk of being out of stock. What would be
the safety stock? The re-order point?
(iii) Assume the company is willing to assume a 5% risk of being out of stock. What would be the
safety stock? The re-order point?
(iv) Assume 5% stock-out risk. What would be the total cost of ordering and carrying inventory for
one year?
(v)
Refer to the original data. Assume that using process re-engineering the company reduces its
cost of placing a purchase order to only Rs.600. In addition company estimates that when the
2.21
Cost Accounting
waste and inefficiency caused by inventories are considered, the true cost of carrying a unit in
stock is Rs. 720 per year.
(a) Compute the new EOQ.
(b)
How frequently would the company be placing an order, as compared to the old
purchasing policy?
Answer
(i)
Annual requirement
= 54,000 castings
(C)
= Rs. 800
(O)
Ordering cost
(c i)
= Rs. 300
EOQ =
2AO
=
c i
2 54000 9000
300
= 1800 casting
Re-order point
= 150 3 days
= 450 castings
Re-order point
=1,350 castings
= Rs. 2,70,000
= Rs. 4,05,000
(v)
2 54,000 600
720
= 300 castings
2.22
Materials
(b) Total number of orders to be placed in a year are 180. Each order is to be placed after 2
days (1 year = 360 days). Under old purchasing policy each order is placed after 12
days.
Question 22
Write short notes on any three of the following:
(i)
Re-order quantity
(ii)
Re-order level
Re-order quantity: It refers to the quantity of stock for which an order is to be placed at any
one point of time. It should be such that it minimises the combined annual costs of-placing an
order and holding stock. Such an ordering quantity in other words is known as economic
order quantity (EOQ).
EOQ =
(ii)
2AO
C i
Re-order level: It is the level at which fresh order should be placed for the replenishment of
stock.
= Maximum re-order period Maximum usage
Average time to
Average
= Minimum level +
obtain fresh sup plies
consumption
(iii) Max stock level: It indicates the maximum figure of stock held at any time.
Minimum
Minimum
= Re order + Re order
re order
consumption
quantity
Level
period
2.23
Cost Accounting
(iv) Minimum stock level: It indicates the lowest figure of stock balance, which must be
maintained in hand at all times, so that there is no stoppage of production due to nonavailability of inventory.
= Re order
level
Average rate of
consumption
Average time of
stock delivery
Question 23
Discuss ABC analysis as a system of Inventory control.
Answer
ABC Analysis as a system of inventory control
It exercises discriminating control over different items of stores classified on the basis of
investment involved.
A category of items consists of only a small %age i.e. approximately 10% of total items handled by
stores but requires heavy investment, about 70% of inventory value, because of their high prices or
heavy requirement or both.
B category of items are relatively less important. They may be approximately 20% of the total
items of materials handled by stores. The %age of investment required is approximately 20% of
total investment in inventories.
C category of items do not require much investment. It may be about 10% of total inventory value
but they are nearly 70% of the total items handled by store.
EOQ, re-order level concepts are usually used in case of A category items.
Question 24
Distinguish between Bin Card and Stores Ledger
Answer
Bin card and stores ledger
Bin card is quantitative record of stores receipt, issue and balance. Control over stock is more
effective, in as much as comparison of actual quantity in hand at any time with the book balance
are possible. Bin cards are kept attached to the bins or quite near thereto , so as to assist in the
identification of stock.
Stores ledger is quantitative and value record of stores receipts, issue and balance. It is a
subsidiary ledger to the main cost ledger. It is maintained by cost accounting deptt.
2.24
Materials
Question 25
Discuss the accounting treatment of spoilage and defectives in Cost Accounting.
Answer
Accounting treatment of spoilage and defectives in Cost Accounting:
Normal spoilage cost (which is inherent in the operation) are included in cost either by charging the
loss due to spoilage to the production order or charging it to production overhead so that it is
spread over all products. Any value realized from the sale of spoilage is credited to production
order or production overhead account, as the case may be.
The cost of abnormal spoilage (i.e. spoilage arising out of causes not inherent in manufacturing
process) is charged to the Costing Profit and Loss Account. When spoiled work is due to rigid
specifications, the cost of spoiled work is absorbed by good production, while the cost of disposal
is charged to production overheads.
The problem of accounting for defective work is the problem of accounting of the costs of
rectification or rework. The possible ways of treatment are as below:
(i)
Defectives that are considered inherent in the process and are identified as normal can be
recovered by using the following methods:
Charged to good products
Charged to general overheads
Charged to department overheads
Charged to identifiable job.
(ii)
If defectives are abnormal and are due to causes beyond the control of organisation, the
rework, cost should be charged to Costing Profit and Loss Account.
Question 26
A company manufactures 5000 units of a product per month. The cost of placing an order is Rs.
100. The purchase price of the raw material is Rs. 10 per kg. The re-order period is 4 to 8 weeks.
The consumption of raw materials varies from 100 kg to 450 kg per week, the average
consumption being 275 kg. The carrying cost of inventory is 20% per annum.
You are required to calculate
(i)
Re-order quantity
(ii)
Re-order level
2.25
Cost Accounting
(iv) Minimum level
(v)
Answer
(i)
1,196 kgs.
(v)
Min.
Min.
ROL + ROQ
usage re order period
4,396 kgs.
Normal Normal
ROL
usage re order period
1,950 kgs.
1
2
1
[4,396 kgs. + 1,950 kgs.]
2
3,173 kgs.
Maximum Minimum
+
level
level
OR
=
[Minimum level +
[1,950 kgs +
2,548 kgs.
Working note
Annual consumption of raw material (S) =
14,300 kgs.
2.26
1
ROQ]
2
1
1,196 kgs.]
2
Materials
(275 kgs. 52 weeks)
Cost of placing an order (C0)
Rs. 100
20
Rs. 10 = Rs. 2
100
2SC 0
iC1
1,196 Kgs.
Question 27
The Complete Gardener is deciding on the economic order quantity for two brands of lawn
fertilizer: Super Grow and Natures Own. The following information is collected.
Fertilizer
Annual Demand
Relevant ordering cost per purchase order
Annual relevant carrying cost per bag
Super Grow
Natures Own
2,000 Bags
1,280 Bags
Rs. 1,200
Rs. 1,400
Rs. 480
Rs. 650
Required:
(i)
(ii)
For the EOQ, what is the sum of the total annual relevant ordering costs and total annual
relevant carrying costs for Super Grow and Natures Own?
(iii) For the EOQ, Compute the number of deliveries per year for Super Grow and Natures Own
Answer
(i)
2SC 0 *
iC1
EOQ =
*Here
C1
iC1
Cost Accounting
EOQ for Super Grow Fertilizer
Total annual relevant ordering costs + Total annual relevant carrying costs
S
1
C 0 EOQ iC1
EOQ
2
2,000 bags
1
Rs. 1,200 + 100 bags Rs. 480
2
100 bags
1,280 bags
1
Rs. 1,400 + 80 bags Rs. 560
2
80 bags
S
(annual demand of fertiliser bags)
EOQ
2,000 bags
= 20 orders
100 bags
1,280 bags
= 16 orders
80 bags
Question 28
A Ltd. is committed to supply 24,000 bearings per annum to B Ltd. on a steady basis. It is
estimated that it costs 10 paise as inventory holding cost per bearing per month and that the set-up
cost per run of bearing manufacture is Rs.324.
(i)
(ii)
2.28
Materials
Answer
(i)
12 months
Annual production
Optimum run size
12 months
24,000 bearings
3,600 bearings
12 months
6.66
24,000 bearings
Rs.324 + (1/2) 3,600 bearings 0.10P 12 months
3,600 bearings
Rs. 4,320
Question 29
Distinguish between Bin Card and Stores Ledger
Answer
Bin card & Stores ledger: Bin card is a quantitative record of stores, receipt, issue and balance. It is
kept for each & every item of store by the store keeper. They are kept attached to the bins or
receptacles or placed quite near thereto so that these also assist in the identification of stock. Here,
the balance is taken out after each receipt or issue transaction.
Stores ledger is a collection of cards or loose leaves specially ruled for maintaining a record of both
quantity and cost of stores items received. It also maintains record of stores receipt, issue and
2.29
Cost Accounting
balance in respect of each item of inventory. Entries in this ledger are made from goods received
notes and material requisitions.
Question 30
Discuss the accounting treatment of spoilage and defectives in cost accounting
Answer
Accounting treatment of spoilage & defectives in cost accounts:
Normal spoilage (i.e. which is inherent in the operation) costs are included in cost either by
charging the loss due to spoilage to the production order or by charging it to production overhead
so that it is spread over all the products. Any value realized from the sale of spoilage is credited to
production order or production overhead account, as the case may be. The cost of abnormal
spoilage are charged to Costing Profit & Loss Account.
Defectives that are considered inherent in the process and are identified as normal can be
recovered by using any one of the following method.
Charged to good products
Charged to general overheads
Charged to departmental overheads
If defectives are abnormal, they are to be debited to Costing Profit & Loss Account.
Question 31
A company manufactures a product from a raw material, which is purchased at Rs.60 per kg. The
company incurs a handling cost of Rs. 360 plus freight of Rs. 390 per order. The incremental
carrying cost of inventory of raw material is Re. 0.50 per kg. per month. In addition, the cost of
working capital finance on the investment in inventory of raw material is Rs. 9 per kg. per annum.
The annual production of the product is 1,00,000 units and 2.5 units are obtained from one kg of
raw material.
Required
(i)
(ii)
(iii) If the company proposes to rationalize placement of orders on quarterly basis, what
percentage of discount in the price of raw materials should be negotiated?
2.30
Materials
Answer
S
(Annual requirement of raw material in kgs.) = 1 kg. 1,00,000 units / 2.5 units = 40,000 kgs.
C0
iC1 (Carrying cost per unit per annum + Investment cost per Kg. per annum)
=
(i)
E.O.Q.
= 40,000 kgs.
= 2,000 kgs.
=4
Total cost
(when order size is 10,000 units)
Order placing cost
Rs.3,000
(4 orders Rs.750)
Carrying cost
Rs.75,000
(10,000/2Rs.15)
Rs.78,000
Total Cost
(When order size is equal to EOQ)
No. of orders
20
Rs. 15,000
Carrying cost
Rs. 15,000
Rs.30,000
2.31
Cost Accounting
Increase in cost to be compensated by discount:
Rs.48,000
Discount
Kgs.
Rs.
Upto 6,000
NIL
6,000 8,000
400
8,000 16,000
2,000
16,000 30,000
3,200
30,000 45,000
4,000
(ii)
Prepare a statement showing the total cost of procurement and storage of raw material after
considering the discount of the company elects to place one, two, four or six orders in the
year.
(iii) State the number of orders which the company should place to minimize the costs after taking
EOQ also into consideration
Answer
Working notes
1.
80,000
Materials
2.
40,000
3.
EOQ =
4.
20
2,000
(i)
2,000
_____
Total cost
4,000
Reorder point
(ii)
Order
size
No. of
orders
Kgs.
(1)
(2)
Total cost of
procurement
Average
stock
Total cost of
storage of
raw
materials
Discount
Total cost
Rs.
Kgs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
(3)=(2)Rs.100
(4)=(1)
(5)=(4)Rs.2
(6)
(7)=[(3)+(5)(6)
40,000
100
20,000
40,000
4,000
36,100
20,000
200
10,000
20,000
3,200
17,000
10,000
400
5,000
10,000
2,000
8,400
6666.66
600
3,333
6,666
400
6,866
2.33
Cost Accounting
(iii) Number of orders which the company should place to minimize the costs after taking EOQ
also into consideration is 20 orders each of size 2,000 kgs. The total cost of procurement and
storage in this case comes to Rs. 4,000, which is minimum.
(Refer to working notes 3 and 4)
Question 33
Write short note on perpetual inventory control.
Answer
Perpetual Inventory: It represents a system of records maintained by the stores in department. It
in fact comprises of:
(i)
(ii)
Stores Ledger
Bin Card maintains a quantitative record of receipts, issues and closing balances of each item of
stores. Separate bin cards are maintained for each item. Each card is filled up with the physical
movement of goods i.e. on its receipt and issue.
Like bin cards, the Stores Ledger is maintained to record all receipt and issue transactions in
respect of materials. It is filled up with the help of goods received note and material requisitions.
A perpetual inventory is usually checked by a programme of continuous stock taking. Continuous
stock taking means the physical checking of those records (which are maintained under perpetual
inventory) with actual stock. Perpetual inventory is essentially necessary for material control. It
incidentally helps continuous stock taking.
The success of perpetual inventory depends upon the following: (a) The Stores Ledger-(showing quantities and amount of each item)
(b) Stock Control Cards (or Bin Cards)
(c)
(d) Checking the physical balances of a number of items every day systematically and by rotation
(e) Explaining promptly the causes of discrepancies, if any, between physical balances and book
figures
(f)
Making corrective entries were called for after step (e) and
Materials
(2) Quick compilation of Profit and Loss Accounts (for interim period) due to prompt availability of
stock figures.
(3) Discrepancies are easily located and thus corrective action can be promptly taken to avoid
their recurrence.
(4) A systematic review of the perpetual inventory reveals the existence of surplus, dormant,
obsolete and slow-moving materials, so that remedial measures may be taken in time.
(5) Fixation of the various levels and check of actual balances in hand with these levels assist the
Storekeeper in maintaining stocks within limits and in initiating purchase requisitions for
correct quantity at the proper time.
Question 34
PQR Ltd., manufactures a special product, which requires ZED. The following particulars were
collected for the year 2005-06:
(i)
7,500 units
(ii)
Rs. 500
(iii)
Re-order period
5 to 8 weeks
(iv)
Rs. 60
(v)
10%
(vi)
Normal usage
(vii)
Minimum usage
(viii)
Maximum usage
Required:
(i)
Re-order quantity.
(ii)
Re-order level.
Answer
(i)
Re - order quantity =
2AO
Ci
2.35
Cost Accounting
= 3,873 units
(ii) Re-order level
= Maximum re-order period Maximum usage
2.36
Materials
Answer
Working Notes:
(i)
1.25
.625 kg.
2
1.25
.625 kg.
2
2.37
Cost Accounting
Question 36
Explain Bin Cards and Stock Control Cards.
Answer
Bin Cards and Stores control cards:
Bin Cards are quantitative records of the stores receipt, issue and balance. It is
kept for each and every item of stores by the store keeper. Here, the balance is taken out after
each receipt or issue transaction
Stock control cards are also similar to Bin Cards. Stock control cards contain
further informations as regards stock on order. These cards are kept in cabinets or trays or loose
binders.
Question 37
Explain Economic Batch Quantity in Batch Costing.
Answer
Economic Batch Quantity in Batch Costing
There are two types of costs involved in Batch Costing(i) set up costs(ii) carrying costs.
If the batch size is increased, set up cost per unit will come down and the carrying cost will
increase. If the batch size is reduced, set up cost per unit will increase and the carry\ng cost will
come down.
Economic Batch quantity will balance both these opponent costs. It is calculated as follows:
EBQ
2DS
c
Where,
D
Question 38
A Company manufactures a special product which requires a component Alpha. The
following particulars are collected for the year 2008:
(i)
8,000 units
(ii)
2.38
Materials
(iii)
Rs. 400
(iv)
20%
The company has been offered a quantity discount of 4% on the purchase of Alpha,
provided the order size is 4,000 components at a time.
Required:
(i)
EOQ
2 AO
C i
2 8,000 200
400 20%
= 200 units.
Calculation of total inventory cost p.a. at EOQ.
Rs.
Purchase cost = 8,000 400
Ordering cost
8,000
A
200 =
O
200
Q
Carrying cost
200
Q
400 20% =
c i
2
2
32,00,000
8,000
8,000
32,16,000
30,72,000
8,000
A
Ordering cost O
200 =
4,000
Q
400
________
4,000
Q
c i
384 20% =
2
2
Carrying cost =
1,53,600
32,26,000
2.39
Cost Accounting
Quantity discount offered should not be accepted as it results in increase in total cost of inventory
management by Rs. 10,000.
Question 39
Discuss the treatment of spoilage and defectives in Cost Accounting.
Answer
Treatment of spoilage and defectives in Cost Accounting: The normal spoilage cost (i.e.
which is inherent in the operation) are included in cost either by charging the loss due to spoilage
to production order or charging it to production overhead so that it is spread over all the products.
Any value realized from sale of spoilage is credited to production order or production overhead
account, as the case may be. The cost of abnormal spoilage (i.e. arising out of causes not inherent
in manufacturing process) are charged to costing Profit and Loss Account.
The problem of accounting for defective work is that of accounting of the costs of rectification or
rework.
The possible ways of treatment are as under:
For normal defectives:
(i)
(ii)
Quantity (kgs)
April 10
1,600
April 20
2,400
4.90
May 5
1,000
5.10
2.40
Materials
May 17
1,100
5.20
May 25
800
5.25
June 11
900
5.40
June 24
1,400
5.50
There was 1,500 kgs. in stock at April 1, 2008 which was valued at Rs. 4.80 per kg.
Issues:
Date
Quantity (kgs)
April 4
1,100
April 24
1,600
May 10
1,500
May 26
1,700
June 15
1,500
June 21
1,200
Issues are to be priced on the basis of weighted average method. The stock verifier of the
company reported a shortage of 80 kgs. on 31st May, 2008 and 60 kgs. on 30th June, 2008.
The shortage is treated as inflating the price of remaining material on account of shortage.
You are required to prepare a Stores Ledger Account.
Answer
(a)
Date
GRN
No.
MRR
No.
Qty.
(Kgs.)
Rates
(Rs.)
Issues
Amounts
Requisition. No.
Qty.
(Kgs.)
Balance
Rates Amount
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
Qty.
(Kgs.)
Amount
(Rs.)
2008
April 1
April 4
April 10
1,100
1,600
5.00
8,000
2.41
4.80
5,280
1,500
7,200
4.80
400
1,920
4.80
2,000
9,920
9,920 4.96
2,000
Cost Accounting
April 20
2,400
4.90
11,760
April 24
May 5
1,600
1,000
5.10
4.93
7,888
5,100
May 10
1,500
4.97
7,455
21,680 4.9
4,400
4,400
21,680
2,800
13,792
13,792
4.93
2,800
3,800
18,892
18,892
4.97
3,800
2,300
11,437
11,437
4.97
2,300
May 17
1,100
5.20
5,720
3,400
17,157
17,157
5.05
3,400
May 25
800
5.25
4,200
4,200
21,357
21,357
5.09
4,200
2,500
12,704
12,704
5.09
2,500
2,420
12,704
12,704
5.25
2,420
3,320
17,564
17,564
5.29
3,320
May 26
1,700
May 31
June 11
Shortage
900
5.40
5.09
8,653
80
4,860
June 15
1,500
5.29
7,935
1,820
9,629
9,629
5.29
1,820
June 21
1,200
5.29
6,348
620
3,281
3,281
5.29
620
2,020
10,981
10,981
5.40
2,020
1,960
10,981
10,981
5.60
1,960
June 24
June 30
1,400
5.50
7,700
Shortage
60
Question 41
The average annual consumption of a material is 18,250 units at a price of Rs. 36.50 per unit.
The storage cost is 20% on an average inventory and the cost of placing an order is Rs. 50.
How much quantity is to be purchased at a time?
2.42
Materials
Answer
Quantity to be purchased
2 18,250 50
2,50,000 500 units
20% of 36.50
Question 42
Discuss the treatment of spoilage and defectives.
Answer
Treatment of spoilage and defectives:
Spoilage:
Normal spoilage are included in cost either by charging the loss to the production order or charging it
to production overhead. The cost of abnormal spoilage is charged to costing profit and loss account.
Defectives:
Normal defectives can be recovered
charged to department.
If defectives are abnormal and are due to causes beyond the control of organization then they
should be charged to profit and loss account.
Question 43
Explain, why the Last in First out (LIFO) has an edge over First in First out (FIFO) or any other
method of pricing material issues.
Answer
LIFO has following advantages:
(a) The cost of the material issued will be reflecting the current market price.
(b) The use of the method during the period of rising prices does not reflect undue high profit in
the income statement.
(c)
In the case of falling price, profit tend to rise due to lower material cost, yet the finished goods
appear to be more competitive and are at market price.
(d) During the period of inflation, LIFO will tend to show the correct profit.
Question 44
ZED Company supplies plastic crockery to fast food restaurants in metropolitan city. One of its
products is a special bowl, disposable after initial use, for serving soups to its customers. Bowls
are sold in pack 10 pieces at a price of Rs. 50 per pack.
2.43
Cost Accounting
The demand for plastic bowl has been forecasted at a fairly steady rate of 40,000 packs every
year. The company purchases the bowl direct from manufacturer at Rs. 40 per pack within a three
days lead time. The ordering and related cost is Rs. 8 per order. The storage cost is 10% per cent
per annum of average inventory investment.
Required:
(i)
(ii)
(iii) Calculate the total cost of ordering and storage bowls for the year.
(iv) Determine when should the next order to be placed. (Assuming that the company does
maintain a safety stock and that the present inventory level is 333 packs with a year of 360
working days.
Answer
(i)
EOQ
2 40,000 8
4
(ii)
40,000
100 order per year
400
800
800
1,600
Materials
360
3.6 days supply
100
This implies that each order of 400 packs supplies for requirements of 3.6 days
only.
(b) Days requirement covered by inventory
(c)
Units in inventory
(Day requirement served by an order)
Economic order quantity
333
3.6 days 3 days requirement
400
Question 45
Discuss ABC analysis as a technique of inventory control.
Answer
ABC Analysis as a technique of Inventory Control:
It is a system of inventory control. It exercises discriminating control over different items of stores
classified on the basis of investment involved. Usually they are divided into three categories
according to their importance, namely, their value and frequency of replenishment during a period.
A category of items consists of only a small percentage i.e. about 10% of total items handles by
the stores but require heavy investment about 70% of inventory value, because of their high price
or heavy requirement or both.
B category of items are relatively less important 20% of the total items of material handled by
stores and % of investment required is about 20% of total investment in inventories.
C category 70% of total items handled and 10% of value.
For A category items, stocks levels and EOQ are used and effective monitoring is done.
2.45
Cost Accounting
For B category same tools as in A category are applied.
For C category of items, there is no need of exercising constant control. Orders for items in this
group may be placed after 6 months or once in a year, after ascertaining consumption requirement.
Question 46
The annual carrying cost of material X is Rs. 3.6 per unit and its total carrying cost is Rs.
9,000 per annum. What would be the Economic order quantity for material X, if there is no
safety stock of material X ?
Answer
Calculation of Economic Order Quantity
Average Inventory
Rs. 9,000
2,500 Units
Rs. 3.60
3.6 E.O.Q
2
or E.O.Q.
9,000 2
5,000 unit
3.6
Question 47
Differentiate between scrap and defectives and how they are treated in cost accounting.
Answer
Scrap: Scrap is incidental residence from certain type of manufacture, usually of small amount and
low value, recoverable without further processing.
The cost of scrap is borne by good units and income scrap is treated as other income.
2.46
Materials
Defectives: Defectives are portion of production which can be rectified by incurring additional cost.
Normal defectives can be avoided by quality control. Normal defectives are charged to good
products.
Abnormal defectives are charged to Costing Profit and Loss Account
2.47
Cost Accounting
EXERCISE
Question 1
List five types of inefficiency in the use of materials that may be discovered as the result of
investigating material quantity variances. What measures may be taken in each such situation to
prevent their recurrence?
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 2
Many businesses have an unnecessarily large amount of capital locked up in the raw materials and
work-in-progress. Indicate methods of correcting this position.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 3
Discuss briefly how the following items are to be treated in costs:(i)
(ii)
Storage losses
2.48
Materials
Question 7
Explain the distinction between waste and scrap in the manufacturing process. Discuss their
treatment in cost accounts and suggest a procedure for control.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 8
What is ABC analysis? Discuss its role in a sound system of material control.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 9
Distinguish between
(a) Perpetual Inventory System and continuous stock taking.
(b) Bill of materials and material requisition note
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 10
Distinguish amongst:
Waste
Spoilage
Salvage
Rectification
Scrap.
How are they treated in Cost Accounts.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 11
Draw a proforma of "Bill of Materials". List down the Advantages of using the same.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 12
Write notes on Bill of Material
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 13
2.49
Cost Accounting
Distinguish between perpetual inventory and continuous stock trading.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 14
"To be able to calculate a basic EOQ certain assumptions are necessary. "List down these
assumptions.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 15
Draw specimen draft of a Purchase Order.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 16
What is a purchase requisition? Give a specimen form of a purchase requisition.
Answer Refer to Chapter No.2 i.e. Material of Study Material.
Question 17
What do you understand by ABC analysis of inventory control ? A factory uses 4,000 varieties of
inventory. In terms of inventory holding and inventory usage, the following information is compiled:
No. of varieties
of inventory
% of inventory usage
(in end-product)
3,875
96.875
20
110
2.750
30
10
15
0.375
50
85
4,000
100.000
100
Classify the items of inventory as per ABC analysis with reasons.
100
Purchase (Units)
200
300
2.50
Issued
units
Nil
250
Materials
March
425
26
300
April
475
23
550
May
500
25
800
June
600
20
400
(a) The chief accountant argues that the values of closing stock remains the same no matter
which method of pricing of material issues is used. Do you agree? Why or why not? Detailed
stores ledgers are not required.
(b) When and why would you recommend the LIFO method of pricing material issues?
Answer (a) Correct
(b) At the time of inflation
Question 19
The following information is provided by SUNRISE INDUSTRIES for the fortnight of April, 1988:
Material Exe :
Stock on 1.4.1988 100 units at Rs. 5 per unit.
Purchases
5-4-88
8-4-88
12-4-88
Issues
6-4-88
250 units
10-4-88
400 units
14-4-88
500 units
Required
(A) Calculate using FIFO and LIFO methods of pricing issues:
(a) the value of materials consumed during the period
(b) the value of stock of materials on 15-4-88.
(B) Explain why the figures in (a) and (b) in part A of this question are different under the
two methods of pricing of material issues used. You NEED NOT draw up the Stores
Ledgers.
2.51
Cost Accounting
Answer Total value of material Exe consumed during the period under FIFO method comes to
(Rs. 1,400 + Rs. 2,650 Rs. 3,750) Rs. 7,800 and balance on 15.04.88 is of Rs.
2,800.
Total value of material Exe issued under LIFO method comes to
(Rs. 1,500 + Rs. 2,800 + Rs. 4,000) Rs. 8,300
Question 20
About 50 items are required every day for a machine. A fixed cost of Rs. 50 per order is incurred
for placing an order. The inventory carrying cost per item amounts to Rs. 0.02 per day. The lead
period is 32 days compute.
(i)
(ii)
Re-order level
Answer (i)
(ii)
Question 21
The following data are available in respect of material X for the year ended 31 st March 1997.
Rs.
Opening stock
90,000
2,70,000
Closing stock
1,10,000
Calculate
(i)
(ii)
Answer (i)
(ii)
the number of days for which the average inventory is held 146 days
Question 22
M/s Tubes Ltd. are the manufacturers of picture tubes for T.V. The following are the details of their
operation during 1997:
Average monthly market demand
2,000 Tubes
Ordering cost
Materials
Cost of tubes
Normal usage
Minimum usage
Maximum usage
6-8 weeks
10,000 units.
Question 24
At what price per unit would Part No. A32 be entered in the Stores Ledger, if the following invoice
was received from a supplier:
Invoice
200 units Part No. A32 @ Rs. 5
Less: 20% discount
Add: Excise Duty @ 15%
Add Packing charges (5 non-returnable boxes)
2.53
Rs.
1,000.00
200.00
800.00
120.00
920.00
50.00
970.00
Cost Accounting
Notes:
(i)
(ii)
Documents substantiating payment of excise duty is enclosed for claiming MODVAT credit.
200
Cost of an Order
100
Would your advice differ if the company is offered 5% discount on a single order?
Answer (a)
2.54
Materials
(c) The offer should be accepted
Question 27
From the details given below, calculate
(i)
Re-ordering level
(ii)
Maximum level
Rate of consumption:
Answer (i)
(ii)
Nil
Purchases :
Jan.1
2.55
Cost Accounting
Jan. 20
Issues:
Jan. 22
Jan 23
60 for Job W 16
60 for Job W 17
Complete the receipts and issues valuation by adopting the First-in First-Out, Last-in First Out
and the Weighted Average Method. Tabulate the values allocated to Job W 16, Job W 17 and the
closing stock under the methods aforesaid and discuss from the different points of view which
method you would prefer.
Answer
FIFO
160
LIFO
Weighted Average
80
120
Question 30
AT Ltd. furnishes the following stores transactions for September, 1982
1-9-82
Opening balance
4-9-82
6-9-82
7-9-82
12 Units
10-9-82
10 Units
12-9-82
15 Units
13-9-82
20 Units
15-9-82
17-9-82
10 Units
19-9-82
10 Units
20-9-82
8 Units
5 Units
22-9-82
5 Units
26-9-92
29-9-82
5 Units
30-9-82
2 Units
10 units
2.56
Materials
Write up the priced stores ledger on FIFO method and discuss how would you treat the shortage in
stock taking.
Answer Balance Rs. 167.30
Question 31
A manufacturer of Surat purchased three Chemicals A, B and C from Bombay. The invoice gave
the following information:
Rs.
Chemical A :
12,600
Chemical B:
19,000
Chemical C:
9,500
Sales Tax
2,055
Railway Freight
1,000
Total Cost
44,155
A shortage of 200 kg in Chemical A, of 280 kg. in Chemical B and of 100 kg. in Chemical C was
noticed due to breakages. At Surat, the manufacturer paid Octroi duty @ Re 0.10 per kg. He also
paid Cartage Rs. 22 for Chemical A, Rs. 63.12 for Chemical B and Rs. 31.80 for Chemical C.
Calculate the stock rate that you would suggest for pricing issue of chemicals assuming a provision
of 5% towards further deterioration.
Answer
Rs.5.20
B
Rs. 4.68
C
Rs. 5.76
Question 32
Shriram Enterprises manufactures a special product "ZED". The following particulars were
collected for the year 1986:
Cost Accounting
Compute from the above
(1) Re-order Quantity
(2) Re-order level
(3) Minimum Level
(4) Maximum Level
(5). Average Stock Level
Answer (1)
Tonnes
Rs.
1,400
1,380
1,360
1,340
1,320
The annual requirement of the material is 5,000 tonnes. The delivery cost per order is Rs. 1,200
and the annual stock holding cost is estimated at 20 per cent of the average inventory.
The Purchase Department wants you to consider the following purchase options and advise which
among them will be the most economical ordering quantity, presenting the relevant information in a
tabular form.
2.58
Materials
The purchase quantity options to be considered are 400 tonnes, 500 tonnes, 1,000 tonnes, 2,000
tonnes and 3,000 tonnes
Answer Most economical order size 1,000 tonnes
Question 34
Component Pee is made entirely in cost centre 100. Material cost is 6 paise per component and
each component takes 10 minutes to produce. The machine operator is paid 72 paise per hour,
and the machine hour rate is Rs. 1.50. The setting up of the machine to produce the component
Pee takes 2 hours 20 minutes.
On the basis of this information, prepare a cost sheet showing the production and setting up cost,
both in total and per component, assuming that a batch of:
(a) 10 components,
(b) 100 components, and
(c)
Answer Components
10
100
1000
9.48
48.18
435.18
Question 35
X Ltd. is committed to supply 24,000 bearings per annum to Y Ltd. on a steady basis. It is
estimated that it costs 10 paise as inventory holding cost per bearing per month and that the set-up
cost per run of bearing manufacture is Rs. 324.
(a) What would be the optimum run size for bearing manufacture?
(b) Assuming that the company has a policy of manufacturing 6,000 bearing per run, how much
extra costs the company would be incurring as compared to the optimum run suggested in (a)
above?
(c)
Rs. 2,160
Question 36
Raw materials X costing Rs. 100 per kilogram and Y costing Rs. 60 per kilogram are mixed in
equal proportions for making product A. The loss of material in processing works out to 25% of the
output. The production expenses are allocated at 50% of direct material cost. The end product is
2.59
Cost Accounting
priced with a margin of 33 31 % over the total cost. Material Y is not easily available and substitute
raw material Z has been found for Y costing Rs. 50 per kilogram. It is required to keep the
proportion of this substitute material in the mixture as low at possible and at the same time
maintain the selling price of the end product at existing levels and ensure the same quantum of
profit as at present.
You are required:
To compute what should be the ratio of mix of the raw materials X and Z.
Answer The ratio of mix of the raw materials X and Z =3:2.
Question 37
SK Enterprise manufactures a special product ZE. The following particulars were collected for the
year 2004:
Annual consumption
Re. 1
Ordering cost
24%
15 days
Safety stock
30 days consumption
Required:
(i)
Re-order quantity
(ii)
Re-order level
(iii)
What should be the inventory level (ideally) immediately before the material order is
received?
Answer (i)
2.60
Materials
of Component X are required. The Ordering cost is Rs. 350 per order and the Carrying cost is 12%
p.a.
Required:
(i)
(ii)
If the minimum lot size to be supplied is 52,000 units, what is the extra cost, the company has
to incur?
(iii) What is the minimum carrying cost, the Company has to incur?
Answer (i) economic order quantity = 15,578 units of components
(ii) Extra cost incurred = Rs 22,960
(iii) Minimum carrying cost = Rs 14,020
2.61
CHAPTER 3
LABOUR
BASIC CONCEPTS AND FORMULAE
Basic Concepts
1.
2.
Direct Labour: Any Labour Cost that is specifically incurred for or can be readily charged
to or identified with a specific job, contract, work order or any other unit of cost.
Idle Time: The time for which the employer pays but obtains no direct benefit or for no
productive purpose.
4.
Normal Idle Time: Time which can not be avoided or reduced in the normal course of
business. The cost of normal idle time should be charged to the cost of production.
5.
Abnormal Idle Time: It arises on account of abnormal causes and should be charged to
Costing Profit and Loss account.
6.
7.
Time Booking: It is basically recording the details of work done and the time spent by
workers on each job or process.
8.
Overtime: Payment to workers, when a worker works beyond the normal working hours.
Usually overtime has to be paid at double the rate of normal hours.
9.
Overtime Premium: Its the amount of extra payment paid to a worker under overtime.
10. Labour Turnover: It is the rate of change in labour force during a specified period due to
resignation, retirement and retrenchment. If the labour turnover is high, its a sign of
instability and may affect the profitability of the firm.
11. Incentives: It is the simulation for effort and effectiveness by offering monetary inducement
or enhanced facilities.
12. Time Rate System: The amount of wages due to a worker is arrived at by multiplying the
time worked by the appropriate time rate.
13. Differential Time Rate: Different hourly rates are fixed for differtent levels of efficiency.
Upto a certain level a fixed rate is paid and based on the efficiency level the hourly rate
increases gradually.
Cost Accounting
14. Straight Piece Work: Payment is made on the basis of a fixed amount per unit of output
irrespective of time taken. It is the number of units produced by the worker multiplied by
rate per unit.
15. Differential Piece Rate: For different level of output below and above the standard,
different piece rates are applicable.
16. Wage Abstract: A summary giving details of wages to be charged to individual jobs,
workorders or processes for a specific period.
Basic Formulas
The formulas for different wage payment and incentive systems are given below:
1
Either 100% or
more than 100%
3.2
Payment
83% of the normal piece rate or 80% of piece rate
when below standard
125% of the normal piece rate or 120% of piece rate
when at or above standard
Payment
Up to 83 %
83% to 100%
Above 100%
Payment
Output at standard
3.2
Labour
4.2
4.3
Payment
No bonus, only guaranteed time rate is paid.
Worker is paid by hourly rate for the time he actually
worked plus in increase in bonus according to degree of
efficiency on the basis of step bonus rates. Bonus rate
can be up to 20%.
Above 100%
120% of time wage rate plus additional bonus of 1% for
each 1% increase in efficiency.
Bedaux Pont System
75 Bedaux pointssaved
Rate per hour
Earnings = Hours worked Rate per hour +
60
100
4.4
4.5
50
Earnings = Hours worked Rate per hour + Time saved Rate per hour)
100
5.2 Halsey-Weir Premium Plan
30
Earnings = Hours worked Rate per hour + Time saved Rate per hour)
100
3.3
Cost Accounting
5.3 Rowan System
Time saved
Earnings = Hours worked Rate per hour +
Hours worked Rate per hour)
Time allowed
5.4 Barth Sharing Plan
Earnings = Rate per hour
Question 1
Discuss the three methods of calculating labour turnover
Answer
Methods of Calculating labour turnover
(i)
Replacement method =
(ii)
Separation method =
Question 2
Discuss the Gantt task and bonus system as a system of wage payment and incentives.
Answer
Gantt Task and Bonus System
This system is a combination of time and piecework system. According to this system a high standard
or task is set and payment is made at time rate to a worker for production below the set standard.
3.4
Labour
Wages payable to workers under the plan are calculated as under:
Output
Payment
(i)
(ii)
Output at standard
Question 3
Discuss two types of Costs, which are associated with labour turnover
Answer
Two types of costs associated with labour turnover are:
(i)
Preventive costs:
These costs are incurred to keep the labour turnover rate at a low level. They include costs of
accommodation, transport facilities, medical services, welfare schemes, pension schemes,
environment improvement, lighting, heating, air-conditioning etc. The rate of labour turnover is
usually low, if a company incurs higher preventive costs.
(ii)
Replacement costs:
These costs arise due to high labour turnover, e.g. cost of advertising, recruitment, selection,
training & induction, abnormal breakage and scrap, extra wages & overheads etc., caused as
a result of inefficient and inexperienced newly recruited workers.
Question 4
Discuss the accounting treatment of Idle time and overtime wages
Answer
Accounting treatment of idle time wages & overtime wages in cost accounts:
Normal idle time is treated as a part of the cost of production. Thus, in the case of direct workers,
an allowance for normal idle time is built into the labour cost rates. In the case of indirect workers,
normal idle time is spread over all the products or jobs through the process of absorption of factory
overheads.
Under Cost Accounting, the overtime premium is treated as follows:
If overtime is resorted to at the desire of the customer, then the overtime premium may be
charged to the job directly.
3.5
Cost Accounting
If overtime is required to cope with general production programme or for meeting urgent
orders, the overtime premium should be treated as overhead cost of particular department or
cost center which works overtime.
Overtime worked on account of abnormal conditions should be charged to costing Profit &
Loss Account.
If overtime is worked in a department due to the fault of another department the overtime
premium should be charged to the latter department.
Question 5
Discuss the effect of overtime payment on productivity
Answer
Effect of overtime payment on productivity: Overtime work should be resorted to only when it is
extremely essential because it involves extra cost. The overtime payment increases the cost of
production in the following ways:
1.
The overtime premium paid is an extra payment in addition to the normal rate.
2.
The efficiency of operators during overtime work may fall and thus output may be less than
normal output.
3.
In order to earn more the workers may not concentrate on work during normal time and thus
the output during normal hours may also fall.
4.
Reduced output and increased premium of overtime will bring about an increase cost of
production.
Question 6
State the circumstances in which time rate system of wage payment can be preferred in a factory.
Answer
Circumstances in which time rate system of wage payment can be preferred:
In the following circumstances the time rate system of wage payment is preferred in a factory.
1.
Persons whose services cannot be directly or tangibly measured, e.g., general helpers,
supervisory and clerical staff etc.
2.
Workers engaged on highly skilled jobs or rendering skilled services, e.g., tool making,
inspection and testing.
3.
Where the pace of output is independent of the operator, e.g., automatic chemical plants.
3.6
Labour
Question 7
Discuss briefly, how will you deal with casual workers and workers employed on outdoor work in
Cost Accounts.
Answer
Causal and outdoor workers
Casual workers (badli workers) are employed temporarily, for a short duration to cope with
sporadic increase in volume of work. If the permanent labour force is not sufficient to cope
effectively with a rush of work, additional labour (casual workers) are employed to work for a short
duration. Out door workers are those workers who do not carry out their work in the factory
premises. Such workers either carry out the assigned work in their homes (e.g., knitwear, lamp
shades) or at a site outside the factory.
Casual workers are engaged on a dally basis. Wages are paid to them either at the end of the
days work or after a periodic interval. Wages paid are charged as direct or indirect labour cost
depending on their identifiability with specific jobs, work orders, or department.
Rigid control should be exercised over the out-workers specially with regard to following:
1.
2.
Ensuring the completion of output during the stipulated time so as to meet comfortably the
orders and contracts.
Question 8
It should be managements endeavor to increase inventory turnover but to reduce labour turnover.
Expand and illustrate the idea contained in this statement.
Answer
Inventory turnover: It is a ratio of the value of materials consumed during a period to the average
value of inventory held during the period. A high inventory turnover indicates fast movement of
stock.
Labour turnover: It is defined as an index denoting change in the labour force for an organization
during a specified period. Labour turnover in excess of normal rate is termed as high and below it
as low turnover.
Effects of high inventory turnover and low labour turnover: High inventory turnover reduces the
investment of funds in inventory and thus accounts for the effective use of the concerns financial
resources. It also accounts for the increase of profitability of a business concern. As against high
labour turnover the low labour turnover is preferred because high labour turnover causes-decrease
in production targets; increase in the chances of break down of machines at the shopfloor level;
3.7
Cost Accounting
increase in the number of accidents; loss of customers and their brand loyalty due to either nonsupply of the finished goods or due to sub-standard production of finished goods; increase in the
cost of selection, recruitment and training; increase in the material wastage and tools breakage.
All the above listed effects of high labour turnover accounts for the increase in the cost of
production/process/service. This increase in the cost finally accounts for the reduction of concerns
profitability. Thus, it is necessary to keep the labour turnover at a low level.
As such, it is correct that management should endeavour to increase inventory turnover and
reduce labour turnover for optimum and best utilization of available resources and reduce the cost
of production and thus increase the profitability of the organization.
Question 9
What are the main features of Halsey and Rowan method of payment of remuneration? State how
Rowan Scheme is better than Halsey Scheme. Given time allowed of 30 hours for a job and the
wage rate of Re. 1.00 per hour, illustrate your answer by assuming your own figure for time taken
to do the job.
Answer
F.A. Halsey, an American Engineer, brought out his plan in 1891. the main features of his plan
were as follows:
(i)
(ii)
(iii) In case a worker completes the job or operation in less time than allowed time (or standard
time) he is paid a fixed percentage of saving in time, which is usually 50%.
(iv) Under this plan, the employer is benefited to the extent of remaining 50% of time saved.
(v)
Employer is not protected against overspeeding jobs by workers resulting in waste, damages
etc.
Rowan Scheme was introduced by James Rowan in Glasgow in the year 1898. it is similar to
Halsey Scheme but the premium concept here is different. The main features of Rowan
Scheme are:
(i)
(ii)
(iii) Instead of fixed percentage of time saved, bonus is in proportion of time saved to time
allowed.
(iv) Protects employer against loose rate setting.
3.8
Labour
(v)
The Rowan Scheme is better than Halsey Scheme because of the following reasons:
(i)
In Halsey Scheme, bonus is set at 50% of time saved. It does not serve as a strong
incentive. If workers overspeed, the quality of the products deteriorates.
(ii)
In Rowan Scheme, there is an automatic check on the earnings and thus overspeeding
is arrested. In Halsey Scheme if two third of the time is saved, the worker can double his
earning per hour and in Rowan Scheme, this is not possible.
(iii) The earning per hour in Rowan Scheme is higher upto 50% of time saved and falls
thereafter whereas in Halsey Scheme the earnings per hour increases at a slow speed
and can be doubled.
Consider the following example in which the time allowed for performing the job is 30 hours and the
wage rate is Re. 1.00 per hour. We will depict with the help of imaginary figures in the following
example, how the earnings per hour under Halsey and Rowan plan will vary.
Example:
Time
Time
Wage
Allowed taken
30
Bonus
Total Wages
Earnings/hr
Halsey
Rowan
Halsey
Rowan
Halsey
Rowan
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
30
30
30.00
30.00
1.00
1.00
20
20
5.00
6.67
25.00
26.67
1.25
1.33
15
15
7.50
7.50
22.50
22.50
1.50
1.50
10
10
10.00
6.67
20.00
16.67
2.00
1.67
12.50
4.17
17.50
9.17
3.50
1.83
Question 10
Explain the meaning of and the reasons for Idle time and discuss its treatment in cost accounting.
Answer
Idle time refers to the labour time paid for but not utilized on production. It, in fact, represents the
time for which wages are paid, but during which no output is given out by the workers. This is the
period during which workers remain idle.
3.9
Cost Accounting
Reasons for idle time: According to reasons, idle time can be classified into normal idle time and
abnormal idle time. Normal idle time is the time which cannot be avoided or reduced in the normal
course of business.
The main reasons for the occurrence of normal idle time are as follows:
1.
Time taken by workers to travel the distance between the main gate of factory and the place
of their work.
2.
Time lost between the finish of one job and starting of next job.
3.
4.
Time spent to meet their personal needs like taking lunch, tea etc.
The main reasons for the occurrence of abnormal idle time are:
1.
Due to machine break downs, power failure, non-availability of raw materials, tools or waiting
for jobs due to defective planning.
2.
Due to conscious management policy decision to stop work for some time.
3.
In the case of seasonal goods producing units, it may not be possible for them to produce
evenly throughout the year. Such a factor too results in the generation of abnormal idle time.
Treatment in Cost Accounting: Idle time may be normal or abnormal.
Normal idle time: It is inherent in any job situation and thus it cannot be eliminated or reduced. For
example:- time gap between the finishing of one job and the starting of another; time lost due to
fatigue etc.
The cost of normal idle time should be charged to the cost of production. This may be done by
inflating the labour rate. It may be transferred to factory overheads for absorption, by adopting a
factory overhead absorption rate.
Abnormal idle time: It is defined as the idle time which arises on account of abnormal causes; e.g.
strikes; lockouts; floods; major breakdown of machinery; fire etc. Such an idle time is
uncontrollable.
The cost of abnormal idle time due to any reason should be charged to Costing Profit & Loss
Account.
Question 11
Discuss the objectives of time keeping & time booking.
3.10
Labour
Answer
Objectives of time keeping and time booking: Time keeping has the following two objectives:
(i)
Preparation of Payroll: Wage bills are prepared by the payroll department on the basis of
information provided by the time keeping department.
(ii)
Computation of Cost: Labour cost of different jobs, departments or cost centers are computed
by costing department on the basis of information provided by the time keeping department.
To ascertain the labour time spent on the job and the idle labour hours.
(ii)
(iii) To calculate the amount of wages and bonus payable under the wage incentive scheme.
(iv) To compute and determine overhead rates and absorption of overheads under the labour and
machine hour method.
(v)
To evaluate the performance of labour by comparing actual time booked with standard or
budgeted time.
Question 12
Distinguish between Job Evaluation and Merit Rating.
Answer
Distinguish between Job Evaluation and Merit Rating
Job evaluation. It can be defined as the process of analysis and assessment of jobs to ascertain
reliably their relative worth and to provide management with a reasonably sound basis for
determining the basic internal wage and salary structure for the various job positions. In other
words, job evaluation provides a rationale for differential wages and salaries for different groups of
employees and ensures that these differentials are consistent and equitable.
Merit Rating. It is a systematic evaluation of the personality and performance of each employee by
his supervisor or some other qualified persons.
Thus the main points of distinction between job evaluation and merit rating are as follows:
1.
Job evaluation is the assessment of the relative worth of jobs within a company and merit
rating is the assessment of the relative worth of the man behind a job. In other words job
evaluation rate the jobs while merit rating rate employees on their jobs.
3.11
Cost Accounting
2.
Job evaluation and its accomplishment are means to set up a rational wage and salary
structure whereas merit rating provides scientific basis for determining fair wages for each
worker based on his ability and performance.
3.
Job evaluation simplifies wage administration by bringing a uniformity in wage rates. On the
other hand merit rating is used to determine fair rate of pay for different workers on the basis
of their performance.
Question 13
Calculate the earnings of A and B from the following particulars for a month and allocate the labour
cost to each job X, Y and Z:
A
Rs. 100
160
50%
50%
8%
8%
2%
2%
(i)
Basic Wages
(ii)
Dearness Allowance
(v)
Overtime
Hours 10
The Normal working hours for the month are 200. Overtime is paid at double the total of normal
wages and dearness allowance. Employers contribution to State Insurance and Provident Fund
are at equal rates and employees contributions. The two workers were employed on jobs X, Y and
Z in the following proportions:
Jobs
X
Workers A
40%
30%
30%
Worker B
50%
20%
30%
Rs.
Rs.
100
160
50
50
Dearness Allowance
(50% of Basic Wages)
3.12
Labour
Overtime Wages
15
165
240
10
16
155
224
Rs.
Rs.
Gross Wages
150
240
10
16
Ordinary wages
160
256
0.80
1.28
(Rs. 160/200)
(Rs. 256/200)
(excluding overtime)
Employers Contribution to P.F. and E.S.I.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
160
64
48
48
15
15
256
128
51.20
76.8
431
192
114.2
124.8
Worker A:
Ordinary Wages:
(4 : 3 :3)
Overtime
Workers B:
Ordinary Wages:
(5: 2 : 3)
Working Notes:
1. Normal Wages are considered as basic wages
Overtime
10 hours
Cost Accounting
Question 14
Wage negotiations are going on with the recognized Labour Union and the Management wants you
as the Cost Accountant of the Company to formulate an incentive scheme with a view to increase
productivity.
The case of three typical workers Achyuta, Ananta and Govinda who produce respectively 180,
120 and 100 units of the companys product in a normal day of 8 hours is taken up for study.
Assuming that day wages would be guaranteed at 75 paise per hour and the piece rate would be
based on a standard hourly output of 10 units calculate the earnings of each of the three workers
and the labour cost per 100 pieces under (i) Day wages, (ii) Piece rate, (iii) Halsey, scheme and
(iv) The Rowan scheme.
Also calculate under the above schemes the average cost of labour for the company to produce
100 pieces.
Answer
Calculation of earnings of each of
the three workers and the labour cost per 100 piece under different wage schemes
(i) Day wages
Name of workers
Day wages
Actual output
(units)
100 pieces
Rs.
Rs.
Achyuta
6.00
180
3.33
Ananta
6.00
120
5.00
Govinda
6.00
100
6.00
18.00
400
Total
3.14
Labour
(ii) Piece rate
Name of workers
Actual
Piece
Wages
Output
rate
earned
100 pieces
(units)
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Achyuta
180
0.075
13.50
7.50
Ananta
120
0.075
9.00
7.50
Govinda
100
0.075
7.50
7.50
Total
400
30.00
Rs.30
100 Rs.7.50
400
Actual
Std. Time
Actual
Time
Bonus
Total
Labour
Workers
output
for actual
time
saved
Hrs.
Wages
cost per
(units)
output
for
Hrs.
(50% of
inclu-
100
Hrs.
actual
time
ding
pieces
Output
saved)
Bonus*
Hrs.
Hrs.
Rs.
Rs.
Achyuta
180
18
10
9.75
5.42
Ananta
120
12
7.50
6.25
Govinda
100
10
6.75
6.75
24.00
Average cost of labour for the
Company to produce 100 pieces = (Rs. 24/400) 100 = Rs. 6.00
*Total wages = (Actual hours worked + Bouus hours) Rate per hour
Hence total wages of Achyuta are : (8 + 5) Rs. 0.75 = Rs. 9.75
Similarly, the total wages of Ananta and Govinda are Rs. 7.50 and Rs. 6.75 respectively.
3.15
Cost Accounting
(iv) Rowan Scheme
Name of
Actual
Std.
Actual
Time
Bonus*
Wages
Bonus
Total
Labour
workers
output
Time for
time
saved
hours
for
@ 0.75
earning
cost per
actual
taken in
(hours)
output
hours
(units)
(hours)
actual
per
100
hrs. @
Bonus
pieces
0.75 P.
hour
per hour
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
7+8=(9)
(10)
Achyuta
180
18
10
4.44
6.00
3.33
9.33
5.18
Ananta
120
12
2.67
6.00
2.00
8.00
6.67
Govinda
100
10
1.6
6.00
1.20
7.20
7.20
24.53
Rs.24.53
100 Rs.6.13
400
Time saved
Standard time
Similarly, bonus hours of Ananta and Govinda are 2.67 hours and 1.6 hours respectively.
Question 15
(a) Bonus paid under the Halsey Plan with Bonus at 50% for the time saved equals the bonus
paid under the Rowan System. When will this statement hold good? (Your answer should
contain the proof).
(b) The time allowed for a job is 8 hours. The hourly rate is Rs. 8. Prepare a statement showing:
(i)
(ii)
.. (i)
3.16
Labour
Bonus under Rowan Plan
= Standard wage rate
Time saved
Time allowed
50
Time saved
100
or
Time saved
xTime taken
Time allowed
1
Time taken
2 Time allowed
1
of Time allowed
2
or Time taken =
Hence, when the time taken is 50% of the time allowed the bonus under Halsey and Rowan Plans
is equal.
Statement of Bonus, Total earnings of Labour and hourly earnings
under Halsey and Rowan Systems
Time
allowed
Time
taken
Time
saved
Basic
Wages
B Rs. 8
Bonus under
Halsey system
C
50
Bonus
under
Rowan
System
Rs.8
100
B Rs.8
Total
earnings
under
Halsey
System
D+E
Total
earnings
under
Rowan
System
D+F
Hourly
earnings
under
Halsey
System
G/B
Hourly
earnings
under
Rowan
System
H/B
C=(A-B)
hours
Hours
hours
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
64
64
64
8.00
8.00
56
60
63
8.57
9.00
48
12
56
60
9.33
10.00
40
12
15
52
55
10.40
11.00
32
16
16
48
48
12.00
12.00
24
20
15
44
39
14.67
13.00
16
24
12
40
28
20.00
14.00
28
36
15
36.00
15.00
3.17
Cost Accounting
Question 16
Mr. A is working by employing 10 skilled workers. He is considering the introduction of some
incentive scheme either Halsey Scheme (with 50% bonus) or Rowan Scheme of wage payment
for increasing the labour productivity to cope with the increased demand for the product by 25%.
He feels that if the proposed incentive scheme could bring about an average 20% increase over
the present earnings of the workers, it could act as sufficient incentive for them to produce more
and he has accordingly given this assurance to the workers.
As a result of the assurance, the increase in productivity has been observed as revealed by the
following figures for the current month:
Hourly rate of wages (guaranteed)
Rs. 2.00
Average time for producing 1 piece by one workers at the previous performance
2 hours
25
1,250 units
Required:
1.
Calculate effective rate of earnings per hour under Halsey Scheme and Rowan Scheme.
2.
Calculate the savings to Mr. A in terms of direct labour cost per piece under the schemes.
3.
Advise Mr. A about the selection of the scheme to fulfill his assurance.
Answer
Working Notes:
1. Total time wages of 10 workers per month:
= No. of working days in the month No. of working hours per day of each
worker Hourly rate of wages No. of workers
Rs. 4,000
2 hours
1,250 pieces
2,500 hours
3.18
Labour
Actual time taken to produce 1,250 pieces:
Time saved (2,500 hours 2,000 hours)
2,000 hours
500 hours
50
x 500 hours x Rs.2 Rs.500
100
Total wages to be paid to 10 workers are (Rs. 4,000 + Rs. 500) Rs. 4,500, if Mr. A considers the
introduction of Halsey Incentive Scheme to increase the labour productivity.
4. Bonus under Rowan Scheme to be paid to 10 workers:
Bonus =
=
Time saved
xTime wages
Total time allowed
500 hours
x Rs.4,000 Rs.800
2,500 hours
Total wages to be paid to 10 workers are (Rs. 4,000 + Rs. 800) Rs. 4,800, if Mr. A considers the
introduction of Rowan Incentive Scheme to increase the labour productivity.
1.
(i)
Total time wages of 10 wor ker s Total bonus under Halsey scheme
Total hours worked
Rs.4,000 Rs.500
Rs. 2.25
2,000 hours
2.
Total time wages of 10 wor ker s Total honus under Rowan scheme
Total hours worked
(i) Saving in terms of direct labour cost per piece under Halsey scheme:
(Refer to Working Note 3)
Labour cost per piece (under time wage scheme) = 2 hours Rs. 2 = Rs. 4
3.19
Cost Accounting
Labour cost per piece (under Halsey scheme)
=
Rs. 4,500
Rs. 3.60
1,250
Saving in terms of direct labour cost per piece under Rowan scheme:
(Refer to Working Note 4)
Labour cost per piece under Rowan scheme =
Rs. 4,800
= Rs. 3.84
1,250
From the labour cost per piece under Halsey scheme (Rs. 3.60) and Rowan scheme (Rs.
3.84), it is quite clear that Halsey scheme brings about more saving than Rowan scheme to
the concern. But Halsey scheme does not fulfils the assurance given to the workers about
500
20% increase in their earnings as it secures only 12.5%
100 increase. On the
4,000
800
other hand, Rowan scheme secures 20%
100 increase in the earnings and it
4,000
fulfils the assurance. Therefore, Rowan scheme may be adopted.
Question 17
A factory having the latest sophisticated machines wants to introduce an incentive scheme for its
workers, keeping in view the following:
(i)
(ii)
(iii) The rate setting department being newly established are liable to commit mistakes.
You are required to devise a suitable incentive scheme and demonstrate by an illustrative
numerical example how your scheme answers to all the requirements of the management.
Answer
Rowan scheme of premium bonus (variable sharing plan) is a suitable incentive scheme for the
workers of the factory. If this scheme is adopted, the entire gains due to time saved by a worker will
not pass to him.
3.20
Labour
Another feature of this scheme is that a worker cannot increase his earnings or bonus by merely
increasing its work speed. The reason for this is that the bonus under Rowan Scheme is maximum
when the time taken by a worker on a job is half of the time allowed. As this fact is known to the
workers, therefore they work at such a speed which helps them to maintain the quality of output
too.
Lastly, Rowan System provides a safeguard in case of any loose fixation of the standards by the
rate setting department. It may be observed from the following illustration that in the Rowan
Scheme the bonus paid will be low due to any loose fixation of standards. Workers cannot take
undue advantage of such a situation. The above three features of Rowan Plan can be discussed
with the help of the following illustration:
Illustration
(i)
Time allowed
4 hours
Time taken
3 hours
Time Saved
1 hour
Rate
Bonus
Time taken
Time saved Rate
Time allowed
3 hours
1 hour Rs. 5 = Rs. 3.75
4 hours
In the above illustration time saved is 1 hour and therefore total gain is Rs. 5. Out of
Rs. 5/- according to Rowan Plain only Rs. 3.75 is given to the worker in the form of bonus. In other
words a worker is entitled for 75 percent of the time saved in the form of bonus.
(ii)
The figures of bonus in the above illustration when the time taken is 2 hours and 1 hours
Bonus
Time taken
Time saved Rate
Time allowed
2 hours
2 hours Rs. 5 = Rs. 5
4 hours
1 hour
3 hours Rs. 5 = Rs. 3.75
4 hours
3.21
Cost Accounting
The above figures of bonus clearly shows that when time taken is half of the time allowed, the
bonus is maximum. When the time is reduced from 2 to 4 hours, the bonus figures fell by Rs.1.25.
Hence, it is quite apparent to workers that it is of no use to increase speed of work. This features of
Rowan Plan thus protects the quality of output.
(iii) If the rate setting department erroneously sets the time allowed as 10 hours instead of 4
hours, in the above illustration, then the bonus paid will be as follows:
Bonus =
3 hours
7 hours Rs. 5 = Rs. 10.5
10 hours
The bonus paid for saving 7 hours thus is Rs. 10.50 which is approximately equal to the wages of 2
hours. In other words the bonus paid to the workers is low. Hence workers cannot take undue
advantage of any mistake committed by the rate setting department of the concern.
Question 18
Distinguish between Job Evaluation and Merit Rating.
Answer
Distinguish between Job Evaluation and Merit Rating
Job evaluation: It can be defined as the process of analysis and assessment of jobs to ascertain
reliably their relative worth and to provide management with a reasonably sound basis for
determining the basic internal wage and salary structure for the various job positions. In other
words, job evaluation provides a rationale for differential wages and salaries for different groups of
employees and ensures that these differentials are consistent and equitable.
Merit rating: It is a systematic evaluation of the personality and performance of each employee by
his supervisor or some other qualified person.
The main points of distinction between job evaluation and merit rating are as follows:
1.
Job evaluation is the assessment of the relative worth of jobs within a company and merit
rating is the assessment of the relative worth of the man behind a job. In other words, job
evaluation rate the jobs while merit rating rate employees on these jobs.
2.
Job evaluation and its accomplishment are means to set up a rational wage and salary
structure whereas merit rating provides scientific basis for determining fair wages for each
worker based on his ability and performance.
3.
Job evaluation simplifies wage administration by bringing a uniformity in wage rates. On the
other hand, merit rating is used to determine fair rate of pay for different workers on the basis
of their performance.
3.22
Labour
Question 19
What do you mean by time and motions study? Why is it so important to management?
Answer
Time and motions study: It is the study of time taken and motions (movements) performed by
workers while performing their jobs at the place of their work. Time and motion study has played a
significant role in controlling and reducing labour cost.
Time Study is concerned with the determination of standard time required by a person of average
ability to perform a job. Motion study, on the other hand, is concerned with determining the proper
method of performing a job so that there are no wasteful movements, hiring the worker
unnecessarily. However, both the studies are conducted simultaneously. Since materials, tools,
equipment and general arrangement of work, all have vital bearing on the method and time
required for its completion. Therefore, their study would be incomplete and would not yield its full
benefit without a proper consideration of these factors.
Time and motion study is important to management because of the following features:
1.
Improved methods, layout, and design of work ensures effective use of men, material and
resources.
2.
Unnecessary and wasteful methods are pin-pointed with a view to either improving them or
eliminating them altogether. This leads to reduction in the work content of an operation,
economy in human efforts and reduction of fatigue.
3.
4.
Provides information for setting labour standards - a step towards labour cost control and cost
reduction.
5.
Useful for fixing wage rates and introducing effective incentive scheme.
Question 20
Discuss the treatment of overtime premium in Cost accounting.
Answer
Treatment of Overtime Premium in Cost Accounting
If overtime is resorted to at the desire of the customer, then overtime premium may be
charged to the job directly.
If overtime is required to cope with general production programme or for meeting urgent
orders, the overtime premium should be treated as overhead cost of the particular department
or cost center, which works overtime.
3.23
Cost Accounting
If overtime is worked in a department, due to the fault of another department, the overtime
premium should be charged to the latter department.
Overtime worked on account of abnormal conditions such as flood, earthquake etc., should
not be charged to cost but to costing P/L A/c.
Question 21
ZED Limited is working by employing 50 skilled workers it is considered the introduction of
incentive scheme-either Halsey scheme (with 50% bonus) or Rowan scheme of wage payment for
increasing the labour productivity to cope up the increasing demand for the product by 40%. It is
believed that proposed incentive scheme could bring about an average 20% increase over the
present earnings of the workers; it could act as sufficient incentive for them to produce more.
Because of assurance, the increase in productivity has been observed as revealed by the figures
for the month of April, 2004.
Hourly rate of wages (guaranteed)
Rs. 30
Average time for producing one unit by one worker at the previous
1.975 hours
24
8
6,120 units
Required:
(i)
Calculate the effective rate of earnings under the Halsey scheme and the Rowan scheme.
(ii)
Calculate the savings to the ZED Limited in terms of direct labour cost per piece.
(iii) Advise ZED Limited about the selection of the scheme to fulfill their assurance.
Answer
Working notes:
1.
3.24
Labour
2.
Computation of bonus for time saved hours under Halsey and Rowan schemes:
Time saved hours
2,487 hours
Rs. 30
Rs. 37,305
Time saved
Time taken Rate per hour
Time allowed
2,487 hours
9,600 hours Rs.30
12,087
Rs. 59,258.38 P.
(i)
Computation of effective rate of earnings under the Halsey and Rowan schemes:
Total earnings (under Halsey scheme)
Rs. 3,47,258.38
Rs. 33.89
Rs. 36.17
Savings to the ZED Ltd., in terms of direct labour cost per piece:
Rs.
3.25
59.25
Cost Accounting
Direct labour cost (per unit) under Halsey Plan
53.15
56.74
Halsey Plan
Rs. 6.10
Rowan Plan
Rs. 2.51
(Rs. 59.25-56.74)
(iii) Advise to ZED Ltd.: (about the selection of the scheme to fulfill assurance)
Halsey scheme brings more savings to the management of ZED Ltd., over the present earnings of
Rs. 2,88,000 but the other scheme viz Rowan fulfils the promise of 20% increase over the present
earnings of Rs. 2,88,000 by paying 20.58% in the form of bonus. Hence Rowan Plan may be
adopted.
Question 22
A Company is undecided as to what kind of wage scheme should be introduced. The following
particulars have been compiled in respect of three systems, which are under consideration of the
management.
Workers
Actual hours worked in a week
38
40
34
Rs. 6
Rs. 5
Rs. 7.20
Product P
21
60
Product Q
36
135
Product R
46
25
12
18
30
3.26
Labour
Minutes
For the purpose of piece rate, each minute is valued at Rs. 0.10
You are required to calculate the wages of each worker under:
(i)
(ii)
Piece work earnings basis, but guaranteed at 75% of basic pay (guaranteed hourly rate) if his
earnings are less than 50% of basic pay.
(iii) Premium bonus basis where the worker receives bonus based on Rowan scheme.
Answer
(i)
Workers
Actual hours
worked in a week
(a)
(b)
(c)
A
B
C
38
40
34
6.00
5.00
7.20
228.00
200.00
244.80
(ii) Computation of wages of each worker under piece work earnings basis
Worker A
Product Piece rate
Units
Worker B
Wages
Units
Worker C
Wages
Units
Wages
per unit
(Refer to working note 1)
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(g)
1.20
21
25.20
60
72
1.80
36
64.80
135
243
3.00
46
138.00
25
75
Since each worker has been guaranteed at 75% of basic pay, if his earnings are less than 50% of
basic pay, therefore, workers A and C will be paid the wages as computed viz., Rs. 228 and Rs.
315 respectively. The computed wage of worker B is Rs. 75 which is less than 50% of basic pay
viz., Rs. 100 therefore he would be paid 75% Rs. 200 or s. 150.
3.27
Cost Accounting
Working Notes:
1. Piece rate / per unit
2.
Product
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d) = (b) c
P
Q
R
12
18
30
0.10
0.10
0.10
1.20
1.80
3.00
Worker B =
Worker C =
(iv) Computation of wages of each worker under Premium bonus basis (where each worker
receives bonus based on Rowan Scheme)
Workers
A
B
C
Time
allowed
hours
(Refer to
W. Note 2)
Time
taken
hours
38.00
12.50
52.50
38.00
40.00
34.00
Time
saved
hours
Wage
rate/hour
Earnings
Bonus
Rs.
Rs.
228.00
200.00
244.80
86.26
Rs.
18.50
6.00
5.00
7.20
Total of
earning &
bonus
Rs.
228.00
200.00
331.06
Question 23
What do you understand by labour turnover? How is it measured?
Answer
Labour turnover in an organization is the rate of change in the composition of labour force during a
specified period measured against a suitable index. The standard of usual labour turnover in the
3.28
Labour
industry or labour turnover rate for a past period may be taken as the index or norm against which
actual turnover rate should be compared.
The methods for measuring labour turnover are:
Replacement method =
Separation method
Question 24
A skilled worker in XYZ Ltd. Is paid a guaranteed wage rate of Rs. 30 per hour. The standard time
per unit for a particular product is 4 hours. P, a machineman, has been paid wages under the
Rowan Incentive Plan and he had earned an effective hourly
rate of Rs. 37.50 on the
manufacture of that particular product.
What could have been his total earnings and effective hourly rate, had he been put on Halsey
Incentive Scheme (50%)?
Answer
Working note:
Let T hours be the total time worked in hours by the skilled worker (machineman P); Rs 30/- is the
rate per hour; standard time is 4 hours per unit and effective hourly earning rate is Rs. 37.50 then
Earning = Hours worked Rate per hour +
Time saved
Time taken Rate per hour
Time allowed
(4 - T)
T Rs. 30 = Rs.105
4
Rs. 37.5
Or Rs. 7.5 T
= Rs. 22.5
Or T
= 3 hours
Total earnings and effective hourly rate of skilled worker (machineman P) under Halsey
Incentive Scheme (50%)
Total earnings = Hours worked Rate per hour + Time saved Rate per hour
3.29
Cost Accounting
(under 50% Halsey Incentive Scheme)
= 3 hours Rs. 30 + 1 hour Rs. 30
Effective hourly rate =
Question 25
From the following information, calculate Labour turnover rate and Labour flux rate:
No. of workers as on 0.01.2000 = 7, 600
No. of workers as on 31.12.2000 = 8,400
During the year, 80 workers left while 320 workers were discharged 1,500 workers were recruited
during the year of these, 300 workers were recruited because of exits and the rest were recruited in
accordance with expansion plans.
Answer
Labour turnover rate:
It comprises of computation of labour turnover by using following methods:
(i)
(ii)
Separation Method:
=
(80 320)
x100
(7,600 8,400) 2
400
x100 =5%
8,000
Replacement Method:
=
300
x100 = 3.75%
8000
3.30
Labour
1, 200
100 = 15%
8,000
Flux Method:
No. of separations + No. of accessions
100
Average number of wor ker s
(400 1500)
100
(7,600 8, 400) 2
1,900
100 = 23.75%
8,000
Question 26
Discuss the two types of cost associated with labour turnover.
Answer
Types of cost associated with labour turnover
Two types of costs which are associated with labour turnover are:
(i)
Preventive costs: These includes costs incurred to keep the labour turnover at a low level i.e.,
cost of medical schemes. If a company incurs high preventive costs, the rate of labour
turnover is usually low.
(ii)
Replacement costs: These are the costs which arise due to high labour turnover. If men leave
soon after they acquire the necessary training and experience of work, additional costs will
have to be incurred on new workers, i.e., cost of advertising, recruitment, selection, training
and induction, extra cost also incurred due to abnormal breakage of tools and machines,
defectives, low output, accidents etc., caused due to the inefficiency and inexperienced new
workers.
It is obvious that a company will incur very high replacement costs if the rate of labour
turnover is high. Similarly, only adequate preventive costs can keep labour turnover at a low
level. Each company must, therefore, workout the optimum level of labour turnover keeping in
view its personnel policies and the behaviour of replacement costs and preventive costs at
various levels of labour turnover rates.
Question 27
The management of a company are worried about their increasing labour turnover in factory and
before analyzing the causes and taking remedial steps, they want to have idea of the profit
foregone as a result of labour turnover in the last year.
3.31
Cost Accounting
Last year sales amounted to Rs. 83,03,300 and the profit-volume ratio was 20 per cent. Total
number of actual hours worked by the Direct Labour Force was 4.45 lakhs. As a result of the
delays by the Personnel Department in filling vacancies due to labour turnover, 1,00,000 potentially
productive hours were lost. The actual direct labour hours includes 30,000 hours attributable to
training new recruits, out of which half of the hours were unproductive.
The costs incurred consequent on labour turnover revealed on analysis the following:
Rs.
Settlement costs due to leaving
43,820
Recruitment costs
26,740
Selection costs
12,750
Training costs
30,490
Assuming that the potential production lost as a consequence of labour turnover could have been
sold at prevailing prices, find the profit foregone last year on account of labour turnover.
(Nov., 2004, 8 marks)
Answer
Working notes:
1.
4,45,000
15,000
4,30,000
Rs. 19.309
4.
1,00,000
19,31,000
3,86,000
3.32
Labour
Statement of Profit foregone last year
on account of Labour Turnover
Contribution foregone
3,86,000
43,820
Recruitment costs
26,740
Selection costs
12,750
Training costs
30,490
5,00,000
Question 28
State the distinction between Job evaluation and Merit rating.
Answer
Distinction between Job evaluation and Merit rating:
Job evaluation can be defined as the process of analysis and assessment of jobs to ascertain
reliably their relative worth and to provide management with a reasonably sound basis for
determining the basic internal wage and salary structure for the various job positions. In other
words, job evaluation provides a rationale for differential wages and salaries for different group of
employees and ensures that these differentials are consistent and equitable.
Merit rating is the quantitative or qualitative assessment of an employees personality or his
performance on the job made by his supervisor or other person qualified to judge.
The main points of distinction between job evaluation and merit rating are as follows:
1.
Job evaluation is the assessment of the relative worth of jobs within a company and merit
rating is the assessment of the relative worth of the man behind a job. In other words, merit
rating rates employees on their job while job evaluation rate the jobs.
2.
Job evaluation and its accomplishments are meant to set up a rational wage and salary
structure whereas merit rating provides a scientific basis for determining fair wages for each
worker based on his ability and performance.
3.
Job evaluation simplifies wage administration by bringing a uniformity in wage rates. On the
other hand, merit rating is used to determine fair rate of pay for different workers on the basis
of their performance.
3.33
Cost Accounting
Question 29
The finishing shop of a company employs 60 direct workers. Each worker is paid Rs. 400 as wages
per week of 40 hours. When necessary, overtime is worked upto a maximum of 15 hours per week
per worker at time rate plus one-half as premium. The current output on an average is 6 units per
man hour which may be regarded as standard output. If bonus scheme is introduced, it is expected
that the output will increase to 8 units per man hour. The workers will, if necessary, continue to
work Overtime upto the specified limit although no premium on incentives will be paid.
The company is considering introduction of either Halsey Scheme or Rowan Scheme of Wage
Incentive system. The budgeted weekly output is 19,200 units. The selling price is
Rs. 11 per unit and the direct Material Cost is Rs. 8 per unit. The variable overheads amount to Rs.
0.50 per direct labour hour and the fixed overhead is Rs, 9,000 per week.
Prepare a Statement to show the effect on the Companys weekly Profit of the proposal to
introduce (a) Halsey Scheme, and (b) Rowan Scheme.
Answer
Working notes:
1.
2,400
3,200
2,400
800
10
Bonus:
(i) Halsey Scheme =
=
1
Time saved Wage rate per hour
2
1
x 800 hours x Rs. 10 = Rs. 4,000
2
3.34
Labour
Time saved
Time taken Wage rate per hour
Time allowed
800 hours
=
2,400 hours Rs. 10
3,200 hours
= Rs. 6,000
Statement showing the effect on the Companys Weekly
present profit by the introduction of Halsey & Rowan schemes
Present
Halsey
Rowan
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
2,11,200
2,11,200
2,11,200
1,53,600
1,53,600
1,53,600
32,000
24,000
24,000
(3,200 hrs.
2,400 hrs.
(2,400 hrs.
Rs. 10)
Rs. 10)
Rs. 10)
4,000
4,000
6,000
1,600
1,200
1,200
(3,200 hrs.
(2,400 hrs.
(2,400 hrs.
0.50 P)
0.50 P)
0.50 P)
9,000
9,000
9,000
2,00,200
1,91,800
1,93,800
11,000
19,400
17,400
(800 hrs.
Rs. 5)
Bonus
(Refer to working notes 6 (i) & (ii))
Variable overheads
Fixed overheads
Question 30
The management of In and Out Ltd., are worried about their increasing labour turnover in the
factory and before analyzing the causes and taking remedial steps, they want to have an idea of
the profit foregone as a result of labour turnover in the last year.
3.35
Cost Accounting
Last year sales amounted to Rs. 83,03,300 and the P/V ratio was 20 per cent. The total number of
actual hours worked by the Direct Labour force was 4.45 lakhs. As a result of the delays by the
Personnel Department in filling vacancies due to labour turnover, 1,00,000 potentially productive
hours were lost. The actual direct labour hours included 30,000 hours attributable to training new
recruits, out of which half of the hours were unproductive.
The costs incurred consequent on labour turnover revealed on analysis the following:
Rs.
Settlement cost due to leaving
43,820
Recruitment costs
26,740
Selection costs
12,750
Training costs
30,490
Assuming that the potential production lost as a consequence of Labour Turnover could have been
sold at prevailing prices, find the profit foregone last year on account of labour turnover.
Answer
Statement of Profit Foregone last year on account of
labour turnover of In and Out Ltd.
Rs.
Contribution foregone
3,86,200
(See Notes 1 to 4)
Settlement cost due to leaving
43,820
Recruitment Costs
26,740
Selection Costs
12,750
Training Costs
30,490
5,00,000
Working Notes:
1.
4,45,000
15,000
4,30,000
3.36
Labour
2.
Sales
Rs. 83,03,300
4,30,000 hours
Rs.
83,03,300
= Rs.19.30
4,30,000
4.
Question 31
The standard hours of job X is 100 hours. The job has been completed by Amar in 60 hours, Akbar
in 70 hours and Anthony in 95 hours.
The bonus system applicable to the job is as follows:Percentage of time saved to time allowed
Bonus
The rate of pay is Re. 1 per hour, Calculate the total earnings of each worker and also the rate of
earnings per hour.
(a)
Amar
Akbar
Anthony
100 hours
100 hours
100 hours
60 hours
70 hours
95 hours
Time saved
40 hours
30 hours
5 hours
40%
30%
5%
6.5 hours
4.5 hours
0.5 hours
3.37
Cost Accounting
Total hours to be paid [(i) + (ii)]
Total earning @ Re. 1/- p.h.
Rate of earning per hour (See Note 2)
66.5 hours
74.5 hours
95.5 hours
Rs. 66.5
Rs. 74.5
Rs. 95.5
Rs. 1.1083
Rs. 1.0642
Rs. 1.005
Note:
1.
Total earning
Total time taken on the job
Amar:
Rs. 66.5
= Rs. 1.1038
60 hours
Rs. 74.5
= Rs. 1.0642
70 hours
Anthony :
Rs. 95.50
= Rs. 1.005
95 hours
Akbar
Question 32
Distinguish between Direct and Indirect labour.
Answer
Direct labour cost is the labour costs that is specifically incurred for or can be readily charged to or
identified with a specific job, contract, work-order or any other unit of cost.
Indirect labour costs are labour costs which cannot be readily identified with products or services
but are generally incurred in carrying out production activity.
The importance of the distinction lies in the fact that whereas direct labour cost can be identified
with and charged to the job, indirect labour costs cannot be so charged and are, therefore, to be
treated as part of the factory overheads to be included in the cost of production.
3.38
Labour
Question 33
What do you understand by overtime premium? What is the effect of overtime payment on
productivity and cost? Discuss the treatment of overtime premium in cost accounts and suggest a
procedure for control of overtime work.
Answer
Work done beyond normal working hours is known as overtime work. Overtime payment is the
amount of wages paid for working beyond normal working hours. The rate for overtime work is
higher than the normal time rate; usually it is at double the normal rates. The extra amount so paid
over the normal rate is called overtime premium. Overtime work should be resorted to only when it
is extremely essential because it involves extra cost. The overtime payment affects to increase the
cost of production in the following ways:
(2) The premium paid is an extra payment in addition to the normal rate.
(3) The efficiency of operators during overtime work may fall and thus the output may be lesser
than normal output.
(4) In order to earn more the workers may not concentrate on work during normal time and thus
the output during normal hours may also fall.
(5) Reduced output and increased premium will bring about an increase in costs of production.
Under cost accounting the overtime premium is treated as follows:
(i)
If overtime is resorted to, at the desire of the customer, then overtime premium may be
charged to the job directly.
(ii)
If overtime is due to a general pressure of work to increase the output, the premium may
be charged to general overheads.
(iii) If overtime is due to the negligence or delay, it may be charged to the department
concerned.
(iv) If it is due to circumstances beyond control, e.g. fire, strike etc. it may be charged to
Costing Profit and Loss Account.
It is necessary that proper Control over the overtime work should be exercised in order to
keep it to the minimum. The procedure based on following steps may be adopted for such
control.
(1) Watch on the output during normal hours should be maintained to ensure that overtime
is not granted when normal output is not obtained during the normal hours, without any
special reasons.
3.39
Cost Accounting
(2) Statement concerning overtime work be prepared along with justifications, at
appropriate places for putting up before competent authority.
(3) Prior sanction about overtime should be obtained from competent authority.
(4) Actual rate of output produced during the overtime period should be compared with
normal rate of output.
(5) Periodical reports on overtime wages should be sent to top management for taking
corrective action
(6) If possible an upper limit may be fixed for each category of worker in respect of
overtime.
Question 34
During audit of accounts of G. Company, your assistant found errors in the calculation of the wages
of factory workers and he wants you to verify his work.
He has extracted the following information:
(i)
The contract provides that the minimum wage for a worker is his base rate. It is also paid for
downtimes i.e. the machine is under repair or the worker is without work. The standard work
week is 40 hours. For overtime production, workers are paid 150 per cent of base rates.
(ii)
Straight Piece Work-The worker is paid at the rate of 20 paise per piece.
(iii) Percentage Bonus Plan- Standard quantities of production per hour are established by the
engineering department. The workers average hourly production, determined from his total
hours worked and his production, is divided by the standard quantity of production to
determine his efficiency ratio. The efficiency ratio is then applied to his base rate to determine
his hourly earnings for the period.
(iv) Emerson Efficiency Plan- A minimum wages is paid for production upto 66-2/3% of standard
output or efficiency. When the workers production exceeds 66-2/3% of the standard output,
he is paid bonus as per the following table:
Efficiency Level
Bonus
2
Upto 66 %
3
Nil
2
Above 66 % to 79%
3
10%
80% - 99%
20%
100% - 125%
45%
3.40
Labour
Your assistant has produced the following schedule pertaining to certain workers of a weekly pay
roll:
Workers
Wage Incentive
Plan
Total
Hours
Units
Standard
Produced
Units
Down
Time
Hours
Base
Rate
Gross
Wages as
per Book
Rs.
Rs.
Rajesh
40
400
1.80
85
Mohan*
46
455
1.80
95
John
44
425
1.80
85
Harish
Percentage bonus
plan
40
250
200
2.20
120
Mahesh
Emerson
40
240
300
2.10
93
Anil
Emerson
40
600
500
2.00
126
Rajesh
Minimum
wages
Gross
wages
computed
as per
incentive
plan
Gross
wage as
per book
Wages to be
paid are
Maximum of:
minimum and
gross computed
wages
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
72.00
80.00
85
80.00
88.20
91.00
95
91.00
82.80
85.00
85
85.00
(Refer to W. Note 1)
Mohan
(Refer to W. Note 2)
John
(Refer to W. Note 3)
3.41
Cost Accounting
Harish
Percentage bonus
(Refer to W. Note 4)
plan
Mahesh
88.00
110.00
120
110.00
Emerson
84.00
100.80
93
100.80
Emerson
80.00
116.00
126
116.00
(Refer to W. Note 5)
Anil
(Refer to W. Note 6)
Working notes:
1.
Minimum wages
2.
Minimum wages
3.
Minimum wages
Minimum wages
Efficiency of worker
Hourly rate
3.42
Labour
5.
Minimum wages
Efficiency of worker
6.
Minimum wages
Efficiency of worker
Bonus (as per Emersons plan)
600
100 = 120%
500
Question 35
The existing Incentive system of Alpha Limited is as under:
Normal working week
Rate of Payment
:
:
:
:
3.43
Cost Accounting
Required:
(i)
Prepare a Statement showing hours worked, weekly earnings, number of articles produced
and labour cost per article for one operator under the following systems:
Rowan system
Weekly
earnings
Rs. 8,425.00
Rs. 8,640.00
Rs. 9,007.41
Rs. 8,600.00
Number of articles
produced
120
135
135
135
Hours
worked
49
40
40
40
labour cost
per article
Rs. 70.21
Rs. 64
Rs. 66.72
Rs. 63.70
= Rs. 6,400
= Rs. 2,025
Rs. 8,425
= Rs. 800
= Rs. 160
Rs. 960
Labour
Rowan Premium System
Basic Time
Add
50% to time
7.5 hours for 15 articles
Or
TA HW
Earnings = (HWRH) +
HW RH
TA
67.5 40
= (40 hrs Rs. 160) +
40 Rs. 160
67.5
= Rs. 9007.41
Halsey Premium System
Earnings = HWRH +
50
(TA HW) RH
100
= 40 Rs. 160
1
(67.5 40) Rs. 160
2
= Rs. 8,600.
Question 36
Under the Rowan Premium Bonus system, a less efficient worker can obtain same bonus as a
highly efficient worker. Discuss with suitable examples
Answer
Bonus under Rowan system =
Time taken
time saved rate per hour
Time allowed
For example let time allowed for a job = 4 hours and Labour rate = Rs. 5 per hour.
Case I : Less efficient worker
If time taken = 3 hours
Then time saved = 4 3 = 1 hour
Bonus =
3 hours
1 hour Rs. 5 Rs. 3.75
4 hours
3.45
Cost Accounting
Case II : Highly efficient worker
If time taken = 1 hour
Then time saved = 4 1 = 3 hours
Bonus =
1 hour
3 hours Rs. 5 Rs. 3.75
4 hours
So, it can be concluded that under Rowan System, the less efficient worker and highly efficient
worker can get the same bonus.
Question 37
Two workers A and B produce the same product using the same material. Their normal wage
rate is also the same. A is paid bonus according to Rowan scheme while B is paid bonus
according to Halsey scheme. The time allowed to make the product is 50 hours. A takes 30
hours while B takes 40 hours to complete the product. The factory overhead rate is Rs. 5 per
person-hour actually worked. The factory cost of product manufactured by A is Rs. 3,490 and for
product manufactured by B is Rs. 3,600.
Required:
(i)
(ii)
(iii) Prepare a statement comparing the factory cost of the product as made by two workers.
Answer
Let x be the cost of material and y be the normal rate of wage/hour
Worker A
Worker B
Rs.
Rs.
Material cost
Labour wages
30 y
40 y
Rowan system
Halsey system
Time saved
hour worked rate
Time allowed
20
30 y 12y
50
Overheads
30 5 = 150
40 5 = 200
Factory cost
Bonus
3.46
1
10 y 5y
2
Labour
Solving (1) and (2) we get
X = 2,500 and y = 20
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
Worker B
Rs.
Rs.
Material cost
2,500
2,500
Wages
30 20 = 600
40 20 = 800
Bonus
20
30 20 = 240
50
1
10 20 = 100
2
30 5 = 150
40 5 = 200
3,490
3,600
Overheads
Factory cost
Question 38
Discuss the three methods of calculating labour turnover.
Answer
Methods of calculating labour turnover
Number of employees replaced
(i) Replacement method
100
Average number of employees on roll
(ii)
Separation method
Workers joining a business concern on account of its expansion do not account for labour turnover.
Question 39
Calculate the total wages earned by a workman for a working day of 8 hours under Halsey and
Rowan Plans:
20 units
200 units
3.47
Cost Accounting
Answer
200
10 hours
20
(i)
Standard time
(ii)
8 30 +
Rs. 270.
50
(10 8) 30
100
10 8
= 8 30 +
8 30
10
Question 40
The following information is collected from the personnel department of ST limited for the year
ending 31st March, 2008:
Number of workers at the beginning of the year
8,000
Number of workers at the end of the year
9,600
Number of workers left the company during the year
500
Number of workers discharged during the year
100
Number of workers replaced due to left and discharges
700
Additional workers employed for expansion during the year
1,500
You are required to calculate labour turnover rate by using separation method, replacement
method and flux method
Answer
Calculation of labour turnover rate:
1.
Separation method:
Labour turnover rate
3.48
Labour
600
100
8,800
= 6.82%.
Average Number of workers separated during the year = Number of workers left the
company during the year +
Number of workers
discharged during the year
= 500 + 100 = 600.
Average number of workers on rolls during the year
2.
8,000 9,600
8,800
2
Replacement Method:
700
100
8,800
= 7.95%.
3.
Flux Method:
Number of workers separated Number of workers replaced
100
Average number of workers on rolls during the year
600 700
100
8,800
= 14.77%.
= Rs. 288.
Question 41
Using Taylors differential piece rate system, find the earning of A from the following particulars:
Standard time per piece
12 minutes
Rs. 20
A produced
37 Units
Answer
8 60
Standard output per day
40 units
12
3.49
Cost Accounting
Actual output
Efficiency percentage
= 37 units
37
100 92.5%
40
Under this method lower rate is 83% of the normal piece rate and is applicable if efficiency of
worker is below 100%.
Earning rate per unit = 83% of
20
or 3.32 per unit
5*
60 minutes
5 units
standard time per peice, i.e. 12 minutes
Question 42
Enumerate the various methods of Time booking
Answer
The various methods of time booking are:
(a) Job ticket.
(b) Combined time and job ticket.
(c)
Clock card.
Question 43
Enumerate the remedial steps to be taken to minimize the labour turnover.
Answer
The following steps are useful for minimizing labour turnover:
(a) Exit interview: An interview be arranged with each outgoing employee to ascertain the
reasons of his leaving the organization.
(b) Job analysis and evaluation: to ascertain the requirement of each job.
(c)
Organisation should make use of a scientific system of recruitment, placement and promotion
for employees.
3.50
Labour
(d) Organisation should create healthy atmosphere, providing education, medical and housing
facilities for workers.
(e) Committee for settling workers grievances.
Question 44
Standard output in 10 hours is 240 units; actual output in 10 hours is 264 units. Wages rate is Rs.
10 per hour. Calculate the amount of bonus and total wages under Emerson Plan.
Answer
Efficiency percentage =
264
100 110%
240
As per Emerson plan, in case of above 100% efficiency bonus of 20% of basic wages plus
1% for each 1% increase in efficiency is admissible.
So, new bonus percentage = 20 + (110 100) = 30
Total Bonus =
=
30
(hours worked rate per hour)
100
30
10 10 Rs. 30
100
3.51
Cost Accounting
(i)
(ii)
Gantt task and bonus system: As per this system a higher standard is set and payment is
made at time rate to a worker for production below the standard. If the standards are
achieved or exceeded, the payment is made at a higher piece rate. The piece rate fixed also
includes an element of bonus to the extent of 20%. Bonus is calculated over the time rate.
(ii)
Emersons Efficiency System: Under this system wages may be calculated as below:
Performance
Wages
Rowan System: As per this system standard time allowance is fixed for the performance of
a job and bonus is paid if time is saved.
Wages under Rowan System (Time taken rate per unit of time )
time saved
time allowed
Halsey System: Under this system a standard time is fixed for each job. If there is no
saving on this standard time allowance, the worker is paid only his day rate.
Wages under Halsey System = Time taken Time rate + (50% of time saved time rate)
(v)
Barth System:
Earnings under Barth System = Hourly rate Standard hours Hours worked
This is particularly suitable for trainees and beginners and also for unskilled workers
3.52
Labour
EXERCISE
Question 1
Distinguish between Idle Time and Idle Facilities. How are they treated in Cost Accounts? Develop
a system of control for Idle Time in a factory.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 2
What do you understand by Labour Turnover? How is it measured? What are its causes? What are
the remedial steps you would suggest to minimize its occurrence?
Labour Utilisation Statement
Department....
Ending.
Week
Standard Time
Sl.
Category
of
No.
Workers
Number
of hours
paid for
Output
in
Units
Time
Per
Unit of
Output
Standard
time for
Output
Idle
Time
(3-6)
Breakdown
Power
Failure
Lack of
Material
Lack of
planning
Set
up
time
Inefficiency
Etc.
10
11
12
13
14
Causes
Cost Accountant
Action taken .
..
Department Supdt.
3.53
Cost Accounting
Question 4
What are piece-rate? What advantage and disadvantages are attributed to their use? What
principles should govern the determination and revision of piece-rates?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 5
Define job evaluation and distinguish it from merit rating. Explain the methods and objectives of job
evaluation.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 6
What do you understand by time and motion study? Explain how standard time is set under time
study. State how time and motion study is useful to management.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 7
List down the factors to be considered before introducing a scheme of incentive to workers.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 8
Distinguish between Casual worker and Outworker
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 9
Discuss the three methods of calculating labour turnover
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 10
Discuss the Gantt task and bonus system as a system of wage payment and incentives.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 11
Discuss two types of Costs, which are associated with labour turnover
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 12
Discuss the accounting treatment of Idle time and overtime wages.
3.54
Labour
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 13
Discuss the effect of overtime payment on productivity
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 14
State the circumstances in which time rate system of wage payment can be preferred in a factory.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 15
Discuss briefly, how will you deal with casual workers and workers employed on outdoor work in
Cost Accounts.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 16
What is the impact of Labour Turnover on a manufacturing organisations working?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 17
In a unit, 10 men work as a group. When the production for the group exceeds the standard output
of 200 pieces per hour, each man is paid an incentive for the excess production in addition to his
wages at hourly rates. The incentive is at half the percentage, the excess production over the
standard bears to the standard production, Each man is paid an incentive at the rate of this
percentage of a wage rate of Rs. 2 per hour. There is no relation between the individual workmans
hourly rate and the bonus rate.
In a week, the hours worked are 500 hours and the total production is 1,20,000 pieces.
(a) Compute the total amount of the bonus for the week.
(b) Calculate the total earnings of two workers A and B of the group:A worked 44 hours and his basic rate per hour was Rs. 2.20.
B worked 48 hours and his basic rate per hour was Rs. 1.90.
Answer (a)
105.60
100.80
3.55
Cost Accounting
Question 18
What are the main features of Halsey and Rowan method of payment of remuneration? State how
Rowan Scheme is better than Halsey Scheme. Given time allowed of 30 hours for a job and the
wage rate of Re. 1.00 per hour, illustrate your answer by assuming your own figure for time taken
to do the job.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 19
The cost accountant of Y Ltd. has computed labour turnover rates for the quarter ended 31st
March, 1997 as 10%, 5% and 3% respectively under Flux method, Replacement method and
Separation method. If the number of workers replaced during that quarter is 30, find out the
number of (1) workers recruited and joined and (2) workers left and discharged.
Answer No. of workers recruited and joined 42
Number of workers left and discharged comes to 18.
Question 20
What is overtime premium? Explain the treatment of overtime premium in cost accounting. Suggest
steps for controlling overtime.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 21
Distinguish between Job Evaluation and Merit Rating
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 22
A worker produced 200 units in a weeks time. The guaranteed weekly wage payment for 45 hours
is Rs. 81. The expected time to produce one unit is 15 minutes which is raised further by 20%
under the incentive scheme. What will be the earnings per hour of that worker under Halsey (50%
sharing) and Rowan bonus schemes?
Answer Earning per hour under Halsey (50% sharing) Bonus Scheme Rs. 2.10 per hour
Earnings per hour under Rowan Bonus Scheme Rs. 2.25 per hour
Question 23
Write short note on Labour Turnover.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
3.56
Labour
Question 24
A job can be executed either through workman A or B. A takes 32 hours to complete the job while
B finishes it in 30 hours. The standard time to finish the job is 40 hours.
The hourly wage rate is same for both the workers. In addition workman A is entitled to receive
bonus according to Halsey plan (50%) sharing while B is paid bonus as per Rowan plan. The
works overheads are absorbed on the job at Rs. 7.50 per labour hour worked. The factory cost of
the job comes to Rs, 2,600 irrespective of the workman engaged.
Find out the hourly wage rate and cost of raw materials input. Also show cost against each element
of cost included in factory cost.
Answer The wage rate per hour is Rs. 10
The cost of raw material input is Rs. 2,000 on the job.
Question 25
The management of Sunshine Ltd. wants to have an idea of the profit lost/foregone as a result of
labour turnover last year.
Last year sales accounted to Rs. 66,000,000 and the P/V Ratio was 20%. The total number of
actual hours worked by the direct labour force was 3.45 lakhs. As a result of the delays by the
Personnel Department in filling vacancies due to labour turnover, 75,000 potential productive
hours were lost. The actual direct labour hours included 30,000 hours attributable to training new
recruits, out of which half of the hours were unproductive. The costs incurred consequent on labour
turnover reveled on analysis the following:
Rs.
Settlement cost due to leaving
27,420
Recruitment costs
18,725
Selection costs
12,750
Training costs
16,105
Assuming that the potential production lost due to labour turnover could have been sold at
prevailing prices, ascertain the profit foregone/lost last year on account of labour turnover.
Answer Total profit foregone (Rs.)
3,75,000
Question 26
Write Short note on Labour Turnover.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
3.57
Cost Accounting
Question 27
Calculate the earnings of workers A, B and C under Straight Piece Rate System and Merricks
Multiple Piece Rate System from the following particulars:
Normal Rate per Hour
Rs. 5.40
1 Minute
Rs. 35.10
Worker B =
Rs. 40.50
Worker C =
Rs. 54.00
35.10
44.55
C
64.80
Question 28
What do you understand by overtime premium? What is the effect of overtime payment on
productivity and cost? Discuss the treatment of overtime premium in cost accounts and suggest a
procedure for control of overtime work.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 3 i.e. Labour of Study Material
Question 29
Calculate the earnings of a worker under (i) Halsey Plan and (ii) Rowan Plan from the following
particulars:
(1) Hourly rate of wages guaranteed 0.50 paise per hour.
(2) Standard time for producing one dozen articles 3 hours.
(3) Actual time taken by the worker to produce 20 dozen articles 48 hours.
Answer (i)
3.58
Rs. 27
CHAPTER 4
OVERHEADS
BASIC CONCEPTS AND FORMULAE
Basic Concepts
1.
Overheads: Overheads represent expenses that have been incurred in providing certain
ancillary facilities or services which facilitate or make possible the carrying out of the
production process; by themselves these services are not of any use.
2.
3.
Fixed Overhead- Expenses that are not affected by any variation in the volume of
activity.
Semi variable- The expenses that do not change when there is a small change in
the level of activity but change whenever there is a slightly big change or change in
the same direction as change in the level of activity but not in the same proportion.
4.
Cost allocation- The term allocation refers to assignment or allotment of an entire item
of cost to a particular cost center or cost unit.
5.
6.
7.
Cost Accounting
8.
9.
Direct re-distribution method- Under this method service department costs are
apportioned over the production departments only, ignoring the services rendered
by one service department to the other.
Reciprocal Service Method- These methods are used when different service
departments render services to each other, in addition to rendering services to
production departments. In such cases various service departments have to share
overheads of each other. The methods available for dealing with reciprocal services
are
(a)
(b)
(c)
Percentage of direct materials method: Under this method, the cost of direct material
consumed is the base for calculating the amount of overhead absorbed.
b)
Percentage of prime cost method This method is based on the fact that both
materials as well as labour contribute in raising factory overheads. Hence, the
total of the two i.e. Prime cost should be taken as base for absorbing the
factory overhead.
c)
Percentage of direct labour cost : This method also fails to give full recognition to
the element of the time which is of prime importance in the accounting for and
treatment of manufacturing overhead expenses except in so far as the amount of
wages is a product of the rate factor multiplied by the time factor.
d)
e)
Machine hour rate method: By the machine hour rate method, manufacturing
overhead expenses are charged to production on the basis of number of hours
machines are used on jobs or work orders.
4.2
Overheads
10.
b)
c)
Blanket overhead rates- Blanket overhead rate refers to the computation of one
single overhead rate for the whole factory. It is to be distinguished from the
departmental overhead rate which refers to a separater
d)
Departmental overhead rate: Where the product lines are varied or machinery
is used to a varying degree in the different departments, that is, where conditions
throughout the factory are not uniform, the use of departmental rates is to be
preferred. ate for each individual cost centre or department.
Works cost
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
Quantity produced
(v)
Basic Formulas
1.
4.3
Cost Accounting
* The selected base can be the total output; total labour hours; machine hours etc.
Situation for using blanket rate:
The use of blanket rate may be considered appropriate for factories which produce only one
major product on a continuous basis. It may also be used in those units in which all products
utilise same amount of time in each department. If such conditions do not exist, the use of
blanket rate will give misleading results in the determination of the production cost , specially
when such a cost ascertainment is carried out for giving quotations and tenders.
Question 2
Answer
Step method and Reciprocal Service method of secondary distribution of overheads
Step method: This method gives cognisance to the service rendered by service department to
another service dept, thus sequence of apportionments has to be selected. The sequence
4.4
Overheads
here begins with the dept that renders service to the max number of other service dept. After
this, the cost of service dept serving the next largest number of dept is apportioned.
Reciprocal service method: This method recognises the fact that where there are two or more
service dept, they may render service to each other and, therefore, these inter dept services
are to be given due weight while re-distributing the expense of service dept. The methods
available for dealing with reciprocal servicing are:
Simultaneous equation method
Repeated distribution method
Trial and error method
Question 3
Answer
Treatment of under absorbed and over absorbed factory overheads in cost accounting.
Factory overheads are usually applied to production on the basis pre-determined rate
=
The possible options for treating under / over absorbed overheads are
Use supplementary rate in the case of substantial amount of under / over absorption
Write it off to the costing profit & loss account in the event of insignificant amount /
or abnormal reasons.
Carry toward to accounting period if operating cycle exceeds one year.
Question 4
Discuss the problems of controlling the selling and distribution overheads
Answer
Problems of controlling the selling & distribution overheads are
(i)
The incidence of selling & distribution overheads depends on external factors such as
distance of market, nature of competition etc. which are beyond the control of
management.
Cost Accounting
The above problems of controlling selling & distribution overheads can be tackled by
adopting the following steps:
(a) Comparing the figures of selling & distribution overhead with the figures of previous
period.
(b) Selling & distribution overhead budgets may be used to control such overhead
expenses by making a comparison of budgetary figures with actual figures of
overhead expenses, ascertaining variances and finally taking suitable actions,
(c) Standards of selling & distribution expenses may be set up for salesmen, territories,
products etc. The laid down standards on comparison with actual overhead
expenses will reveal variances, which can be controlled by suitable action.
Question 5
Distinguish between cost allocation and cost absorption
Answer
Cost allocation and Cost absorption:
Cost allocation is the allotment of whole item of cost to a cost centre or a cost unit. In other words,
it is the process of identifying, assigning or allowing cost to a cost centre or a cost, unit.
Cost absorption is the process of absorbing all indirect costs or overhead costs allocated to
apportioned over particular cost center or production department by the units produced.
Question 6
Discuss in brief three main methods of allocating support departments costs to operating
departments. Out of these three, which method is conceptually preferable.
Answer
The three main methods of allocating support departments costs to operating departments
are:
(i)
Direct re-distribution method: Under this method, support department costs are directly
apportioned to various production departments only. This method does not consider the
service provided by one support department to another support department.
(ii) Step method: Under this method the cost of the support departments that serves the
maximum numbers of departments is first apportioned to other support departments and
production departments. After this the cost of support department serving the next largest
number of departments is apportioned. In this manner we finally arrive on the cost of
production departments only.
4.6
Overheads
(iii) Reciprocal service method: This method recognises the fact that where there are two or
more support departments they may render services to each other and, therefore, these
inter-departmental services are to be given due weight while re-distributing the expenses
of the support departments. The methods available for dealing with reciprocal services
are:
(a) Simultaneous equation method
(b) Repeated distribution method
(c) Trial and error method.
The reciprocal service method is conceptually preferable. This method is widely used
even if the number of service departments are more than two because due to the
availability of computer software it is not difficult to solve sets of simultaneous equations.
Question 7
Explain Single and Multiple Overhead Rates.
Answer
Single and Multiple Overhead Rates:
Single overhead rate: It is one single overhead absorption rate for the whole factory.
It may be computed as follows:
Single overhead rate =
The base can be total output, total labour hours, total machine hours, etc.
The single overhead rate may be applied in factories which produces only one
major product on a continuous basis. It may also be used in factories where the
work performed in each department is fairly uniform and standardized.
Multiple overhead rate: It involves computation of separate rates for each
production department, service department, cost center and each product for both
fixed and variable overheads. It may be computed as follows:
Multiple overhead rate
Overhead allocated/appportioned to each department/cost centre or product
=
Corresponding base
Under multiple overhead rates, jobs or products are charged with varying amount of
factory overheads depending on the type and number of departments through which
they pass. However, the number of overhead rates which a firm may compute would
4.7
Cost Accounting
depend upon two opposing factors viz. the degree of accuracy desired and the
clerical cost involved.
Question 8
How do you deal with the following in cost accounts?
(i)
Fringe benefits
Fringe benefits: the benefits paid to workers in every organisation in addition to their
normal wage or salary are known as fringe benefits. They include Housing facility,
children education allowance, holiday pay, leave pay, leave travel concession to home
town or any place in India, etc.
Expenditure incurred on fringe benefits in respect of factory workers should be
apportioned among all the production and service departments on the basis of the
number of workers in each department.
(ii) Bad debts: There is no unanimity among various authors about the treatment of bad
debts. Some authors believe that bad debts are financial losses and therefore should not
be included in the cost of a particular product or job. Another view is that, bad debts are
a part of selling and distribution overhead, especially where they arise in the normal
course of trading. Therefore they should be treated in cost accounts in the same way as
any other selling and distribution expense.
Question 9
Distinguish between fixed and variable overheads.
Answer
Fixed and Variable Overheads: Fixed overhead expenses do not vary with the volume of
production within certain limits. In other words, the amount of fixed overhead tends to remain
constant for volumes of production within the installed capacity of plant. For example, rent of
office, salary of works manger, etc.
Variable overhead cost varies in direct proportion to the volume of production. It increases or
decreases in direct relation to any increase or decrease in output.
Question 10
How would you treat the idle capacity costs in Cost Accounts?
4.8
Overheads
Answer
Treatment of idle capacity cost in Cost Accounts:
It is that part of the capacity of a plant, machine or equipment which cannot be effectively
utilised in production. The idle capacity may arise due to lack of product demand, no
availability of raw-material, shortage of skilled labour, shortage of power, etc. Costs
associated with idle capacity are mostly fixed in nature. These costs remain unabsorbed or
unrecovered due to under-utilisation of plant and service capacity. Idle capacity costs are
treated in the following ways in Cost Accounts.
(i)
If the idle capacity cost is due to unavoidable reasons - a supplementary overhead rate
may be used to recover the idle capacity cost. In this case, the costs are charged to the
production capacity utilised.
(ii) If the idle capacity cost is due to avoidable reasons - such as faulty planning, etc. the
cost should be charged to Costing Profit and Loss Account.
(iii) If the idle capacity cost is due to trade depression, etc., - being abnormal in nature the
cost should also be charged to the Costing Profit and Loss Account.
Question 11
Select a suitable unit of cost to be used in the following:
(i)
Hospital
Unit of cost
Hospital
Passenger km.
Room / day
Question 12
Discuss the treatment in cost accounts of the cost of small tools of short effective life.
Answer
Small tools are mechanical appliances used for various operations on a work place, specially
in engineering industries. Such tools include drill bits, chisels, screw cutter, files etc.
4.9
Cost Accounting
Treatment of cost of small tools of short effective life:
(i)
Small tools purchased may be capitalized and depreciated over life if their life is
ascertainable. Revaluation method of depreciation may be used in respect of very small
tools of short effective life. Depreciation of small tools may be charged to:
Factory overheads
Overheads of the department using the small tool.
(ii) Cost of small tools should be charged fully to the departments to which they have been
issued, if their life is not ascertainable.
Question 13
A machine shop has 8 identical drilling machines manned by 6 operators. The machine cannot
be worked without an operator wholly engaged on it. The original cost of all these machines
works out to Rs. 8 lakh. These particulars are furnished for a 6 month period.
Normal available hours per month per worker
208
18
20
10
Rs.20
15% on wages
Rs. 8,050
Rs. 3,300
Rs. 1,200
3% of value of machines
Rs. 40,000
Depreciation.
Rs. 12,000
Rs. 54,530
You are required to work out a comprehensive machine hour rate for the machine shop
4.10
Overheads
Answer
Computation of comprehensive machine hour rate of machine shop
Rs.
Operators wages
17,100
2,565
Power consumed
8,050
3,300
1,200
12,000
Insurance
20,000
Depreciation
40,000
6,000
27,265
1,37,480
Rs.1,37,480
(Refer to working note 1)
5,760 hours
= Rs. 23.87
Working notes:
1.
208
18
20
10
48
160
4.11
Cost Accounting
Total utilizable hour for 6 operators and
for 6 months are =160 hours 6 operators 6 months = 5,760 hours.
As machines cannot be worked without an operator wholly engaged on them, therefore hours
for which 6 operators are available for 6 months are the hours for which machines can be
used. Hence 5,760 hours represents total machine hours.
2
Question 14
E-books is an online book retailer. The Company has four departments. The two sales
departments are Corporate Sales and Consumer Sales. The two support departments are
Administrative (Human Resources Accounting) and Information Systems each of the sales
departments conducts merchandising and marketing operations independently.
The following data are available for October, 2003:
Departments
Revenues
Number of
Processing
Employees
Time used
(in minutes)
Corporate Sales
Rs. 16,67,750
42
2,400
Consumer Sales
Rs. 8,33,875
28
2,000
Administrative
--
14
400
Information system
--
21
1,400
Cost incurred in each of four departments for October, 2003 are as follow:
Corporate Sales
Rs. 12,97,751
Consumer Sales
Rs. 6,36,818
Administrative
Rs. 94,510
Information systems
Rs. 3,04,720
4.12
Overheads
The company uses number of employees as a basis to allocate Administrative costs and
processing time as a basis to allocate Information systems costs.
Required:
(i)
Allocate the support department costs to the sales departments using the direct method.
(ii) Rank the support departments based on percentage of their services rendered to other
support departments. Use this ranking to allocate support costs based on the step-down
allocation method.
(iii) How could you have ranked the support departments differently?
(iv) Allocate the support department costs to two sales departments using the reciprocal
allocation method.
Answer
(i)
Particulars
Basis of
allocation
Support department
Corporate
sales
Consumer
sales
Administrative
Information
systems
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
12,97,751
6,36,818
94,510
3,04,720
56,706
37,804
(94,510)
1,66,211
1,38,509
________
________
Total
15,20,668
8,13,131
Cost incurred
4.13
(3,04,720)
Cost Accounting
(ii)
Basis of
allocation
Support department
Corporate
sales
Consumer
sales
Administrative
Information
systems.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
12,97,751
6,36,818
94,510
3,04,720
43,520
29,080
(94,510)
21,810
1,78,107
1,48,423
________
________
Total
15,19,478
8,14,321
Cost incurred
3,26,530
(3,26,530)
(iii) An alternative ranking is based on the rupee amount of services rendered to other
service departments, using the rupee figures obtained under requirement (ii) This
approach would use the following sequence of ranking.
Allocation of information systems overheads as first (Rs.25,383 provided to
administrative).
4.14
Overheads
Allocated administrative overheads as second (Rs. 21,810 provided to information
systems).
(iv) Working notes:
(1) Percentage of services provided by each service department to other service
department and sales departments.
Service departments
Particulars
Sale departments
Administrative
Information
system
Corporate
Sales
Consumer
Sales
23.07%
46.16%
30.77%
8.33%
50%
41.67%
Administrative
Information systems
(2) Total cost of the support department: (By using simultaneous equation method).
Let AD and IS be the total costs of support departments Administrative and
Information systems respectively. These costs can be determined by using the
following simultaneous equations:
AD
94,510 + 0.0833 IS
IS
3,04,720 + 0.2307 AD
or
AD
or
AD
or
0.98078AD
1,19,893
or
AD
Rs. 1,22,243
Rs. 3,32,922
and IS
Particulars
Costs incurred
Re-allocation of cost administrative
department
(46.16% and 30.77% of Rs. 1,22,243)
4.15
Cost Accounting
1,66,461
1,38,729
________
_______
15,20,639
8,13,161
Question 15
Explain what do you mean by Chargeable Expenses and state its treatment in Cost Accounts.
Answer
Chargeable expenses: All expenses, other than direct materials and direct labour cost which
are specifically and solely incurred on production, process or job are treated as chargeable or
direct expenses. These expenses in cost accounting are treated as part of prime cost,
Examples of chargeable expenses include - Rental of a machine or plant hired for specific job,
royalty, cost of making a specific pattern, design, drawing or making tools for a job.
Question 16
A company manufacturing two products furnishes the following data for a year.
Product
Annual output
(Units)
Total Machine
hours
Total number
of purchase
orders
Total number
of set-ups
5,000
20,000
160
20
60,000
1,20,000
384
44
5,50,000
8,20,000
6,18,000
You are required to calculate the cost per unit of each Product A and B based on :
(i)
4.16
Overheads
Answer
Working notes:
1.
2.
Rs.19,88,000
= Rs. 14.20 per hour
1,40,000 hours
3.
4.
(i)
Products
A
B
Rs. 5,50,000
= Rs. 3.93 (approx.)
1,40,000 hours
Rs. 8,20,000
= Rs. 12,812.50
64 set ups
Rs. 6,18,000
= Rs. 1,136.03
544 orders
Total
machine
hours
Overhead cost
component (Refer to W,
Note 1)
Rs.
Overhead cost
per unit
Rs.
5,000
20,000
2,84,000
56.80
17,04,000
28.40
(Rs.17,04,000/60,000 units)
60,000
1,20,000
4.17
Cost Accounting
(ii)
Products Annual
output
units
(a)
A
Note:
(b)
Cost
related to
volume
activities
Rs.
(c)
Cost
related to
purchases
Cost
related to
set-ups
Total cost
Cost
per
unit
Rs.
(d)
Rs.
(e)
Rs.
(f) = [(c) +
(d) + (e)]
5,16,614.80
Rs.
(g) =
(f)/(a)
103.32
2,56,250
78,600 1,81,764.80
(20 set
(20,000 (160 orders
Rs. ups Rs.
hrs Rs.
1136.03) 12,812.50)
3.93)
60,000 1,20,000 4,71,600 4,36,235.52
5,63,750 14,71,585.52 24.53
(1,20,000 (384 orders
(44 set
hrs Rs.
Rs. ups Rs.
3.93)
1136.03) 12,812.50)
Refer to working notes 2, 3 and 4 for computing costs related to volume activities,
set-ups and purchases respectively.
5,000
Total
Machine
Hours
20,000
Question 17
In the current quarter, a company has undertaken two jobs. The data relating to these jobs are
as under:
Selling price
Profit as percentage on cost
Direct Materials
Job 1102
Job 1108
Rs. 1,07,325
Rs. 1,57,920
8%
12%
Rs. 37,500
Rs. 54,000
Direct Wages
Rs. 30,000
Rs. 42,000
It is the policy of the company to charge Factory overheads as percentage on direct wages
and Selling and Administration overheads as percentage on Factory cost.
The company has received a new order for manufacturing of a similar job. The estimate of
direct materials and direct wages relating to the new order are Rs. 64,000 and Rs. 50,000
respectively. A profit of 20% on sales is required.
You are required to compute
(i)
The rates of Factory overheads and Selling and Administration overheads to be charged.
4.18
Overheads
(ii) The Selling price of the new order
Answer
Working notes
1.
2.
Factory overheads
Rs.,1,07,325
100
108
= Rs. 99,375
Rs. 1,57,920
=
100
112
= Rs. 1,41,000
= F% of direct wages
Job 1108
Rs.
Rs.
Direct materials
37,500
54,000
Direct wages
30,000
42,000
Prime cost
67,500
96,000
30,000F
42,000F
(67,500 + 30,000 F)
(96,000 + 42,000 F)
(67,500 + 30,000 F) A
(96,000 + 42,000 F) A
Since the total cost of jobs 1102 and 1108 are equal to Rs. 99,375 and Rs. 1,41,000
respectively, therefore we have the following equations (Refer to working note 1)
4.19
Cost Accounting
(67,500 + 30,000 F) (1 + A)
99,375
(1)
(96,000 + 42,000 F) (1 + A)
1,41,000
(2)
or
99,375
1,41,000
31,875
(3)
45,000
(4)
or
0.40
64,000
Direct wages
50,000
Prime cost
1,14,000
Factory overheads
20,000
1,34,000
33,500
1,67,500
If selling price of new order is Rs. 100 then Profit is Rs. 20 and Cost is Rs. 80
Hence selling price of the new order =
Rs.1,67,500
100 = Rs. 2,09,375
80
Question 18
PQR Ltd has its own power plant, which has two users, Cutting Department and Welding
Department. When the plans were prepared for the power plant, top management decided that
its practical capacity should be 1,50.000 machine hours. Annual budgeted practical capacity
fixed costs are Rs.9,00,000 and budgeted variable costs are Rs.4 per machine-hour. The
following data are available:
4.20
Overheads
Cutting
Department
Welding
Department
Total
60,000
40,000
1,00,000
90,000
60,000
1,50,000
Allocate the power plants cost to the cutting and the welding department using a single
rate method in which the budgeted rate is calculated using practical capacity and costs
are allocated based on actual usage.
(ii) Allocate the power plants cost to the cutting and welding departments, using the dual rate method in which fixed costs are allocated based on practical capacity and variable
costs are allocated based on actual usage,
(iii) Allocate the power plants cost to the cutting and welding departments using the dual-rate
method in which the fixed-cost rate is calculated using practical capacity, but fixed costs
are allocated to the cutting and welding department based on actual usage. Variable
costs are allocated based on actual usage.
(iv) Comment on your results in requirements (i), (ii) and (iii).
Answer
Working notes:
1.
1,50,000
9,00,000
Rs. 6
(i)
Fixed practical capacity cost per machine hour + Budgeted variable cost per
machine hour
Statement showing Power Plants cost allocation to the Cutting & Welding
departments by using single rate method on actual usage of machine hours.
4.21
Cost Accounting
Cutting
Department
Rs.
Welding
Department
Rs.
Total
6,00,000
4,00,000
(40,000 hours
Rs. 10)
10,00,000
(50,000 hours
Rs. 10)
Rs.
(ii) Statement showing Power Plants cost allocation to the Cutting & Welding
departments by using dual rate method.
Cutting
Department
Rs.
Welding
Department
Rs.
Total
5,40,000
3,60,000
9,00,000
Rs. 9,00,000 3
5
Rs. 9,00,000 2
5
2,40,000
1,60,000
(60,000 hours
(40,000 hours
Rs.4)
Fixed Cost
(Allocated on practical capacity for
each department i.e.):
Rs.
Rs. 4)
7,80,000
5,20,000
4,00,000
13,00,000
(iii) Statement showing Power Plants cost allocation to the Cutting & Welding
Departments using dual rate method
Fixed Cost
Allocation of fixed cost on actual
usage basis (Refer to working note 1)
Variable cost
(Based on actual usage)
Total cost
Cutting
Department
Rs.
Welding
Department
Rs.
Total
3,60,000
2,40,000
6,00,000
(60,000 hours
Rs. 6)
(40,000 hours
Rs. 6)
2,40,000
1,60,000
(60,000 hours
Rs. 4)
(40,000 hours
Rs. 4)
6,00,000
4,00,000
4.22
Rs.
4,00,000
10,00,000
Overheads
(iv) Comments:
Under dual rate method, under (iii) and single rate method under (i), the allocation of
fixed cost of practical capacity of plant over each department are based on single rate.
The major advantage of this approach is that the user departments are allocated fixed
capacity costs only for the capacity used. The unused capacity cost Rs. 3,00,00
(Rs. 9,00,000 Rs. 6,00,000) will not be allocated to the user departments. This
highlights the cost of unused capacity.
Under (ii) fixed cost of capacity are allocated to operating departments on the basis of
practical capacity, so all fixed costs are allocated and there is no unused capacity
identified with the power plant.
Question 19
Define Selling and Distribution Expenses. Discuss the accounting for selling and distribution
expenses.
Answer
Selling expenses: Expenses incurred for the purpose of promoting, marketing and sales of
different products.
Distribution expenses: Expenses relating to delivery and despatch of goods/products to
customers.
Accounting treatment for selling and distribution expenses
Selling and distribution expenses are usually collected under separate cost account numbers.
These expenses may be recovered by using any one of following method of recovery.
1.
2.
3.
Question 20
The total overhead expenses of a factory are Rs. 4,46,380. Taking into account the normal
working of the factory, overhead was recovered in production at Rs. 1.25 per hour. The actual
hours worked were 2,93,104. How would you proceed to close the books of accounts,
assuming that besides 7,800 units produced of which 7,000 were sold, there were 200
equivalent units in work-in-progress?
4.23
Cost Accounting
On investigation, it was found that 50% of the unabsorbed overhead was on account of
increase in the cost of indirect materials and indirect labour and the remaining 50% was due to
factory inefficiency. Also give the profit implication of the method suggested.
Answer
Rs.
Actual factory overhead expenses incurred
4,.46,380
3,66,380
______
Unabsorbed overheads
80,000
40,000
40,000
(i)
1.
Unabsorbed overhead amount of Rs.40,000, which was due to increase in the cost of
indirect material and labour should be charged to units produced by using a
supplementary rate.
Supplementary rate =
Rs. 40,000
= Rs. 5 per unit
(7,800 200) units
35,000
4,000
1,000
______
40,000
4.24
Overheads
The use of cost of sales figures, would reduce the profit for the period by Rs. 35,000 and
will increase the value of stock finished goods and work-in-progress by Rs. 4,000 and Rs.
1,000 respectively.
2.
The balance amount of unabsorbed overheads viz. of Rs. 40,000 due to factory inefficiency
should be charged to Costing Profit & Loss Account, as this is an abnormal loss.
Question 21
ABC Ltd. manufactures a single product and absorbs the production overheads at a
pre-determined rate of Rs. 10 per machine hour.
At the end of financial year 1998-99, it has been found that actual production overheads
incurred were Rs. 6,00,000. It included Rs. 45,000 on account of written off obsolete stores
and Rs. 30,000 being the wages paid for the strike period under an award.
The production and sales data for the year 1998-99 is as under:
Production:
Finished goods
20,000 units
Work-in-progress
8,000 units
18,000 units
The actual machine hours worked during the period were 48,000. It has been found that onethird of the under absorption of production overheads was due to lack of production planning
and the rest was attributable to normal increase in costs.
You are required to:
(i)
Calculate the amount of under absorption of production overheads during the year
1998-99; and
4.25
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
Rs. 45,000
Rs. 30,000
6,00,000
75,000
5,25,000
4,80,000
45,000
15,000
2.
30,000
______
45,000
4,000
4.26
Rs.
5,000
Overheads
Finished goods
(2,000 units Rs. 1.25)
2,000
2,500
Cost of sales
(18,000 units Rs. 1.25)
18,000
22,500
24,000
30,000
Accounting treatment:
Work-in-progress control A/c
Dr.
Rs. 5,000
Dr.
Rs. 2,500
Dr.
Rs. 22,500
Dr.
Rs. 15,000
45,000
Working note:
Supplementary overhead absorption rate
Rs. 30,000
24,000 units
Cost of the machine is Rs. 5,00,000. Life 10 years. Estimated scrap value at the end of
life is Rs. 20,000.
Rs.
60,480
47,520
72,000
6,000
2,500
1,000
4.27
Cost Accounting
Power is required for productive purposes only. Set up time, though productive, does not
require power. The Supervisor and Operator are permanent. Repairs and maintenance
and consumable stores vary with the running of the machine.
Required
Calculate a two-tier machine hour rate for (a) set up time, and (b) running time
Answer
Working notes:
1.
(i)
200
180
2,000
General Lighting
1,000
Rent
1,000
_____
4,000
Per hour
Rs.
20
Per hour
Rs.
Depreciation
(Rs. 5,00,000 Rs. 20,000) /
(10 years 12 months)
4,000
20
(Rs. 4,000 / 200 hours
5,040
28
(Rs. 5,040 / 180 hours)
4.28
Overheads
Consumable stores
(Rs. 47,520 / 12 months)
3,960
22
(Rs. 3,960 / 180 hours)
Power
(25 units Rs. 2 180 hours)
9,000
50
(Rs. 9,000 / 180 hours)
Wages
2,500
______
12.50
(Rs. 2,500 / 200 hours)
24,500
132.50
20.00
20.00
20.00
20.00
28.00
Consumable stores
22.00
Power
50.00
40.00
140.00
Wages
12.50
12.50
52.50
152.50
Standing Charges
(Refer to working note 2)
Machine expenses:
(Refer to working note 3)
Depreciation
Question 23
What is idle time? Explain the causes leading to idle time and its treatment in cost accounts?
Answer
Idle time : It refer to the labour time paid for but not utilized on production .In other words it
represents the time for which wages are paid, but during which no output is given out by the
workers .This is the period during which workers remain idle . Idle time may be normal or
abnormal . Normal idle time is the time, which cannot be avoided or reduced, in normal course
of business. Abnormal idle time is the time, which arises on account of abnormal causes. Such
idle time is uncontrollable.
4.29
Cost Accounting
Causes leading to idle time: The major causes, which account for idle time may be grouped
under the following two heads:
Normal causes: The main causes, which lead to the occurrence of normal idle time, are as
follow
1.
Time taken by workers to travel the distance between the main gate of factory and the
place pf their work.
2.
Time lost between the finish of one job and starting of next job.
3.
4.
Time spent to meet their personal needs like taking lunch, tea etc.
Abnormal causes: The main causes, which account for the occurrence of abnormal idle time,
are:
1.
Machine break- down, power failure, non-availability of raw materials, tools or waiting for
jobs due to defective planning.
2.
3.
In the case of seasonal goods producing units may not be possible for them to produce
evenly throughout the year. Such a factor too, it result in the generation of abnormal idle
time.
Supplies
(ii) Repairs
(v) Rent
4.30
Overheads
Answer
(i)
Item
Bases of apportionment
Supplies
(ii) Repair
(v) Rent
Floor area
K W hours or H P (power)
Number of light points; Floor space; Meter
readings (light)
Question 25
Your company uses a historical cost system and applies overheads on the basis of predetermined rates. The following are the figure from the Trial Balance as at 30-9-83:Manufacturing overheads
Work-in-progress
Give two methods for the disposal of the unabsorbed overheads and show the profit
implications of each method.
Answer
Actual overheads
Rs. 4,26,544
Overhead recovered
Rs. 3,65,904
Rs.
4.31
60,640
Cost Accounting
The two methods for the disposal of the under-absorbed overheads in this problem may be:(1) Write off the under absorbed overhead to Costing Profit & Loss Account.
(2) Use supplementary rate, to recover the under-absorbed overhead.
According to first method, the total unabsorbed overhead amount of Rs. 60,640 will be written
off to Costing Profit & Loss Account. The use of this method will reduce the profits of the
concern by Rs. 60,640 for the period.
According to second method, a supplementary rate may be used to adjust the overhead cost
of each cost unit. The under-absorbed amount in total may, at the end of the accounting
period, be apportioned on ratio basis to the three control accounts, viz, work-in-progress,
finished goods stock and cost of goods sold account. Apportioning of under-absorbed
overhead can be carried out by using direct labour hours/machine hours/the value of the
balances in each of these accounts, as the basis. Prorated figures of under-absorbed
overhead over work-in-progress, finished goods stock and cost of goods sold in this question
on the basis of values, of the balances in each of these accounts are as follows:Additional Overhead
(Under-absorbed) Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Work-in-progress
1,41,480
7,074*
1,48,554
2,30,732
11,537**
2,42,269
8,40,588
42,029***
8,82,617
12,12,800
60,640
12,73,440
By using this method, the profit for the period will be reduced by Rs. 42,029 and the value of
stock will increase by Rs. 18,611. The latter will affect the profit of the subsequent period.
Working Notes
The apportionment of under-absorbed overhead over work-in-progress, finished goods stock
and cost of goods sold on the basis of their value in the respective account is as follows:Rs. 60,640
*Overhead to be absorbed by work-in=
1,41,480 = Rs. 7,074
progress
12,12,800
Rs. 60,640
2,30,732 = Rs. 11,537
12,12,800
Rs. 60,640
***Overhead to be absorbed by cost of
=
8,40,588 = Rs. 42,029
goods sold
12,12,800
4.32
Overheads
Question 26
Distinguish between cost allocation and cost absorption.
Answer
Cost allocation and Cost Absorption: Cost allocation is defined as the allotment of whole
items of cost to cost centers. For example, if a typist works exclusively for Board of Studies,
then the salary paid to him should be charged to Board of Studies account. This technique of
charging the entire overhead expenses to a cost centre is known as cost allocation.
Cost absorption is defined as the process of absorbing all overhead costs allocated to or
apportioned over particular cost centre or production department by the units produced. For
example, the overhead costs of a lathe centre may be absorbed by a rate per lathe hour.
Cost absorption can take place only after cost allocation. In other words, the overhead costs
are either allocated or apportioned over different cost centres and afterwards they are
absorbed on equitable basis by the output of the same cost centres.
Question 27
A manufacturing unit has purchased and installed a new machine of Rs. 12,70,000 to its fleet
of 7 existing machines. The new machine has an estimated life of 12 years and is expected to
realise Rs. 70,000 as scrap at the end of its working life. Other relevant data are as follows:
(i)
Budgeted working hours are 2,592 based on 8 hours per day for 324 days. This includes
300 hours for plant maintenance and 92 hours for setting up of plant.
4.33
Cost Accounting
Answer
Computation of Machine hour Rate
Per year
Per hour
Per hour
(unproductive) (productive)
Standing charges
Operators wages
4 420 54
90,720
13,608
1,04,328
55,000
1,59,328
19,916
9.05
19,916/2,292
8.69
Machine hours:
Setting time unproductive (2,592-300-92) = 2200
Setting time productive (2,592-300) = 2,292
Machine expenses
Depreciation (12,70,000 -70,000)/(12 2,200)
45.45
(12,70,000-70,000)/(12 2,292)
43.63
Electricity (16 3)
48.00
(1632,200)/2,292)
46.07
9.82
9.42
11.36
(25,000/2,292)
10.91
123.68
4.34
118.72
Overheads
Question 28
From the details furnished below you are required to compute a comprehensive machine-hour
rate:
Original purchase price of the machine (subject to
depreciation at 10% per annum on original cost)
Rs. 3,24,000
Normal
working hours for the month
(The machine works to only 75% of capacity)
200 hours
Wages of Machineman
Rs. 15,000
Rs. 3,000
Rs. 7,500
Rs. 17,500
Rs. 16,250
Rs. 27,500
The workers are paid a fixed Dearness allowance of Rs. 1,575 per month. Production bonus
payable to workers in terms of an award is equal to 33.33% of basic wages and dearness
allowance. Add 10% of the basic wage and dearness allowance against leave wages and
holidays with pay to arrive at a comprehensive labour-wage for debit to production. (14 Marks)
Answer
Computation of Comprehensive Machine Hour Rate
Per month(Rs)
Fixed cost
Supervision charges
3,000
7,500
4.35
Per hour(Rs)
Cost Accounting
1,354.17
2,291.67
Depreciation (32,4001/12)
2,700
16,845.84
112.31
17,500
116.67
Power
15,000
100.00
Variable Cost
44.91
Wages of Helper
32.97
Rs406.86
Helper
Rs. 3,125
(Rs. 75 25)
Rs. 1,875
D.A.
Rs. 1,575
Rs. 1,575
Rs. 4,700
Rs. 3,450
1,567
1,150
6,267
4,600
470
345
6,737
4,945
Rs. 44.91
Rs. 32.97
Question 29
ABC Ltd. has three production departments P 1, P2 and P3 and two service departments S 1 and
S2. The following data are extracted from the records of the Company for the month of
October, 2007:
4.36
Overheads
Rs.
Rent and rates
62,500
General lighting
7,500
Indirect Wages
18,750
Power
25,000
Depreciation on machinery
50,000
Insurance of machinery
20,000
Other Information:
P1
P2
P3
S1
S2
37,500
25,000
37,500
18,750
6,250
60
30
50
10
Cost of machinery
(Rs.)
3,00,000
4,00,000
5,00,000
25,000
25,000
2,000
2,500
3,000
2,000
500
10
15
20
10
Number
points
Production
worked
of
of
light
hours
6,225
4,050
4,100
Expenses of the service departments S 1 and S2 are reapportioned as below:
S1
S2
Required:
(i)
P1
P2
P3
S1
S2
20%
30%
40%
10%
40%
20%
30%
10%
(ii) Determine the total cost of product X which is processed for manufacture in
department P1, P2 and P3 for 5 hours, 3 hours and 4 hours respectively, given that
its direct material cost is Rs. 625 and direct labour cost is Rs. 375.
4.37
Cost Accounting
Answer
Rent
Rates
Basis of
apportionment
Total
P1
P2
P3
S1
S2
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
62,500
12,500
15,625
18,750
12,500
3,125
7,500
1,250
1,875
2,500
1,250
625
18,750
5,625
3,750
5,625
2812.5
937.5
25,000
10,000
5,000
8,333
1,667
50,000
12,000
16,000
20,000
1,000
1,000
20,000
4,800
6,400
8,000
400
400
_______
______
______
______
______
_____
1,83,750
46,175
48,650
63,208
19,630
6,088
4:5:6:4:1
General
lighting
Light points
Indirect
wages
Direct wages
Power
Horse Power
of machines
used
2:3:4:2:1
6:4:6:3:1
6:3:5:1
Depreciation
of machinery
Value of
machinery
12 : 16 : 20 : 1
:1
Insurance of Value of
machinery
machinery
12 : 16 : 20 : 1
:1
Overheads of service cost centres Let S 1 be the overhead of service cost centre S 1 and
S2 be the overhead of service cost centre S 2.
S1 = 19,630 + 0.10 S2
S2 = 6,088 + 0.10 S1
Substituting the value of S 2 in S1 we get
S1 = 19,630 + 0.10 (6,088 + 0.10 S1)
4.38
Overheads
S1 = 19,630 + 608.8 + 0.01 S1
0.99 S1 = 20,238.8
S1
= Rs. 20,443.
S2
Total
P1
P2
P3
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
1,58,033
46,175
48,650
63,208
S1
20,443
4,089
6,133
8,177
S2
8,132
3,253
1,626
2,440
53,517
56,409
73,825
P1
P2
P3
Rs. 53,517
Rs. 56,409
Rs. 73,825
6,225
4,050
4,100
Rs. 13.93
Rs. 18.01
Rs. 8.60
Cost of Product X
Direct material
Rs. 625
Direct labour
Rs. 375
Prime cost
Rs. 1,000
Production on overheads
P1
P2
P3
Rs. 156.83
Factory cost
Rs. 1,157
4.39
Cost Accounting
Question 30
(a) PQR manufacturers a small scale enterprise produces a single product and has
adopted a policy to recover the production overheads of the factory by adopting a single
blanket rate based on machine hours. The budgeted production overheads of the factory
are Rs. 10,08,000 and budgeted machine hours are 96,000.
For a period of first six months of the financial year 20072008, following information
were extracted from the books:
Actual production overheads
Rs. 6,79,000
Rs. 45,000
Rs. 10,000
Rs. 42,000
Rs. 18,000
Production and sales data of the concern for the first six months are as under:
Production:
Finished goods
22,000 units
Works-in-progress
(50% complete in every respect)
16,000 units
Sale:
Finished goods
18,000 units
The actual machine hours worked during the period were 48,000 hours. It is revealed
from the analysis of information that of the under-absorption was due to defective
production policies and the balance was attributable to increase in costs.
You are required:
(i)
to determine the amount of under absorption of production overheads for the period,
4.40
Overheads
Answer
(a) (i)
Amount of under absorption of production overheads during the period of first six
months of the year 2007-2008:
Amount
(Rs.)
6,79,000
45,000
10,000
42,000
18,000
1,15,000
5,64,000
5,04,000
60,000
Rs. 10,08,000
Rs. 10.50 per hour
96,000 hours
Rs.15,000.
Supplementary rate =
Rs. 45,000
Rs. 1.50 per unit
30,000 units
4.41
Cost Accounting
(iii) Apportionment of under absorbed production overheads over WIP, finished goods
and cost of sales:
Equivalent
completed units
Amount
8,000
12,000
4,000
6,000
18,000
27,000
Total
30,000
45,000
(in Rs.)
Question 31
(a) In a manufacturing company factory overheads are charged as fixed percentage basis on
direct labour and office overheads are charged on the basis of percentage of factory
cost. The following informations are available related to the year ending 31st March,
2008 :
Product A
Product B
Direct Materials
Rs. 19,000
Rs. 15,000
Direct Labour
Rs. 15,000
Rs. 25,000
Sales
Rs. 60,000
Rs. 80,000
Profit
25% on cost
Product B
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
Direct Materials
19,000
15,000
Direct labour
15,000
25,000
4.42
Overheads
Prime Cost
34,000
40,000
150 x
250 x
34,000 + 150 x
40,000 + 250 x
340 y + 1.5 x y
400 y + 2.5 x y
34,000 + 150 x
40,000 + 250 x
+ 340 y +
1.5 x y
+400 y +
2.5 x y
Sales
Product A
Product B
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
60,000
80,000
Less: Profit
Product A 25% on cost or 20% on Sales
12,000
______
20,000
48,000
60,000
Total Cost
Thus,
20
Cost Accounting
or 180x = 7,200
or x = 40.
Hence,
(i)
Direct wages Rs. 9 per unit (subject to a minimum of Rs. 2,50,000 per month).
Semi-variable overheads are Rs. 5,60,000 per annum up to 50 per cent capacity
and additional Rs. 1,50,000 per annum for every 25 per cent increase in capacity or
a part of it.
JK Ltd. worked at 60 per cent capacity for the first three months during the year 2008, but it is
expected to work at 90 per cent capacity for the remaining nine months.
The selling price per unit was Rs. 44 during the first three months.
You are required, what selling price per unit should be fixed for the remaining nine months to
yield a total profit of Rs. 15,62,500 for the whole year.
Answer
First 3 months
Next 9 months
60%
90%
Capacity utilized
Production
5,20,000 3 60%
5,20,000 9 90%
12
12
Total
= 78,000 units
= 3,51,000 units
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
11,70,000
52,65,000
64,35,000
7,50,000
31,59,000
39,09,000
4.44
4,29,000 units
Overheads
19,20,000
84,24,000
1,03,44,000
Fixed
2,40,000
7,20,000
9,60,000
6,24,000
28,08,000
34,32,000
Semi Variable
1,77,500
6,45,000
8,22,500
10,41,500
41,73,000
52,14,500
29,61,500
1,25,97,000
1,55,58,500
Overheads
4,70,500
34,32,000
10,92,000
__________
1,36,89,000
Total profit
15,62,500
Total Sales
1,71,21,000
Rs.
1,36,89,000
Rs. 39 per unit.
35,10,000
Workings:
(1) Semi-variable overheads:
(a) For first 3 months at 60% capacity = Rs. (5,60,000 + Rs. 1,50,000) 3/12
= Rs. 7,10,000 3/12
= Rs. 1,77,500.
(b) For remaining 9 months at 90% capacity= Rs. (5,60,000 + Rs. 3,00,000) 9/12
4.45
Cost Accounting
Question 33
= Rs. 8,60,000 9/12
Calculate machine hour rate for recovery of overheads for a machine from the following
information:
Cost of machine is Rs. 25, 00,000 and estimated salvage value is Rs. 1,00,000. Estimated
working life of the machine is 10 years. Annual working hours are 3,000 in the factory. The
machine is required 400 hours per annum for repairs and maintenance. Setting-up time of the
machine is 156 hours per annum to be treated as productive time. Cost of repairs and
maintenance for whole working life of the machine is Rs. 3,50,000. Power used 15 units per
hour at a cost of Rs. 5 per unit. No power is consumed during maintenance and setting-up
time. A chemical required for operating the machine is Rs. 9,880 per annum. Wages of an
operator is Rs. 4,000 per month. The operator, devoted one-third of his time to the machine.
Annual insurance charges 2 per cent of cost of machine.
Light charges for the department is Rs. 2,500 per month, having 48 points in all, out of which
only 8 points are used at this machine. Other indirect expenses are chargeable to the
machine are Rs. 6,500 per month.
Answers
Computation of Machine Hour Rate
Running Hours (3,000 400) = 2,600 per annum
Particulars
Total Amount
Rs.
Rs.
16,000
50,000
5,000
78,000
1,49,000
Rs. 1,49,000
2,600
4.46
57.31
Overheads
92.31
Rs. 3,50,000
10 2,600
13.46
Chemical :
70.50
Rs. 9,880
2,600
3.80
237.38
Product Y
M1
10 Machine hours
6 Machine hours
M2
4 Machine hours
14 Machine hours
Indirect Wages
Consumable
Supplies
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
M1
46,520
12,600
M2
41,340
18,200
4.47
Cost Accounting
A1
16,220
4,200
Stores
8,200
2,800
Engineering Service
5,340
4,200
General Service
7,520
3,200
Rs.
Depreciation on Machinery
Insurance of Machinery
7,200
Insurance of Building
3,240
Power
6,480
Light
5,400
Rent
12,675
(Total
building
insurance cost for
M1 is one third of
annual premium
(The
general
service deptt. is
located in a building
owned
by
the
company.
It is
valued at Rs. 6,000
and is charged into
cost at notional
value of 8% per
annum. This cost is
additional to the
rent shown above)
The value of issues of materials to the production departments are in the same
proportion as shown above for the Consumable supplies.
The following data are also available:
Department
Book value
Machinery
(Rs.)
Area
(Sq. ft.)
Effective
H.P. hours %
Production
Direct
Labour
hour
Capacity
Machine
hour
M1
1,20,000
5,000
50
2,00,000
40,000
M2
90,000
6,000
35
1,50,000
50,000
4.48
Overheads
A1
30,000
8,000
05
Stores
12,000
2,000
Engg. Service
36,000
2,500
10
General Service
12,000
1,500
3,00,000
Required:
(i)
Items
Basis of
Total
Apportionment
Amount
Indirect
Allocation
wages
given
Consumable
Allocation
stores
given
Depreciation
Capital value
Production Deptt.
M1
M2
Service Deptt.
A1
Store
Engineering
General
Service
Service
Service
1,25,140
46,520
41,340
16,220
8,200
5,340
7,520
45,200
12,600
18,200
4,200
2,800
4,200
3,200
39,600
15,840
11,880
3,960
1,584
4,752
1,584
7,200
2,880
2,160
720
288
864
288
3,240
1,080
648
864
216
270
162
of machine
Insurance of
Capital value
Machine
of machine
Insurance
on Building
1
3
to
MI
Balance area
basis
Power
HP Hr%
6,480
3,240
2,268
324
Light
Area
5,400
1,080
1,296
1,728
4.49
648
432
540
324
Cost Accounting
Rent
Area
Rent
of
12,675
3,042
4,056
1,014
1,268
_______
______
______
______
______
______
______
2,45,415
85,775
80,834
32,072
14,534
17,882
14,318
480
760
Direct 8% of
general
2,535
480
6,000
service
Total
(ii)
Service
Production Deptt.
M1
M2
Service Deptt.
A1
Deptt.
Store
Store
Engineering
General
Service
Service
Service
(14,534)
Ratio of
consumable value
5,232
7,558
1,744
7,948
9,934
4,406
3,304
6,608
_______
85,775
80,834
32,072
2,45,415
1,03,361
1,01,630
40,424
In Machine hours
Ratio of M1 and
(17,882)
M2 (4 : 5)
General
LHR Basis
service
20 : 15 : 30
(14,318)
Production
Department
allocated
in
(i)
Total
(iii)
M2
A1
1,03,361
1,01,630
40,424
Machine hours
40,000
50,000
Labour hours
3,00,000
2.584
2.033
4.50
.135
Overheads
(iv)
Machine Deptt.
Absorption Rate
M1
M2
A1
2.584
2.033
.135
Product X
Hours
10
25.84
4
8.13
14
.54
34.51
Product Y
Hours
6
15.50
14
28.46
18
2.43
46.39
Question 36
Explain Blanket overhead rate.
Answer
Blanket overhead rate refers to the computation of one single overhead rate for the entire
factory. This is also known as plantwise or the single overhead rate for the entire factory. It is
determined as follows:
Blanket overhead rate =
It is useful in companies producing the main product in continue process, e.g. chemical plant,
glass plant etc.
Question 37
A machine shop cost centre contains three machines of equal capacities. Three operators are
employed on each machine, payable Rs. 20 per hour each. The factory works for fortyeight
hours in a week which includes 4 hours set up time. The work is jointly done by operators.
The operators are paid fully for the fortyeight hours. In additions they are paid a bonus of 10
per cent of productive time. Costs are reported for this company on the basis of thirteen fourweekly period.
The company for the purpose of computing machine hour rate includes the direct wages of the
operator and also recoups the factory overheads allocated to the machines. The following
details of factory overheads applicable to the cost centre are available:
Depreciation 10% per annum on original cost of the machine. Original cost of the each
machine is Rs. 52,000.
Maintenance and repairs per week per machine is Rs. 60.
Consumable stores per week per machine are Rs. 75.
Power : 20 units per hour per machine at the rate of 80 paise per unit.
4.51
Cost Accounting
Apportionment to the cost centre : Rent per annum Rs. 5,400, Heat and Light per annum
Rs. 9,720, and foremans salary per annum Rs. 12,960.
Required:
(i)
Calculate the cost of running one machine for a four week period.
Per annum
Rent
5,400
9,720
Formans salary
12,960
28,080
Rs.
28,080 4
3 13
2,880
3,840
352
7,072
Machine Expenses:
Rs.
(ii)
4
Depreciation = 52,000 10%
13
1,600
240
300
2,816
4,956
12,028
4.52
Overheads
12,028
68.34.
176
Question 38
Explain the cost accounting treatment of unsuccessful Research and Development cost.
Answer
Cost of unsuccessful research is treated as factory overhead, provided the expenditure is
normal and is provided in the budget. If it is not budgeted, it is written off to the profit and loss
account. If the research is extended for long time, some failure cost is spread over to
successful research.
Question 39
Discuss the difference between allocation and apportionment of overhead.
Answer
The following are the differences between allocation and apportionment.
1.
Allocation costs are directly allocated to cost centre. Overhead which cannot be directly
allocated are apportioned on some suitable basis.
2.
Allocation allots whole amount of cost to cost centre or cost unit where as apportionment
allots part of cost to cost centre or cost unit.
3.
No basis required for allocation. Apportionment is made on the basis of area, assets
value, number of workers etc.
Question 40
A machinery was purchased from a manufacturer who claimed that his machine could produce
36.5 tonnes in a year consisting of 365 days. Holidays, break-down, etc., were normally
allowed in the factory for 65 days. Sales were expected to be 25 tonnes during the year and
the plant actually produced 25.2 tonnes during the year. You are required to state the
following figures:
(a) rated capacity
(b) practical capacity
(c) normal capacity
(d) actual capacity
4.53
Cost Accounting
Answer
a)
Rated capacity
36.5
tonnes
30
tonnes
25
tonnes
25.2
tonnes
36.5
(365 65) tonnes ]
365
4.54
Overheads
EXERCISE
Question 1
(a) Explain with illustrative examples the concept of fixed cost and variable cost.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
(b) The following are the Maintenance costs incurred in a machine shop per six months with
corresponding machine hours:
Month
Maintenance Costs
Rs.
Machine Hours
January
2,000
300
February
2,200
320
March
1,700
270
April
2,400
340
May
1,800
280
June
1,900
290
Total
12,000
1,800
Analyse the Maintenance cost which is semi-variable into fixed and variable element.
Answer Fixed cost (Rs.) 100
Question 2
(a) Explain how departmental overhead rates are arrived at.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
(b) Selfhelp Ltd. has gensets and produces its own power. Data for power costs are as follows:Horse power Hours
Production deptts.
A
Service deptts.
B
10,000
20,000
12,000
8,000
8,000
13,000
7,000
6,000
During the month of May costs for generating power amounted to Rs. 9,300: of this
Rs. 2,500 was considered to be fixed cost. Service Deptt. X renders service to A, B and Y in the
ratio 13:6:1, while Y renders service to A and B in the ratio 31:3. Given that the direct labour hours
4.55
Cost Accounting
in Deptts. A and B are 1650 hours and 2175 hours respectively, find the Power Cost per labour
hour in each of these two Deptts.
Answer
Power Cost per labour labour (Rs.)
A
3.00
B
2.00
Question 3
The level of production activity fluctuates widely in your company from month to month. Because of
this, the incidence of depreciation on unit cost varies considerably. The management decides that
you should find out a suitable method to correct this.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 4
What is an idle capacity? What are the costs associated with it? How are these treated in product
costs?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 5
Explain what is meant by Cost Apportionment and Cost Absorption. Illustrate each with two
examples. Discuss the methods of cost absorption and state which method do you consider to be
the best and why
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 6
State the objectives of codification of overheads. Enumerate with examples the different methods
of coding and suggest a suitable method for a large organization.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 7
Explain what do you understand by the terms stores overheads. Cite three example of stores
overheads. Discuss the methods of treatment of stores overhead in cost accounts and state the
method which you consider to be good.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 8
In a manufacturing company where costing is done with a view to fix prices, state whether and, if
so, to what extent the following items are includible in cost .
(i)
Interest on borrowing
(ii)
4.56
Overheads
(iii) Depreciation on plant and machinery.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 9
(a) What do you understand by codification of overheads?
(b) What are the objectives of codification?
(c)
List down the various methods of codification (you need not elaborate).
Fringe Benefits
4.57
Cost Accounting
rest was attributed to normal cost increase. How would you treat the under absorbed
overhead in the cost accounts?
Answer
1.
60 percent of under absorbed overhead is due to defective planning. This being abnormal,
should be debited to Profit and Loss A/c (60% of Rs. 10,000) (Rs.)
6,000
2.
Question 13
(a) Distinguish between allocation, apportionment and absorption of overheads.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
(b) A departmental store has several departments. What bases would you recommend for
apportioning the following items of expense to its departments
(1) Fire insurance of Building.
(2) Rent
(3) Delivery Expenses.
(4) Purchase Department Expenses.
(5) Credit Department Expenses.
(6) General Administration Expenses.
(7) Advertisement.
(8) Sales Assistants Salaries.
(9) Personal Department expenses.
(10) Sales Commission
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 14
Define administration overheads and state briefly the treatment of such overheads in Cost
Accounts. (Nov. 1996, 4 marks)
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 15
Enumerate the arguments for the inclusion of interest on capital in cost accounts.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
4.58
Overheads
Question 16
What is Idle Capacity ? How should this be treated in cost accounts?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 17
Write short notes on Chargeable Expenses
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 18
What is notional rent of a factory building? Give one reason why it may be included in cost
accounts.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 19
How would you treat the following in Cost Accounts?
(i)
(ii)
(iii) Depreciation
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 20
Write a note on classification, allocation and absorption of overheads. How does it help in
controlling overheads?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 21
Explain, how under absorption and over-absorption of overheads are treated in Cost Accounts.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 22
How do you deal with the following in Cost Account?
(i)
(ii)
Fringe benefits
4.59
Cost Accounting
Question 23
(i)
Overhead expenses: Factory rent Rs. 96,000 (Floor area 80,000 sq.ft.), Heat and gas Rs.
45,000 and supervision Rs. 1,20,000.
(ii)
Wages of the operator are Rs. 48 per day of 8 hours . He attends to one machine when it is
under set up and two machines while they are under operation.
In respect of machine B (one of the above machines) the following particulars are furnished:
(i)
Cost of machine Rs 45,000, Life of machine- 10 years and scrap value at the end of its life
Rs. 5,000
(ii)
Annual expenses on special equipment attached to the machine are estimated as Rs. 3,000
(iii) Estimated operation time of the machine is 3,600 hours while set up time is 400 hours per
annum
(iv) The machine occupies 5,000 sq.ft. of floor area.
(v)
Find out the comprehensive machine hour rate of machine B . Also find out machine costs to be
absorbed in respect of use of machine B on the following two work- orders
Work order 31
Work order 32
10
20
90
180
Answer
Comprehensive machine
hour rate per hr. (Rs.)
12
Work order 31
1,110
11
Work order 32
2,220
Question 24
"The more kilometers you travel with your own vehicle, the cheaper it becomes." Comment briefly
on this statement.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
4.60
Overheads
Question 25
A factory has three production departments: The policy of the factory is to recover the production
overheads of the entire factory by adopting a single blanket rate based on the percentage of total
factory overheads to total factory wages. The relevant data for a month are given below:
Department
Direct
Materials
Direct
Wages
Rs.
Rs.
Factory
Overheads
Rs.
Director
Labour
Hour
Machine
Hours
Budget
Machining
6,50,000
80,000
3,60,000
20,000
80,000
Assembly
1,70,000
3,50,000
1,40,000
1,00,000
10,000
Packing
1,00,000
70,000
1,25,000
50,000
Machining
7,80,000
96, 000
3,90,000
24,000
96,000
Assembly
1,36,000
2,70,000
84,000
90,000
11,000
Actual
Packing
1,20,000
90,000
1,35,000
60,000
The details of one of the representative jobs produced during the month are as under:
Job No. CW 7083
Department
Direct
Materials
Direct Wages
Rs.
Rs.
Machining
1,200
240
60
180
Assembly
600
360
120
30
Packing
300
60
40
The factory adds 30% on the factory cost to cover administration and selling overheads and profit.
Required:
(i)
Calculate the overhead absorption rate as per the current policy of the company and
determine the selling price of the Job No. CW 7083.
(ii)
Suggest any suitable alternative method(s) of absorption of the factory overheads and
calculate the overhead recovery rates based on the method(s) so recommended by you.
4.61
Cost Accounting
(iii) Determine the selling price of Job CW 7083 based on the overhead application rates
calculated in (ii) above.
(iv) Calculate the departmentwise and total under or over recovery of overheads based on
the companys current policy and the method(s) recommended by you.
Answer (i) Overhead absorption rate = 125% of Direct wages
(ii) Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
(iii) Selling Price(Rs.)
4,989.40
Question 26
(a) Why is the use of an overhead absorption rate based on direct labour hours generally
preferable to a direct wages percentage rate for a labour intensive operation?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
(b) B & Co. has recorded the following data in the two most recent periods:
Total cost of production
Volume of production
Rs.
(Units)
14,600
800
19,400
1,200
What is the best estimate of the firms fixed costs per period?
Answer Fixed cost = Rs. 5,000
(c)
4.62
2,00,000
Overheads
Question 27
A company is making a study of the relative profitability of the two products A and B. In addition
to direct costs, indirect selling and distribution costs to be allocated between the two products are
as under:
Rs.
Insurance charges for inventory (finished)
78,000
Storage costs
1,40,000
7,20,000
Salesmen salaries
8,50,000
Invoicing costs
Other details are
4,50,000
Product A
Product B
(Rs.)
500
1,000
(Rs.)
300
600
10,000
8,000
1,000
800
(units)
Number of invoices
2,500
2,000
One unit of product A requires a storage space twice as much as product B. The cost to packing
and forwarding one unit is the same for both the products. Salesmen are paid salary plus
commission @ 5% on sales and equal amount of efforts are put forth on the sales of each of the
product.
Required
(i)
Set-up a schedule showing the apportionment of the indirect selling and distribution costs
between the two products.
(ii)
Answer Products
Profit
A.
Rs.
Rs.
5,45,000
4.63
17,67,000
Cost Accounting
Question 28
SWEAT DREAMS Ltd. uses a historical cost system and absorbs overheads on the basis of
predetermined rate. The following data are available for the year ended 31st March, 1997.
Rs.
Manufacturing overheads
Amount actually spent
1,70,000
Amount absorbed
1,50,000
3,36,000
96,000
Works-in-progress
48,000
Using two methods of disposal of under-absorbed overheads show the implication on the profits of
the company under each method.
Answer According to first method, the total unabsorbed overhead amount of Rs. 20,000 will be
written off to Costing Profit & Loss Account. The use of this method will reduce the profits of
the concern by Rs. 20,000 for the period.
According to second method, a supplementary rate may be used to adjust the overhead cost
of each cost unit. The use of this method would reduce the profit of the concern by Rs. 14,000.
Question 29
A company has three production departments and two service departments. Distribution summary
of overheads is as follows:
Production Departments
A
Rs. 13,600
Rs. 14,700
Rs. 12,800
Service Departments
X
Rs. 9,000
Rs. 3,000
4.64
Overheads
The expenses of service departments are charged on a percentage basis which is as follows:
A
X Deptt.
40%
30%
20%
10%
Y Deptt.
30%
30%
20%
20%
Apportion the cost of Service Departments by using the Repeated Distribution method.
Answer
Production Departments
A
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
18,712
18,833
15,555
Question 30
A factory manufactures only one product in one quality and size. The owner of the factory states
that he has a sound system of financial accounting which can provide him with unit cost information
and as such he does not need a cost accounting system. State your arguments to convince him
the need to introduce a cost accounting system.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4.i.e. Overheads of Study Material.
Question 31
Ventilators Ltd. wants to stabilize its production throughout the year. The approaches
recommended are:
(a) Maintain production at an even pace throughout the year, and get the off-season production
stored on the premises.
(b) Maintain production at an even pace but offer dealers a special discount for off-season
purchases.
(c)
Extend special terms to dealers, but maintain prices at levels that will enable regular
movement of goods throughout the year.
Discuss the relative merits and disadvantages of above proposals.
4.65
Cost Accounting
Question 33
Soloproducts Ltd. Manufactures and sells a single product and has estimated a sales revenue of
Rs. 126 lakhs this year based on a 20% profit on selling price. Each unit of the product requires 3
lbs of material P and 1 lbs of material Q for manufacture as well as a processing time of 7 hours
in the Machine Shop and 2 hours in the Assembly Section. Overheads are absorbed at a blanket
rate of 33-1/3% on Direct Labour. The factory works 5 days of 8 hours a week in a normal 52
weeks a year. On an average statutory holidays, leave and absenteeism and idle time amount to
96 hours, 80 hours and 64 hours respectively, in a year.
The other details are as under
Purchase price
Material P
Rs. 6 per lb
Material Q
Rs. 4 per lb
Machine shop
Assembly
Machine shop
600
Assembly
180
Comprehensive
Labour rate
No. of Employees
Finished Goods
Material P
Material Q
Opening stock
20,000 units
54,000 lbs
33,000 lbs
25,000 units
30,000 lbs
66,000 lbs
Capacity utilization of machine shop and Assembly section, along with your comments.
1,40,000 Units
4.66
Machine shop
Assembly Section
91.94%
109.45%
Overheads
Question 34
In a factory following the job costing Method, an abstract from the work in process as at 30 th
September was prepared as under:
Job No.
Material
Director
Labour
Factory overheads
Applied
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
115
1,325
400 hours
800
640
118
810
250 hours
500
400
120
765
300 hours
475
380
1,775
1,420
2,900
Material used in October were as follows :
Material requisition
Job
Cost
No.
No.
Rs.
54
118
300
55
118
425
56
118
515
57
120
665
58
121
910
59
124
720
3,535
Number of Hours
Shop A
Shop B
115
25
25
118
90
30
120
75
10
121
65
124
20
10
275
75
4.67
Cost Accounting
Indirect Labour:
Waiting for material
20
10
Machine Breakdown
10
Indle time
Overtime Premium
316
101
A shop credit slip was issued in October that material issued under Requisition No. 54 was
returned back to stores as being not suitable. A material Transfer Note issued in October indicated
that material issued under requisition No.55 for job 118 was directed to job 124.
The hourly rate in shop A per labour hour is Rs. 3 per hour while at shop B, it is Rs. 2 per hour.
The Factory Overhead is applied at the same rate as in September. Jobs 115, 118 and 120 were
completed in October.
You are asked to compute the factory cost of the completed jobs. It is the practice of the
management to put a 10% on the factory cost to cover administration and selling overheads and
invoice the job to the customer on a total cost plus 20% basis. What would be the invoice price of
these three jobs?
Answer Job No.
115
118
2,990
2,819
3,946.80
120
2,726
3,721.08
3.598.32
Question 35
Modern manufacturers Ltd. Have three production department P1, P2 and P3 and two Service
Departments S1 and S2 the details pertaining to which are as under:P1
P2
P3
S1
S2
3,000
2,000
3,000
1,500
195
Working Hours
3,070
4,475
2,419
60,000
80,000
1,00,000
5,000
5,000
HP of Machines
60
30
50
10
Light Points
10
15
20
10
2,000
2,500
3,000
2,000
500
4.68
Overheads
The following figures extracted from the Accounting records are relevant:
Rs.
Rent and Rates
5,.000
General Lighting
600
Indirect Wages
1,939
Power
1,500
Depreciation on Machines
10,000
Sundries
9,695
P2
P3
S1
S2
S1
20%
30%
40%
10%
S2
40%
20%
30%
10%
Find out the total cost of product X which is processed for manufacture in Departments P1, P2 and
P3 for 4,5 and 3 hours respectively, given that its Direct Material cost in Rs. 50 Direct Labour cost
Rs.30.
Answer
P1
Total (Rs.)
P2
8,787.16
P3
8,504.87
11,441.79
Rs
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Direct Material
1,000
2,000
4,000
2,000
1,000
Direct Wages
5,000
2,000
8,000
1,000
2,000
Factory rent
4,000
Power
2,500
Depreciation
1,000
4.69
Cost Accounting
Other overheads
9,000
Additional information
Area( Sq.ft.)
500
250
500
250
500
20
40
20
10
10
1,000
2,000
4,000
1,000
1,000
50
40
20
15
25
%.
Service Dept. X
45
15
30
10
Service Dept. Y
Required:
60
35
(i)
(ii)
8.48
3.25
C
1.88
Question 37
Explain how under and over absorption of overheads are treated in cost accounts.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 4 i.e. Overheads of Study Material
Question 38
A machine shop has 8 identical Drilling Machines manned by 6 operators. The machines cannot be
worked without an operator wholly engaged on it. The original cost of all these 8 machines works
out to Rs. 8 lakhs. These particulars are furnished for a 6 month period:Normal available hours per month
208
18
20
10
4.70
Overheads
Rs.20
15% on wages
Rs.8,050
Rs. 3,300
Rs. 1,200
Rs. 23.87
Question 39
Gemini Enterprises undertakes three different jobs A,B and C.All of them require, the use of a
special machine and also the use of a computer. The computer is hired and the hire charges work
out to Rs. 4,20,000/- per annum. The expenses regarding the machine are estimated as follows.
Rs.
Rent for the quarter
17,500
2,00,000
600
400
900
600
1,000
(a) For the firm as a whole for the month when the computer was used and when the computer
was not used.
(c) For the individual jobs A, B and C.
4.71
Cost Accounting
Answer (a) Machine Hour Rate of Gemini Enterprises for the firm as a whole, for a month
(1) When the computer was used Rs. 27.50 per hour.
(2) When the computer was not used Rs.10 per hour.
(b) Machine hour rate for the individual jobs.
Job
Rs. 17
Rs. 17
Rs. 27.50
Question 40
Deccan Manufacturing Ltd. have three departments which are regarded as production
departments. Service departments costs are distributed to these production departments using the
Step Ladder Method of distribution . Estimates of factory overhead costs to be incurred by each
department in the forthcoming year are as follows. Data required for distribution is also shown
against each department:
Department
Factory overhead
Direct Labour
No.of
Employees
Area in sq. m.
Rs.
Hours
1,93,000
4,000
100
3,000
64,000
3,000
125
1,500
83,000
4,000
85
1,500
45,000
1,000
10
500
75,000
5,000
50
1,500
1,05,000
6,000
40
1,000
Productions
Services
S
30,000
3,000
50
1,000
The overhead costs of the four service departments are distributed in the same order, viz., P,Q,R
and S respectively on the following basis:
Department
P
Q
R
S
Basis
Number of Employees
Direct Labour Hours
Area in square meters
Direct Labour Hours
_
_
_
_
4.72
Overheads
You are required to:
(a) prepare a schedule showing the distribution of overhead costs of the four service
departments to the three production departments; and
(b) calculate the overhead recovery rate per direct labour hour for each of the three production
departments.
Answer
Rs. 75/-
Rs.45/-
Rs.40/-
Question 41
A Ltd. manufactures two products A and B. The manufacturing division consists of two production
departments P1and P2 and two services S1 and S2.
Budgeted overhead rates are used in the production departments to absorb factory overheads to
the products. The rate of Department P1 is based on direct machine hours, while the rate of
Department P2 is based on direct labour hours. In applying overheads, the pre-determined rates
are multiplied by actual hours.
For allocating the service department costs to production departments, the basis adopted is as
follow:
(i)
(ii)
Rs.
P1
25,50,000
S1
6,00,000
P2
21,75,000
S2
4,50,000
Cost Accounting
Product B: 1.0 machine hour
Department P2: Product A: 2 Direct labour hours
Product B: 2.5 Direct labour hours
Average wage rates budgeted in Department P2 are: Product A Rs72 per hour
and Product B Rs. 75 per hour.
All materials are used in Department P1 only.
Actual data (for the month of July,1993)
Units actually produced: Product A: 4,000 units
Product B: 3,000 units
Raw materials:
Wages:
Overheads: Department
P1
P2
Product B
Rs. 4,56,000
Rs. 5,52,000
Rs.
Rs. 60,000
Rs. 48,000
S1
S2
(ii)
Prepare a performance report for July. 1993 that will reflect the budgeted costs and actual
costs.
Answer
P1
P2
Rs. 30
Rs. 15
Question 42
In a manufacturing unit, factory overhead was recovered at a pre- determined rate of
Rs. 25 per man day. The total factory overhead expenses incurred and the man-days actually
4.74
Overheads
worked were Rs. 41.50 lakhs and 1.5 lakhs man-days respectively. Out of the 40,000 units
produced during a period, 30,000 were sold .
On analysing the reasons, it was found that 60% of the unabsorbed overheads were due to
defective planning and the rest were attributable to increase in overhead costs.
How would unabsorbed overheads be treated in Cost Accounts?
Answer Treatment of Unabsorbed Overheads in Cost Accounts
(i)
(ii) The balance unabsorbed overheads of Rs. 1,60,000 be charged to production i.e. 40,000
units at the supplementary overhead absorption rate i.e. Rs. 4/- per unit .
Question 43
A company has two production departments and two service departments. The data relating to a
period are as under:
Production Department
Service Department
PD1
PD2
SD1
SD2
Direct materials
(Rs.)
80,000
40,000
10,000
20,000
Direct wages
(Rs.)
95,000
50,000
20,000
10,000
Overheads
(Rs.)
80,000
50,000
30,000
20,000
(Kwh)
20,000
35,000
12,500
17,500
(Kwh)
13,000
23,000
10,250
10,000
The power requirement of these departments are met by a power generation plant. The said plant
incurred an expenditure, which is not included above of Rs. 1,21,875 out of which a sum of Rs.
84,375 was variable and the rest fixed.
After apportionment of power generation plant costs to the four departments, the service
department overheads are to be redistributed on the following bases:
PD1
PD2
SD1
SD2
SD1
(Rs.)
50%
40%
---
10%
SD2
(Rs.)
60%
20%
20%
---
4.75
Cost Accounting
You are required to:
(i)
(ii)
(iii) Calculate the overhead rates per direct labour hour of production departments, given that the
direct wage rates of PD1 and PD2 are Rs. 5 and Rs. 4 per hour respectively.
Answer
PD1
10.87
PD2
12.43
31.904
Question 45
An engine manufacturing company has two production departments: (i) Snow mobile engine and
(ii) Boat engine and two service departments: (i) Maintenance and (ii) Factory office. Budgeted
cost data and relevant cost drivers are as follows:
Departmental costs:
Rs.
6,00,000
4.76
Overheads
Boat engine
17,00,000
Factory office
3,00,000
Maintenance
2,40,000
Cost drivers:
Factory office department:
No. of employees
1,080 employees
270 employees
Maintenance department
150 employees
1,500 employees
Maintenance department:
570 orders
190 orders
40 orders
800 orders
Required:
(i)
Compute the cost driver allocation percentage and then use these percentage to
allocate the service department costs by using direct method.
(ii)
Compute the cost driver allocation percentage and then use these percentage to
allocate the service department costs by using non-reciprocal method/step method.
Percent used
80%
Boat engine
20%
Maintenance dept:
Snowmobile engine
75%
Boat engine
25%
Percent used
72%
Boat engine
18%
Maintenance dept
10%
4.77
Cost Accounting
Maintenance dept:
Snowmobile engine
75%
Boat engine
25%
Question 46
RST Ltd. has two production departments: Machining and Finishing. There are three service
departments: Human Resource (HR), Maintenance and Design. The budgeted costs in these
service departments are as follows:
HR
Maintenance
Design
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Variable
1,00,000
1,60,000
1,00,000
3,00,000
6,00,000
Fixed
4,00,000
5,00,000
4,60,000
7,00,000
The usage of these Service Departments output during the year just completed is as follows:
Provision of Service Output (in hours of service)
Users of Service
HR
Maintenance
Design
Machining
Finishing
Total
Required:
Providers of Service
Maintenance
500
500
500
4,000
3,500
4,000
5,000
10,000
8,000
HR
Design
4,500
1,500
6,000
(i)
Use the direct method to re-apportion RST Ltd.s service department cost to its
production departments.
(ii)
Determine the proper sequence to use in re-apportioning the firms service department
cost by step-down method.
(iii) Use the step-down method to reapportion the firms service department cost.
Answer The proper sequence for apportionment of service department overheads is
First
HR
Second
Maintenance
Third
Design
The sequence has been laid down based on service provided.
4.78
CHAPTER 5
NON-INTEGRATED ACCOUNTS
BASIC CONCEPTS AND FORMULAE
Basic Concepts
1.
Cost Control Accounts: These are accounts maintained for the purpose of exercising
control over the costing ledgers and also to complete the double entry in cost accounts.
2.
3.
Non- Integral System of Accounting: A system of accounting where two sets of books
are maintained- (i) for costing transactions; and (ii) for financial transactions
4.
Reconciliation: In the Non-Integral System of Accounting, since the cost and financial
accounts are kept separately, it is imperative that those should be reconciled, otherwise
the cost accounts would not be reliable. The reason for differences in the cost & financial
accounts can be of purely financial nature( Income and expenses) and notional nature
Basic Formula
1.
A.
B.
(b)
Rs.
..
..
..
Cost Accounting
C.
D.
(c)
..
(d)
..
Rent received
..
..
..
..
(b)
..
(c)
..
(d)
..
..
Legal Charges
..
(..)
..
Non-integrated Accounts
2.
A suitable coding system must be made available so as to serve the accounting purposes of
financial and cost accounts.
3.
An agreed routine, with regard to the treatment of provision for accruals, prepaid expenses,
other adjustment necessary for preparation of interim accounts.
4.
Perfect coordination should exist between the staff responsible for the financial and cost
aspects of the accounts and an efficient processing of accounting documents should be
ensured.
Under this system there is no need for a separate cost ledger. Of course, there will be a
number of subsidiary ledgers; in addition to the useful Customers Ledger and the Bought Ledger,
there will be : (a) Stores Ledger; (b) Stock Ledger and (c) Job Ledger.
Question 2
What are the advantages of integrated accounting?
Answer
Advantages of Integrated Accounting:
Integrated Accounting is the name given to a system of accounting whereby cost and financial
accounts are kept in the same set of books. Such a system will have to afford full information
required for Costing as well as for Financial Accounts. In other words, information and data should
be recorded in such a way so as to enable the firm to ascertain the cost (together with the
necessary analysis) of each product, job, process, operation or any other identifiable activity. For
instance, purchases are analysed by nature of material and its end-use. Purchases account is
eliminated and direct postings are made to Stores Control Account, Work-in-Progress account, or
Overhead Account. Payroll is straightway analysed into direct labour and overheads. It also
ensures the ascertainment of marginal cost, variances, abnormal losses and gains. In fact all
information that management requires from a system of Costing for doing its work properly is made
available. The integrated accounts give full information in such a manner so that the profit and loss
account and the balance sheet can be prepared according to the requirements of law and the
management maintains full control over the liabilities and assets of its business.
The main advantages of Integrated Accounting are as follows:
(i)
Since there is one set of accounts, thus there is one figure of profit. Hence the question of
reconciliation of costing profit and financial profit does not arise.
(ii)
There is no duplication of recording of entries and efforts to maintain separate set of books.
(iii) Costing data are available from books of original entry and hence no delay is caused in
obtaining information.
5.3
Cost Accounting
(iv) The operation of the system is facilitated with the use of mechanized accounting.
(v)
Question 3
Write notes on Integrated Accounting
Answer
Integrated Accounting
Integrated Accounting is the name given to a system of accounting whereby cost and financial
accounts are kept in the same set of books. Such a system will have to afford full information
required for costing as well as for Financial Accounts. In other words, information and data should
be recorded in such a way so as to enable the firm to ascertain the cost (together with the
necessary analysis) of each product, job, process, operation or any other identifiable activity. For
instance, purchases analysed by nature of material and its end use. Purchases account is
eliminated and direct postings are made to Stores Control Account, Work-in-Progress accounts, or
Overhead Account. Payroll is straightway analysed into direct labour and overheads. It also
ensures the ascertainment of marginal cost, variances, abnormal losses and gains, In fact, all
information that management requires from a system of costing for doing its work properly is made
available. The integrated accounts give full information in such a manner so that the profit and loss
account and the balance sheet can be prepared according to the requirements of law and the
management maintains full control over the liabilities and assets of its business.
The main advantages of Integrated Accounting are as follows:
(i)
Since there is one set of accounts, thus there is one figure of profit. Hence the question of
reconciliation of costing profit and financial profit does not arise.
(ii)
There is no duplication of recording of entries and efforts in the separate set of books.
(iii)
Costing data are available from books of original entry and hence no delay is casued in
obtaining information.
(iv)
The operation of the system is facilitated with the use of mechanised accounting.
(v)
Question 4
Why is it necessary to reconcile the Profits between the Cost Accounts and Financial Accounts?
Answer
When the cost and financial accounts are kept separately, It is imperative that these should be
reconciled, otherwise the cost accounts would not be reliable. The reconciliation of two set of
5.4
Non-integrated Accounts
accounts can be made, if both the sets contain sufficient detail as would enable the causes of
differences to be located. It is, therefore, important that in the financial accounts, the expenses
should be analysed in the same way as in cost accounts. It is important to know the causes which
generally give rise to differences in the costs & financial accounts. These are:
(i)
Items included in financial accounts but not in cost accounts Appropriation of profits
Income-tax
Transfer to reserve
Dividends paid
(ii)
Interest, dividends
Notional rent
To ensure correct decision making by the management based on Cost & Financial data
Question 5
What are the reasons for disagreement of profits as per cost accounts and financial
accounts? Discuss.
Answer
Reasons for disagreement of profits as per cost and financial accounts
The various reasons for disagreement of profits shown by the two sets of books viz., cost and
financial may be listed as below:
5.5
Cost Accounting
1.
Income:
(a) Profit on sale of assets
(b) Interest received
(c)
Dividend received
Expenditure
(a) Loss on sale of assets
(b) Uninsured destruction of assets
(c)
5.6
Non-integrated Accounts
4. Different bases of stock valuation
In financial books, stocks are valued at cost or market price, whichever is lower. In cost
books, however, stock of materials may be valued on FIFO or LIFO basis and work-inprogress may be valued at prime cost or works cost. Differences in store valuation may thus
cause a difference between the two profits.
5. Depreciation
The amount of depreciation charge may be different in the two sets of books either because
of the different methods of calculating depreciation or the rates adopted. In company
accounts, for instance, the straight line method may be adopted whereas in financial accounts
It may be the diminishing balance method.
Question 6
What are the reasons for disagreement of Profits as per Financial accounts and Cost accounts?
Discuss?
Answer
Reasons for disagreement of Profits as per Financial accounts and Cost accounts are as below.
There are certain items which are included in Financial accounts but not in Cost Accounts.
Likewise there are certain items which are in Cost Accounts but not in Financial accounts.
Examples of financial charges which appear only in financial books are:
(i)
(ii)
(iii) Expenses relating to the issue and transfer of shares and debentures like stamps duty
expenses; discount on shares and debentures etc.
(iv) Penalties and fines.
Examples of incomes which are recorded in the financial books only are:
(i)
(ii)
Rental income.
There are abnormal or special items of expenditure and income which are not included in the cost
of production. Their inclusion in cost of production, would result into incorrect cost ascertainment.
5.7
Cost Accounting
Different bases of charging depreciation also accounts for the disagreement of profits as per
financial and cost accounts. Different methods of valuation of closing stock adopted in cost and
financial accounts will also account for the difference in profits under financial and cost accounts.
Question 7
Why is it necessary to reconcile the Profit between Cost Accounts and Financial Accounts?
Answer
Need for reconciliation: When cost and financial accounts are maintained separately, the profit
shown by one set of books may not agree with that of the other set. In such a situation, it becomes
necessary to reconcile the results (profit / loss) shown by two sets of books.
Causes for difference between profit shown by cost and financial accounts
(i)
There are certain items which appear in financial books only and are not recorded in cost
accounting books e.g. loss on sale of fixed assets; expenses on stamp duty; interest on bank
loan etc. Similarly, there may be some items which appear in cost accounts only and do not
find a place in the financial books e.g. notional rent; national interest etc.
(ii)
In cost accounts, overheads are generally absorbed on the basis of a pre-determined overhead
rate, whereas in financial accounts actual expenditure on overheads is recorded, this will also
cause a difference between the figure of profit shown under financial and cost account.
(ii)
Different methods of valuation of closing stock adopted in cost and financial accounts will also
cause a difference in the results shown by the two sets of books. In financial accounts the
method generally followed is cost or market price, whichever is less whereas in cost accounts
different methods of pricing of material issues such as LIFO, FIFO, average etc are used.
(iii) Use of different methods of depreciation is also responsible for the variation of profit shown by two
sets of books. In financial accounts, depreciation may be charged according to written down value
method whereas in cost accounts is may be charged on the basis of the life of the machine.
(iv) Abnormal items not included in cost accounts also causes a difference in profit. If such items
of expenses are included, cost ascertained will not be correct.
Question 8
Pass journal entries in the cost books, maintained on non-integrated system, for the following:
(i) Issue of materials:
Non-integrated Accounts
Answer
Journal Entries in Cost Books
Maintained on non-integrated system
Rs.
(i) Work-in-Progress Ledger Control A/c
Dr.
5,50,000
Dr.
1,50,000
Rs.
7,00,000
Dr.
2,00,000
Dr.
40,000
2,40,000
Dr.
20,000
20,000
Dr.
10,000
10,000
Debit
Credit
Rs.
Rs.
53,375
--
1,04,595
--
30,780
-1,88,750
5.9
Cost Accounting
Transactions for the quarter ended 30.06.2001 are as under:
Rs.
Materials purchased
26,700
40,000
900
77,500
95,200
3,200
Sales
2,56,000
The Companys gross profit is 25% on Factory Cost. At the end of the quarter, WIP stocks
increased by Rs. 7,500.
Prepare the relevant Control Accounts, Costing Profit and Loss Account and General Ledger
Adjustment Account to record the above transactions for the quarter ended 30.06.2001.
Answer
(a)
Dr.
Particulars
To Sales
To Balance c/d
Dr.
Particulars
Cr.
Rs.
1,88,750
26,700
77,500
95,200
48,000
4,36,150
Cr.
Rs. Particulars
To Balance b/d
Rs.
40,000
900
39,175
80,075
80,075
5.10
Non-integrated Accounts
WIP control A/c
Dr.
Particulars
To Balance b/d
Cr.
Rs. Particulars
1,04,595 By Finished goods control A/c
54,500
Rs.
2,02,900
1,12,095
1,15,900
_______
3,14,995
3,14,995
Cr.
Rs. Particulars
30,780 By Cost of sales A/c
Rs.
2,04,800
(Refer to note)
To WIP control A/c
28,880
2,33,680
Note:
Gross profit is 25% of Factory cost or 20% on sales.
Hence cost of sales = Rs. 2,56,000 20% of Rs. 2,56,000 = Rs. 2,04,800
Factory overhead control A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
Rs. Particulars
Rs.
3,200
1,15,900
95,200
_______
1,19,100
1,19,100
5.11
Cost Accounting
Cost of sales A/c
Dr.
Particulars
To Finished goods control A/c
Rs. Particulars
2,04,800 By Costing Profit & Loss A/c
Cr.
Rs.
2,04,800
Sales A/c
Dr.
Particulars
To Costing Profit & Loss A/c
Rs. Particulars
2,56,000 By GLA A/c
Cr.
Rs.
2,56,000
Rs. Particulars
77,500 By Factory overhead control A/c
_____ By WIP control A/c
77,500
Cr.
Rs.
23,000
54,500
77,500
Cr.
Particulars
Rs. Particulars
Rs.
2,56,000
2,04,800
48,000
(Profit)
_______
_______
2,56,000
Trial Balance (as on 30.6.2001)
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
2,56,000
Rs.
39,175
1,12,095
28,880
______
1,80,150
1,80,150
1,80,150
5.12
Non-integrated Accounts
Question 10
BPR Limited keeps books on integrated accounting system. The following balances appear in the
books as on April 1,2002.
Dr. (Rs.)
40,950
38,675
52,325
1,47,875
27,300
9,975
3,17,100
The transactions for the year ended March 31,2003, were as given below:
Direct Wages
Indirect Wages
Purchase of materials (on credit)
Materials issued to production
Material issued for repairs
Goods finished during the year (at cost)
Credit Sales
Cost of Goods sold
Production overheads absorbed
Production overheads paid during the year
Production overheads outstanding at the end of year
Administration overheads paid during the year
Selling overheads incurred
5.13
Rs.
1,97,925
11,375
Cr. (Rs.)
22,750
18,200
1,82,000
11,375
3,725
6,250
72,800
3,17,100
Rs.
2,09,300
2,27,500
2,50,250
4,550
4,89,125
6,82,500
5,00,500
1,09,200
91,000
7,775
27,300
31,850
Cost Accounting
Payment to Creditors
Payment received from Debtors
Depreciation of Machinery
Administration overheads outstanding at the end of year
Provision for doubtful debts at the end of the year
Required:
2,29,775
6,59,750
14,789
2,225
4,590
Write up accounts in the integrated ledger of BPR Limited and prepare a Trial balance.
Answer
Stores Control A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
To Balance b/d
To Creditors A/c
Dr.
To Bank
2,50,250
4,550
13,650
2,68,450
Cr.
Rs.
To Bank
Rs.
Rs.
1,97,925
11,375
2,09,300
Work-in-Progress A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
To Balance b/d
Rs.
4,89,125
2,50,250
1,09,200
_______
5,96,050
5,96,050
5.14
1,06,925
Non-integrated Accounts
Production Overheads A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
To Bank
1,09,200
14,039
(91,000 6,250)
Written off)
To Production overheads
7,775
outstanding
To Provision for depreciation
14,789
_______
1,23,239
1,23,239
Cr.
Rs.
To Balance b/d
To Work-in-progress A/c
Rs.
5,00,500
80,450
39,500
_______
5,80,950
5,80,950
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
39,500
27,300
2,225
_____
39,500
39,500
5.15
Cost Accounting
Cost of Sales A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
5,32,350
31,850
______
5,32,350
5,32,350
Sales A/c
Dr.
To Cost of sales A/c
To Profit & Loss A/c
Rs.
5,32,350 By Debtors A/c
1,50,150
6,82,500
Cr.
Rs.
6,82,500
______
6,82,500
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
To Bank
6,250
To Balance c/d
7,775
14,025
14,025
Cr.
Rs.
To Balance b/d
Rs.
9,975
9,975
9,975
Cr.
Rs.
To Balance c/d
Rs.
11,375
14,789
26,164
26,164
5.16
Non-integrated Accounts
Provision for doubtful debts A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
To Balance c/d
Rs.
3,725
865
4,590
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
72,800
1,50,150
2,08,046
______
2,22,950
2,22,950
Debtors A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
To Balance b/d
To Sales A/c
Rs.
6,59,750
50,050
7,09,800
Creditors A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
To Bank
To Balance c/d
5.17
Rs.
18,200
2,27,500
2,45,700
Cost Accounting
Fixed Assets A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
1,47,875
Bank A/c
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
To Debtors
Rs.
22,750
By Direct wages
1,97,925
By Indirect wages
11,375
By Production overheads
91,000
27,300
31,850
By Creditors A/c
2,29,775
47,775
6,59,750
6,59,750
Trial Balance
As on March 31, 2003
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
13,650
1,06,925
80,450
Bank A/c
47,775
Creditors A/c
15,925
1,47,875
Debtors A/c
50,050
1,82,000
26,164
5.18
Non-integrated Accounts
2,08,046
7,775
2,225
______
4,590
4,46,725
4,46,725
Question 11
The Chief Cost Accountant of Omega Limited found to his surprise that the profit was the same as
per cost accounts as well as the financial accounts. He asked his deputy to find out the reasons for
the same. You are required to analyse and suggest a Reconciliation Statement is necessary or not.
Answer
Chief Cost Account of M/s Omega Ltd. noticed that the profit of the concern under Cost and
Financial Accounting Systems was the same. This fact indicates that the concern was using a nonintegrated accounting system. The figure of profit under Cost and Financial accounts will be the
same when the amount of total under charges equal to the amount of total overcharges in each set
of books.
The statement of profit under Cost Accounts is usually prepared on the basis of standard/budgeted
figures in respect of various elements of cost, whereas it is prepared on actual basis under
financial accounts.
Consider the following assumed statements of profit as per Cost and Financial Accounts of M/s.
Omega Ltd. to ascertain the reasons, which account for the figure of profit to be same under two
sets of accounts.
Statement of Profit of M/s Omega Ltd. as per Cost A/c
Rs.
Direct Material:
Rs.
2,75,000
1,87,500
Prime Cost
4,62,500
60,000
Fixed:
75,000
5.19
1,35,000
Cost Accounting
Factory Cost
5,97,500
50,000
Cost of Production:
6,47,500
30,000
Fixed:
63,500
Cost of Sales
93,500
7,41,000
Profit:
9,000
Sales:
7,50,000
Statement of Profit & Loss Account of M/s Omega Ltd.
Rs.
To Direct Materials
3,00,000 By Sales
To Direct Wages
To Factory expenses
1,20,000
To Office express
40,000
80,000
Rs.
7,50,000
To Legal expenses
1,000
To Net profit
9,000
_______
7,50,000
7,50,000
An analysis of Cost and Financial profit statement indicates the following facts:
(1) The profit of the concern under two sets of accounts is the same i.e. Rs. 9,000.
(2) A sum of Rs. 25,000 is under charged in Cost Accounts on account of direct material cost. The
estimated cost on this account was Rs. 2,75,000 whereas actual cost incurred amounted to
Rs. 3,00,000.
(3) Similarly, a sum of Rs. 12,500 is under charged in Cost Accounts on account of direct wages.
Estimated costs were Rs. 1,87,500 whereas actual costs comes to Rs. 2,00,000.
(4) A sum of Rs. 1,000 towards legal expenses is only charged in financial accounts and was not
shown in Cost Accounts.
5.20
Non-integrated Accounts
(5) A sum of Rs. 15,000 difference between budgeted and actual factory overheads is overcharged in Cost Accounts.
(6) A sum of Rs. 10,000 difference between budgeted and actual office overheads is overcharged
in Cost Accounts.
(7) A sum of Rs. 13,500 difference between budgeted and actual selling and distribution
overheads is overcharged in Cost Accounts.
Thus, the total amount of under charges is equal to total amount of over charges in each set of
books and it is equal to Rs. 38,500. As a result, the profit was the same as per cost accounts as
well as the financial accounts. The above analysis also indicates that though the figure of profit
under two sets of accounts is same but the figures of material, labour and overhead costs differ. It
also points out items, which are present in financial accounts and not in cost accounts.
The statement of reconciliation is necessary, as the two sets of accounts are non-integrated. It is
only the reconciliation statement which would indicate the amount of under charges and overcharges for different elements of cost. The knowledge of under charges and over-charges would
enable the management to initiate necessary action for control purposes. For example, in the case
of M/s Omega Ltd., the sum of Rs. 25,000 more has been spent on the materials for the
manufacturing of 2,50,000 units of the product. This is known as material cost variance. This
variance may arise either due to excess material usage or price Information about the occurrence
of variances is provided by a statement of reconciliation to the accountants, so that necessary
control action may be taken. Such a statement also includes the items which have not been
included in Cost Accounts but are present in Financial Accounts.
Question 12
The financial books of a company reveal the following data for the year ended 31st March, 2002:
Opening Stock:
Rs.
74,375
Work-in-process
32,000
1.4.01 to 31.3.02
Raw materials consumed
7,80,000
Direct Labour
4,50,000
Factory overheads
3,00,000
Goodwill
1,00,000
Administration overheads
2,95,000
Dividend paid
85,000
5.21
Cost Accounting
Bad Debts
12,000
61,000
Interest received
45,000
Rent received
18,000
20,80,000
41,250
Work-in-process
The cost records provide as under:
38,667
Selling and distribution overheads are charged at Rs. 4 per unit sold.
The company values work-in-process at factory cost for both Financial and Cost Profit
Reporting.
Required:
(i)
(v)
Prepare statements for the year ended 31st March, 2002 show
Present a statement reconciling the profit as per costing records with the profit as per
Financial Records.
Answer
Statement of Profit as per financial records
OR
Profit & Loss Account of the company
(for the year ended March 31, 2002)
To Opening stock of Finished
Goods
To Work-in-process
To Raw materials consumed
Rs.
74.375 By Sales
32,000 By Closing stock of finished
Goods
7,80,000 By Work-in-Process
5.22
Rs.
20,80,000
41250
38,667
Non-integrated Accounts
To Direct labour
To Factory overheads
To Goodwill
To Administration overheads
To Selling & distribution overheads
To Dividend paid
To Bad debts
To Profit
18,000
45,000
________
22,22,917
20,80,000
(14,500 units)
Cost of sales:
Opening stock
91,000
17,92,000
48,000
_______
18,35,000
58,000
________
18,93,000
1,87,000
5.23
Cost Accounting
(ii)
Statement of Reconciliation
(Reconciling the profit as per costing records with the profit as per financial records)
Rs.
Rs.
1,87,000
3,667
45,000
Rent received
18,000
83,292
2,70,292
30,000
3,000
6,750
Goodwill
1,00,000
Dividend
85,000
Bad debts
12,000
2,36,750
33,542
Working notes:
1. Number of units produced
Units
Sales
14,500
375
Total
14,875
875
5.24
Non-integrated Accounts
14,000
2. Cost Sheet
Rs.
Raw materials consumed
7,80,000
Direct labour
4,50,000
Prime cost
12,30,000
Factory overheads
2,70,000
15,00,000
32,000
38,667
14,93,333
2,98,667
Administration overheads
(20% of factory cost)
Cost of production of 14,000 units
17,92,000
Question 13
A manufacturing company disclosed a net loss of Rs. 3,47,000 as per their cost accounts for the
year ended March 31,2003. The financial accounts however disclosed a net loss of
Rs. 5,10,000 for the same period. The following information was revealed as a result of scrutiny of
the figures of both the sets of accounts.
Rs.
(i) Factory Overheads under-absorbed
40,000
60,000
3,25,000
5.25
Cost Accounting
2,75,000
96,000
54,000
2,45,000
24,000
14,000
32,000
Cr.
Rs.
3,47,000
Rs.
By
Administration overheads
recovered in cost accounts
over
60,000
40,000
96,000
50,000
24,000
54,000
By Stores adjustment
14,000
Financial Accounts
32,000
books
_______
5,10,000
7,36,000
7,36,000
Question 14
The following figures have been extracted from the cost records of a manufacturing unit:
Rs.
Stores: Opening balance
32,000
Purchases of material
1,58,000
80,000
5.26
Non-integrated Accounts
Issues to work-in-progress
1,60,000
20,000
6,000
60,000
65,000
Overheads applied
2,40,000
Rs. Particulars
32,000 By W.I.P. Control A/c
Rs.
1,60,000
20,000
6,000
"Balance c/d
2,70,000
84,000
2,70,000
Rs. Particulars
60,000 By stores control A/c
Rs.
80,000
4,00,000
45,000
5,25,000
5.27
5,25,000
Cost Accounting
Works overhead control account
Particulars
Rs. Particulars
Rs.
2,40,000
30,000
2,70,000
Rs. Particulars
4,00,000 By
general
adjustment A/c
Rs.
ledger
Cost of sales
4,00,000
10% profit
To works overhead control
A/c
To stores
(shortage)
control
To profit
A/c
40,000
4,40,000
30,000
6,000
4,000
4,40,000
4,40,000
Rs. Particulars
To opening stock
Rs.
By sales
4,40,000
Stores
32,000
By
stock:
W.I.P.
60,000
92,000 Stores
84,000
W.I.P.
45,000
To purchases
closing
1,29,000
5.28
Non-integrated Accounts
To wages incurred
To overheads incurred
To loss on sale of
capital assets
70,000 By loss
11,000
2,50,000
20,000
5,90,000
5,90,000
Reconciliation statement
Rs.
Profit as per cost accounts
4,000
Add:
Income from investment recorded in financial accounts
10,000
14,000
Less:
Under absorption of wages in cost accounts
5,000
20,000
25,000
11,000
Question 15
The following is the Trading and Profit & Loss Account of Omega Limited:
Dr.
Particulars
Cr.
Rs.
Particulars
To Materials consumed
23,01,000
By Sales
To Direct wages
12,05,750
(30,000 units)
To Production Overheads
6,92,250
By Finished goods
To Administration Overheads
3,10,375
3,68,875
By Work-in-progress:
Rs.
48,75,000
1,30,000
22,750
Materials
55,250
45,500
Wages
26,000
To Fines
3,250
5.29
Production
Cost Accounting
To Interest on Mortgage
13,000
Overheads
16,250
By Dividends received
To Taxation
1,95,000
3,83,500
16,250
97,500
3,90,000
By Interest on bank
deposits
65,000
55,57,500
55,57,500
(ii)
Administration Overheads have been recovered at Rs. 9.75 per finished Unit.
(iii) Selling & distribution Overheads have been recovered at Rs. 13 per Unit sold.
(iv) The Under- or Over-absorption of Overheads has not been transferred to costing P/L
A/c.
Required:
(i)
Prepare a proforma Costing Profit & Loss account, indicating net profit.
(ii)
(iii) Prepare a statement reconciling the profit disclosed by the cost records with that shown
in Financial accounts.
Answer
(i)
Work in Progress
Manufacturing cost incurred during the period
Admn. Ohs (9.75 x 31000)
5.30
Rs.
23,01,000
12,05,750
35,06,750
7,01,350
42,08,100
97,500
41,10,600
3,02,250
Non-integrated Accounts
Cost of Production
Less
44,12,850
1,42,350
1000
)
31000
COGS
Add
Selling & distribution OHs ( 30,000 Rs. 13)
Cost of Sales
Profit
Sales
(ii) Production OH A/c
To Gen ledger Adj. A/c
To Bal. C/d
42,70,500
3,90,000
46,60,500
2,14,500
48,75,000
Rs
6,92,250 By WIP A/c
9,100
7,01,350
Admn. OH A/c
Rs
3,10,375 By Finished goods A/c
By bal c/d
3,10,375
Selling & Distribution OHs A/c
Rs
3,68,875 By Cost of Sales A/c
21,125
3,90,000
Rs
7,01,350
7,01,350
Rs
3,02,250
8,125
3,10,375
Rs
3,90,000
3,90,000
Add:
Less:
Rs
2,14,500
9,100
21,125
3,90,000
65,000
8,125
22,750
45,500
5.31
4,85,225
6,99,725
Cost Accounting
Fines
Interest on Mortgage
Loss on sale of machinery
Taxation
Write-down of Finished stock (1,42,350 130,000)
Profit as per Financial Accounts
3,250
13,000
16,250
1,95,000
12,350
3,16,225
3,83,500
Question 16
What is Integrated Accounting System? State its advantages.
Answer
Integrated Accounting System:
It is such a system of accounting whereby cost and financial accounts are kept in the same
set of books. Obviously, then there will be no separate set of books for costing and financial
records. Integrated accounts provide or meets out fully the information requirements for
costing as well as financial accounts.
Advantages of Integrated Accounting System:
(i)
The question of reconciling of costing and financial profits does not arise, as there is one
figure of profit only.
(ii)
Due to use of one set of books, there is significant extent of saving in efforts made.
(iii) No delay is caused in obtaining information as it is provided from books of original entry.
(iv) It is economical as it is based on the concept of centralisation of Accounting function.
Question 17
ABC Ltd. has furnished the following information from the financial books for the year ended 31st
March, 2007:
Profit & Loss Account
Rs.
To
Opening stock
(500 units at Rs. 140 each)
Material consumed
Wages
Gross profit c/d
70,000
10,40,000
Rs.
By
By
Closing stock
(250 units at Rs. 200 each)
28,70,000
50,000
6,00,000
12,10,000
________
29,20,000
29,20,000
5.32
Non-integrated Accounts
To
Factory overheads
3,79,000
Administration overheads
4,24,000
Interest
Selling expenses
2,20,000
Rent received
Bad debts
16,000
Preliminary expenses
20,000
Net profit
By
12,10,000
1,000
40,000
1,92,000
________
12,51,000
12,51,000
The cost sheet shows the cost of materials at Rs. 104 per unit and the labour cost at Rs. 60 per
unit. The factory overheads are absorbed at 60% of labour cost and administration overheads at
20% of factory cost. Selling expenses are charged at Rs. 24 per unit. The opening stock of
finished goods is valued at Rs. 180 per unit.
You are required to prepare:
(i)
A statement showing profit as per Cost accounts for the year ended 31st March, 2007; and
(ii)
A statement showing the reconciliation of profit as disclosed in Cost accounts with the profit
shown in Financial accounts.
Answer
(i)
Rs.
500
90,000
10,000
24,00,000
Total
10,500
24,90,000
250
60,000
10,250
24,30,000
2,46,000
Cost of sales
26,76,000
Profit
______
1,94,000
Sales
10,250
28,70,000
5.33
Cost Accounting
Working Notes:
(i)
Rs.
Rs.
10,40,000
104.00
Wages
6,00,000
60.00
3,60,000
36.00
20,00,000
200.00
4,00,000
40.00
Total cost
24,00,000
(ii) Statement of differences between the two set of accounts:
240.00
Materials
Factory cost
Administrative overhead 20% of factory cost
Financial A/c
Cost A/c
Difference
Remarks
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Factory overhead
3,79,000
3,60,000
19,000
Under recovery
Administrative
overhead
4,24,000
4,00,000
24,000
Under recovery
Selling expenses
2,20,000
2,46,000
26,000
Over recovery
Opening stock
70,000
90,000
20,000
Over recovery
Closing stock
50,000
60,000
10,000
Over recovery
(ii)
Reconciliation Statement
Rs.
Profit as per cost accounts
1,94,000
19,000
Administrative Overhead
24,000
43,000
+26,000
+20,000
10,000
1,000
5.34
Non-integrated Accounts
Rent
40,000
+41,000
16,000
Preliminary expenses
20,000
36,000
1,92,000
Question 18
Discuss the reasons for disagreement of profits as per Cost Accounting and Financial Accounting.
Answer
Reasons for disagreement of profits as per Cost Accounting and Financial Accounting:
Items included in the financial accounts but not in Cost Accounts
(i)
Appropriation of profits
(i)
Income tax
(ii)
(ii)
Dividends received
Transfer fees
(vi) Damages/penalties
(iii) Items included in Cost Accounting
(i)
(ii)
5.35
Cost Accounting
Question 19
(a) The following figures have been extracted from the cost records of a manufacturing company:
Stores
Opening Balance
Purchases
Transfer from Work-in-progress
Issues to Work-in-progress
Issues to Repairs and Maintenance
Deficiencies found in Stock taking
Work-in-progress:
Opening Balance
Direct Wages applied
Overhead Applied
Closing Balance
Finished Products:
Rs.
63,000
3,36,000
1,68,000
3,36,000
42,000
12,600
1,26,000
1,26,000
5,04,000
84,000
Rs.
To
Balance c/d
To
General
Ledger
Adjustment A/c
By
Overhead A/c
3,36,000
Work-in-progress A/c
1,68,000 By
Overhead A/c
To
63,000 By
Work-in-progress
(Deficiency Assumed as
Normal)
_______ By
5,67,000
Balance c/d
3,36,000
42,000
12,600
1,76,400
5,67,000
5.36
Non-integrated Accounts
Work-in-progress Control Account
Rs.
To
Balance b/d
To
Stores
Control A/c
To
To
Rs.
1,26,000 By
Ledger
By
1,68,000
3,36,000
Work-in-progress
A/c
Overhead
(applied)
Balancing figure)
8,40,000
1,26,000
By
A/c
Balance c/d
84,000
5,04,000
10,92,000
10,92,000
Work-in-Progress A/c
Rs.
8,40,000 By
General Ledger
Adjustment A/c Sales
(8,40,000 + 84,000)
To
General Ledger
Adjustment A/c (Profit)
9,24,000
84,000
_______
9,24,000
9,24,000
Opening Stock
Stores
WIP
63,000
1,26,000
To
To
To
Purchases
Wages
Overhead
To
B
y
B
y
1,89,000 B
y
3,36,000
1,47,000
5,25,000 B
y
42,000
12,39,000
5.37
Rs.
Sales
Income from
investment
Closing Stock
Stores
WIP
Loss
1,76,400
84,000
9,24,000
21,000
2,60,400
33,600
_______
12,39,000
Cost Accounting
Reconciliation Statement
Rs.
Profit as per Cost Account
84,000
21,000
1,05,000
96,600
42,000
1,38,600
Rs.
To
42,000 By
Work-in-Progress
To
12,600 By
Balanced c/d
To
5,04,000
96,600
Indirect Wages
(1,47,000 1,26,000)
To
21,000
5,25,000
_______
6,00,600
6,00,600
Question 20
Enumerate the factors which cause difference in profits as shown in Financial Accounts and Cost
Accounts.
Answer
Causes of difference:
(a) Items included in financial accounts but not in cost accounts such as:
Interest received on bank deposits, loss/profit on sale of fixed assets and investments,
dividend, rent received.
5.38
Non-integrated Accounts
(b) Items included in cost accounts on notional basis such as rent of owned building,
interest on own capital etc.
(c)
Items whose treatment is different in the two sets of accounts such as inventory
valuation.
Question 21
Explain essential pre-requisites for integrated accounts.
Answer
Essential pre-requisites for integrated accounts:
(a) The managements decision about the extent of integration of the two sets of books.
(b) A suitable coding system must be made available so as to serve the accounting purposes of
financial and cost accounts.
(c)
An agreed routine, with regard to the treatment of provision for accruals, prepaid expenses,
other adjustment necessary for preparation of interim accounts.
(d) Perfect coordination should exist between the staff responsible for the financial and cost
accounts and an efficient processing of accounting document should be ensured.
Question 22
As of 31st March, 2008, the following balances existed in a firms cost ledger, which is maintained
separately on a double entry basis:
Debit
Credit
Rs.
Rs.
3,00,000
1,50,000
2,50,000
15,000
6,85,000
7,00,000
7,00,000
2,25,000
5.39
Cost Accounting
85,000
1,25,000
Factory wages
40,000
Indirect labour
20,000
Cost of sales
1,75,000
1,35,000
9,000
13,000
To
To
Balance c/d
Rs.
13,000 By
9,42,000 By
By
_______ By
Opening Balance
6,85,000
1,25,000
Manufacturing
Control A/c
Overhead
9,55,000
85,000
60,000
9,55,000
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
To
Opening Balance
3,00,000 By
To
1,25,000 By
_______ By
4,25,000
Balance c/d
1,35,000
13,000
2,77,000
4,25,000
5.40
Non-integrated Accounts
WIP Control Account
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
To
Opening Balance
To
To
To
Manufacturing
Control A/c
Rs.
1,50,000 By
40,000 By
Finished Stock
Control A/c
Ledger
Balance c/d
2,25,000
1,85,000
1,35,000
Overhead
85,000
_______
4,10,000
Finished Stock Ledger Control Account
Dr.
4,10,000
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
To
Opening Balance
2,50,000 By
Cost of Sales
1,75,000
To
2,25,000 By
Balance c/d
3,09,000
To
9,000
_______
4,84,000
4,84,000
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
To
85,000 By
Opening Balance
15,000
To
20,000 By
85,000
_______ By
1,05,000
5,000
1,05,000
Cr.
Rs.
To
Rs.
By
60,000
5.41
40,000
Cost Accounting
By
Manufacturing Overhead
Control A/c
______
60,000
20,000
60,000
Cr.
Rs.
To
Rs.
By
1,75,000
_______ By
Balance c/d
1,75,000
Trial Balance
Rs.
Stores Ledger Control A/c
1,85,000
3,09,000
9,000
1,66,000
1,75,000
Rs.
9,42,000
5,000
1,66,000
_______
9,42,000
9,42,000
5.42
Non-integrated Accounts
EXERCISE
Question 1
Write short note on Cost Ledger Control Account
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 5 i.e. Non Integrated Accounts of Study Material
Question 2
After the annual stock taking you come to know of some significant discrepancies between book
stock and physical stock. You gather the following information:
Items
Stock Card
Stores Ledger
Physical Check
Cost/Unit
Units
Units
Units
Rs.
600
600
560
60
380
380
385
40
750
780
720
10
(a) What action should be taken to record the information shown above.
(b) Suggest reasons for the shortage and discrepancies disclosed above and recommend a
possible course of action by management to prevent future losses.
(Your answer should be in points and you need not elaborate).
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 5 i.e. Non Integrated Accounts of Study Material
Question 3
What are the essential pre-requisites of integrated accounting system?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 5 i.e. Non Integrated Accounts of Study Material
Question 4
What are the advantages of integrated accounting?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 5 i.e. Non Integrated Accounts of Study Material
Question 5
What do you understand by integrated accounting system? State its advantages and prerequisites.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 5 i.e. Non Integrated Accounts of Study Material
5.43
Cost Accounting
Question 6
Write notes on Integrated Accounting
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 5 i.e. Non Integrated Accounts of Study Material
Question 7
Reconciliation of cost and financial accounts in the modern computer age is redundant. Comment.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 5 i.e. Non Integrated Accounts of Study Material
Question 8
From the following data write up the various accounts as you envisage in the cost ledger and
prepare a trial balance as on 31st March 1984.
(b) Balance as on 1st April 1983:
Rs. (in thousands)
Material Control
1,240
Work-in-Progress
625
Finished Goods
1,240
Production Overhead
84
Administrative Overhead
120 (cr.)
65
3,134
4,801
Issued to :
Jobs
4,774
Maintenance works
412
Administration offices
34
Selling Department
72
Direct Wages
1,493
5.44
Non-integrated Accounts
Indirect Wages
650
Carriage Inward
84
Production Overheads:
Incurred
2,423
Absorbed
3,591
Administration overheads:
Incurred
740
Allocated to Production
529
Allocated to sales
148
Sales overheads:
Incurred
642
Absorbed
820
9,584
9,773
Sales realisation
12,430
Question 9
The following balances are shown in the cost ledger of Vinak Ltd. As on 31st Oct. 1981:
Dr. (Rs.)
Work in Progress Account
Cr. (Rs.)
7,056
360
5,274
9,450
180
22,320
5.45
Cost Accounting
Transactions for the year ended 30th September 1982 were:
Rs.
Stores issued to production
45,370
Stores purchased
52,400
1,135
57,600
1,18,800
Administration expenses
5,400
Selling expenses
6,000
Factory overheads
15,600
1,500
Rs.
Finished goods transferred to warehouse
1,08,000
2,000
16,830
4,580
3,080
5,500
150
850
14,274
You are required to record the entries in the cost ledger for the year ended
and prepare a trial balance as on that date.
30 th
September, 1982
5.46
Non-integrated Accounts
80
20
430
10
540
Wages
Works Overheads
Purchased
40
Issued to production
50
150
Indirect wages
40
10
160
20
8
Rayalty paid
Selling,
distribution
and
administration overheads sales
At the end of the month, the stock of raw material and work-in-progress was Rs. 55 lakhs Rs. 25
lakhs respectively. The loss arising in the raw material account is treated as factory overhead. The
building under construction was completed during the month. Companys gross profit margin is
20% on sales.
Prepare the relevant control accounts to record the above transactions in the cost ledger of
company.
Answer Total of Trial Balance Rs. In (lakhs) 483
5.47
Cost Accounting
Question 11
A fire destroyed some accounting records of a company. You have been able to collect the
following from the spoilt papers/records and as a result of consultation with accounting staff in
respect of January 1997:
(i)
Beginning Inventory
Rs.
32,000
Work-in-Progress A/c
Rs.
Beginning Inventory
Rs.
1,51,000
Creditors A/c
Rs.
Rs.
Opening Balance
Closing Balance
16,400
16,200
Manufacturing Overheads A/c
Rs.
Amount Spent
Rs.
29,600
Finished Goods A/c
Rs.
Opening Inventory
Rs.
24,000
Closing Inventory
(ii)
30,000
Additional Information:
(1)
The cash-book showed that Rs. 89,200 have been paid to creditors for raw-material.
(2)
Ending inventory of work-in-progress included material Rs. 5,000 on which 300 direct
labour hours have been booked against wages and overheads.
(3)
The job card showed that workers have worked for 7,000 hours. The wage rate is Rs.
10 per labour hour.
5.48
Non-integrated Accounts
(4)
You are required to complete the above accounts in the cost ledger of the company.
Answer Raw-materials A/c
Work-in-progress A/c
Creditors A/c
Question 12
In the absence of the Chief Accountant, you have been asked to prepare a months cost accounts
for a company which operates a batch costing system fully integrated with the financial accounts.
The following relevant information is provided to you.
Rs.
Rs.
25,000
20,000
35,000
3,000
75,000
Material issued
To Production
30,000
To Factory Maintenance
4,000
34,000
25,000
To Indirect workers
5,000
30,000
20,000
5,000
6,000
5.49
Cost Accounting
12,000
Sales
1,00,000
80,000
Cost of Goods completed and transferred into finished goods during the month
65,000
40,000
The production overhead absorption rate is 150% of direct wages charged to work
in progress
Required:
Prepare the following accounts for the month:
(a) Stores Ledger Control Account.
(b) Work in Progress Control Account.
(c) Finished Goods Control Account.
(d) Production Overhead Control Account.
(e) Profit and Loss Account.
Answer
(a) Stores Ledger Control Account.
Question 13
On 31st March, 1989 the following balances were extracted from the books of the Supreme
Manufacturing Company.
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
35,000
38,000
25,000
_____
98,000
98,000
98,000
5.50
Non-integrated Accounts
The following transactions took place in April 1989
Rs.
Raw Materials
Purchased
95,000
Returned to suppliers
3,000
Issued to production
98,000
Returned to stores
3,000
Productive wages
40,000
Indirect labour
25,000
50,000
40,000
2,13,000
2,10,000
Sales
3,00,000
Factory overheads are applied to production at 150% of direct wages, any under/over absorbed
overhead being carried forward for adjustment in the subsequent months. All administrative and
selling expenses are treated as period costs and charged off to the Profit and Loss Account of the
month in which they are incurred.
Show the following Accounts:
(a) Cost Ledger Control A/c
(b) Stores Ledger Control A/c
(c)
5.51
Cost Accounting
(Narrations are not required)
Rs.
Raw Materials Purchased (50% on Credit)
6,00,000
4,00,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
80,000
1,00,000
40,000
5,00,000
7,50,000
Closing Stock
Nil
2,00,000
Payments to Creditors
2,00,000
Answer (i) Stores Ledger Account (Dr.), Sunday Creditors Account (Cr.) Cash or Bank Account
(Cr.) (ii) Work-in-Progress Control Account Dr., Stores Ledger Control Account Cr. (iii) Wages
Control Account Dr., Cash or Bank Account Cr. (iv) Selling and Distribution Overheads Control
Account Dr., Cash or Bank Account Cr.(v) Finished Stock Ledger Control Account Dr., Work-inProgress Control Account Cr.,(vi) Cost of Sales Account Dr., Finished Stock Ledger Control
Account Cr., Selling and Distribution Overheads Control Account Cr. (vii) Sundry Debtors Account
Dr., Cash or Bank Account Dr., Sales Account Cr. (viii) Cash or Bank Account Dr., Sundry Debtors
Account Cr.(ix) Sundry Creditors Account Dr., Cash or Bank Account Cr. (x) Work-in-Progress
Control Account Dr., Wages Control Account Cr. (xi) Factory Overheads Control Account Dr.,
Wages Control Account Cr. (xii) Factory Overheads Control Account Dr., Cash or Bank Account
Cr. (xiii) Work-in-Progress Control Account Dr., Factory Overheads Control Account Cr.
Question 15
The following balances were extracted from a companys ledger as on 31st December 1997.
Rs.
Rs.
48,836
14,745
21,980
______
85,561
85,561
85,561
5.52
Non-integrated Accounts
Further transaction took place during the following quarter as follows:
Rs.
Factory overhead allocated to WIP
11,786
36,834
22,422
18,370
42,000
17,000
1,000
1,300
1,800
3,000
By Balance c/d
(Rs.) 51,958
By Balance c/d
(Rs.) 23,267
By Balance c/d
(Rs.) 19,814
To Balance c/d
(Rs.) 95,039
Question 16
The following figures are extracted from the Financial Accounts of Sellwel Ltd. For the year ended
31-12-1984:
Rs.
Rs.
50,00,000
Materials
20,00,000
Wages
10,00,000
Factory Overheads
9,00,000
Administrative Overheads
5,20,000
3,60,000
3,00,000
5.53
Cost Accounting
Work-in-progress:
Materials
60,000
Labour
40,000
Factory Overheads
40,000
1,40,000
4,00,000
6,00,000
2,20,000
Question 17
The financial records of Modern Manufacturers Ltd. reveal the following for the year ended 30-61986:
Rs. in thousands
Rs.
Sales (20,000 units)
4,000
Materials
1,600
Wages
800
Factory Overheads
720
416
288
240
Work-in-progress
48
Labour
32
Overheads (Factory)
32
112
320
Interest on Capital
32
5.54
Non-integrated Accounts
In the Costing records, factory overhead is charged at 100% wages, administration overhead 10%
of factory cost and selling and distribution overhead at the rate of Rs. 16 per unit sold.
Prepare a statement reconciling the profit as per cost records with the profit as per financial
records of the company.
Answer Profit as per Cost Accounts(Rs.) 4, 80,000
Profit as per Financial Accounts (Rs.) 1, 76,000
Question 18
Given below is the Trading and Profit and Loss Account of a Company for the year ended 31st
March, 1993:
Rs.
Rs.
To Materials
27,40,000 By Sales
To Wages
To Factory Expenses
To Admn. Expenses
To Selling Expenses
4,50,000
60,00,000
1,60,000
Rs.
Materials
64,000
Wages
36,000
Expenses
Factory Expenses
20,000
Written off
To Preliminary
1,20,000
18,000
3,25,600
_______
62,98,000
The Company manufactures standard units. In the Cost Accounts:
62,98,000
To Net Profit
(i)
(ii)
3,40,646
3,25,600
5.55
Cost Accounting
Question 19
M/s Sellwell Ltd. has furnished you the following information from the financial books for the year
ended 31st December, 1993:
Profit & Loss Account
For the year ended 31st December, 1993
Rs.
Opening stock of finished goods:
Rs.
6,250
75,000
1,51,250
_______
3,65,000
3,65,000
Factory overheads
Administration overheads
53,000 Interest
Selling expenses
Bad Debts
2,000
Preliminary expenses
2,500
Net Profit
3,58,750
24,000
1,51,250
125
5,000
______
1,56,375
1,56,375
The cost sheet shows: (i) the cost of materials as Rs. 13 per unit; (ii) the labour cost as Rs. 7.50
per unit; (iii) the factory overheads are absorbed at 60% of labour cost; (iv) the administration
overheads are absorbed at 20% of factory cost; (v) selling expenses are charged at Rs. 3 per unit;
(vi) the opening stock of finished goods is valued at Rs. 22.50 per unit.
You are required to prepare:
(i)
The cost sheet showing the number of units produced and the cost of production, by
elements of costs, per unit and in total.
(ii)
The statement of profit or loss as per cost accounts for the year ended 31st December, 1993.
(iii) The statement showing the reconciliation of profit or loss as shown by the cost accounts with
the profit as shown by the financial accounts.
Answer Profit as per Cost Accounts (Rs.)
24,250
5.56
Non-integrated Accounts
Profit as per Financial Accounts (Rs.)
24,000
Question 20
The following figures have been extracted from the Financial Accounts of a Manufacturing Firm for
the first year of its operation:
Rs.
Direct Material Consumption
50,00,000
Direct Wages
30,00,000
Factory Overheads
16,00,000
Administrative Overheads
7,00,000
9,60,000
Bad Debts
80,000
40,000
Legal Charges
10,000
Dividends Received
1,00,000
20,000
1,20,00,000
Closing Stocks:
Finished Goods (4,000 units)
3,20,000
Work in Progress
2,40,000
The cost accounts for the same period reveal that the direct material consumption was Rs.
56,00,000. Factory overhead is recovered at 20% on prime cost. Administration overhead is
recovered at Rs. 6 per unit of production. Selling and distribution overheads are recovered at Rs. 8
per unit sold.
Prepare the Profit and Loss Accounts both as per financial records and as per cost records.
Reconcile the profits as per the two records.
Answer Profit as per Cost Accounts (Rs.) 5,65,160
Profit as per Financial Accounts (Rs.)
12,90,000
5.57
Cost Accounting
Question 21
The following information is available from the financial books of a company having a normal
production capacity of 60,000 units for the year ended 31st March, 1995:
(j)
(ii)
(iii) Direct material and direct wages cost were Rs. 5,00,000 and Rs. 2,50,000 respectively.
(iv) Actual factory expenses were Rs. 1,50,000 of which 60% are fixed.
(v)
Actual administrative expenses were Rs. 45,000 which are completely fixed.
(vi) Actual selling and distribution expenses were Rs. 30,000 of which 40% are fixed.
(vii) Interest and dividends received Rs. 15,000.
You are required to:
(a) Find out profit as per financial books for the year ended 31st March, 1995;
(b) Prepare the cost sheet and ascertain the profit as per cost accounts for the year ended
31st March, 1995 assuming that the indirect expenses are absorbed on the basis of
normal production capacity; and
(c)
Dr.
Cr.
Rs.
Rs.
500
480
20
5.58
CHAPTER 6
Job Costing : According to this method costs are collected and accumulated according
to jobs, contracts, products or work orders. Each job or unit of production is treated as a
separate entity for the purpose of costing. Job costing is carried out for the purpose of
ascertaining cost of each job and takes into account the cost of materials, labour and
overhead etc
Meaning of spoiled and decective work under job costing:Spoiled :- Produced units can not be rectified.
Defective:- Units can be rectified with some additional cost.
2.
Batch Costing: This is a form of job costing. Under job costing, executed job is
used as a cost unit, whereas under batch costing, a lot of similar units which
comprises the batch may be used as a cost unit for ascertaining cost. In the case of
batch costing separate cost sheets are maintained for each batch of products by
assigning a batch number.
3. Economic Batch Quantity: There is one particular batch size for which both set up and
carrying costs are minimum. This size is known as economic or optimum batch quantity.
Question 1
Describe job Costing and Batch Costing giving example of industries where these are used?
Answer
Job Costing: It is a method of costing which is used when the work is undertaken as per the
customers special requirement. When an inquiry is received from the customer, costs expected to
be incurred on the job are estimated and on the basis of this estimate, a price is quoted to the
customer. Actual cost of materials, labour and overheads are accumulated and on the completion
of job, these actual costs are compared with the quoted price and thus the profit or loss on it is
determined.
Cost Accounting
Job costing is applicable in printing press, hardware, ship-building, heavy machinery, foundry,
general engineering works, machine tools, interior decoration, repairs and other similar work.
Batch Costing: It is a variant of job costing. Under batch costing, a lot of similar units which
comprises the batch may be used as a unit for ascertaining cost. In the case of batch costing
separate cost sheets are maintained for each batch of products by assigning a batch number. Cost
per unit in a batch is ascertained by dividing the total cost of a batch by the number of units
produced in that batch.
Such a method of costing is used in the case of pharmaceutical or drug industries, readymade
garment industries, industries, manufacturing electronic parts of T.V. radio sets etc.
Question 2
Distinguish between Job Costing & Batch Costing?
Answer
Job Costing and Batch Costing
Accounting to job costing, costs are collected and accumulated according to job. Each job or unit of
production is treated as a separate entity for the purpose of costing. Job costing may be employed
when jobs are executed for different customers according to their specification.
Batch costing is a form of job costing, a lot of similar units which comprises the batch may be used
as a cost unit for ascertaining cost. Such a method of costing is used in case of pharmaceutical
industry, readymade garments, industries manufacturing parts of TV, radio sets etc.
Question 3
Distinguish between job costing and process costing?
Answer
The main points which distinguishes job costing and process costing are as below:
Job Costing
Process Costing
(i)
(ii)
(v)
Question 4
Define Product costs. Describe three different purposes for computing product costs.
Answer
Definition of product costs
Product costs are inventoriable costs. These are the costs, which are assigned to the product.
Under marginal costing variable manufacturing costs and under absorption costing, total
manufacturing costs constitute product costs.
Purposes for computing product costs:
The three different purposes for computing product costs are as follows:
(i)
(ii)
Product pricing: It is an important purpose for which product costs are used. For this purpose,
the cost of the areas along with the value chain should be included to make the product
available to the customer.
(iii) Contracting with government agencies: For this purpose government agencies may not allow
the contractors to recover research and development and marketing costs under cost plus
contracts.
Question 5
In Batch Costing, how is Economic Batch Quantity determined?
Answer
Economic batch quantity in Batch Costing
In batch costing the most important problem is the determination of Economic Batch Quantity
6.3
Cost Accounting
The determination of economic batch quantity involves two type of costs viz, (i) set up cost and (ii)
carrying cost. With the increase in the batch size, there is an increase in the carrying cost but the
set-up cost per unit of the product is reduced; this situation is reversed when the batch size is
reduced. Thus there is one particular batch size for which both set up and carrying costs are
minimum. This size of a batch is known as economic or optimum batch quantity.
Economic batch quantity can be determined with the help of a table, graph or mathematical
formula. The mathematical formula usually used for its determination is as follows:
EBQ=
Where,
2DC
C
D = Annual demand for the product
S = Setting up cost per batch
C = Carrying cost per unit of production per annum
Question 6
(a) A factory incurred the following expenditure during the year 2007:
Rs.
Direct material consumed
12,00,000
Manufacturing Wages
7,00,000
Manufacturing overhead:
Fixed
3,60,000
Variable
2,50,000
6,10,000
25,10,000
In the year 2008, following changes are expected in production and cost of production.
(i)
Production will increase due to recruitment of 60% more workers in the factory.
(ii)
(iii) There will be an increase of 20% in Fixed overhead and 60% in Variable overhead.
(iv) The cost of direct material will be decreased by 6%.
(v)
Ascertain the cost of production and selling price. (May, 2008, 8 marks)
6.4
Amount Rs.
12,00,000
5,28,000
17,28,000
1,03,680
7,00,000
4,20,000
Prime cost
16,24,320
11,20,000
27,44,320
Manufactured Overhead:
Fixed
3,60,000
72,000
4,32,000
Variable
2,50,000
1,50,000
4,00,000
Cost of production
8,32,000
35,76,320
3,97,368.88
Selling price
39,73,688.88
6.5
Cost Accounting
Alternative Solution:
Students may use a combined factor to arrive at the figures in respect of materials and
variable overheads as under:
2007 production
100
Increase in 2008:60%
= 160%
Direct materials
6.6
Deptt. A
Deptt. B
Rs. Lacs
Rs. Lacs
35.00
5.00
Direct labour
30.00
9.00
Variable overheads
45.00
18.00
Fixed overheads
40.00
32.00
150.00
64.00
Total
Selling Expenses:
Rs. in Lacs
Product P
24.60
Product Q
21.60
Product AR
Required:
16.80
(i)
(ii)
Answer
Input in Deptt. A 80,000 kgs.
Yield 85%
Therefore Output = 85% of 8,00,000 = 6,80,000 kgs.
Ratio of output for P and Q = 70 : 30.
Product of P = 70% of 6,80,000 = 4,76,000 kgs.
Product of Q = 30% of 6,80,000 = 2,04,000 kgs.
Statement showing apportionment of joint cost
P
Product kgs.
Total
4,76,000
2,04,000
Rs. 85.00
290.00
Rs. lakhs
Rs. lakhs
Rs. lakhs
404.60
591.60
996.20
24.60
21.60
46.20
Net sales
380
570
950
Ratio
40%
60%
100%
Sales
Less: Selling expenses
6.7
Cost Accounting
Rs. lakhs
Raw materials (8,00,000 kgs. Rs. 80)
640
150
790
316.00
Cost of Department B
64.00
Selling expenses
16.80
396.80
492.66
95.86
380.00
316.00
Profit
64.00
Further processing of product P and converting into product AR is beneficial to the company
because the profit increaser by Rs. 31.86 lakhs (95.86 64.00).
6.8
EXERCISE
Question 1
Distinguish between job costing and process costing?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 6 i.e. Method of Costing (I) of Study Material
Question 2
(a) What do you understand by Batch Costing? In which industries it is applied?
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 6 i.e. Method of Costing (I) of Study Material
(b) Leo Limited undertakes to supply 1,000 units of a component per month for the months of
January, February and March 1987. Every month a batch order is opened against which
materials and labour cost are booked at actual. Overheads are levied at a rate per labour
hour. The selling price is contracted at Rs. 15/- per unit.
From the following data, present the cost and profit per unit of each batch order and the overall
position of the order for the 3,000 units.
Month
Batch Output
Material
Labour
(Numbers)
Cost
Cost
Rs.
Rs.
January 1987
1,250
6,250
2,500
February 1987
1,500
9,000
3,000
March 1987
1,000
5,000
Labour is paid at the rate of Rs. 2 per hour. The other details are:
2,000
Month
Overheads
January 1987
12,000
4,000
February 1987
9,000
3,000
15,000
5,000
March 1987
Answer Batch (Numbers)
1,250
1,500
1,000
Cost/Unit (Rs.)
10
10
10
Profit/Unit (Rs.)
6.9
CHAPTER 7
CONTRACT COSTING
BASIC CONCEPTS AND FORMULAE
Basic Concepts
1.
2.
3.
Extra work : The extra work amount payable by the contractee should be added to
the contract price. If extra work is substantial, it is better to treat it as a separate
contract. If it is not substantial, expenses incurred should be debited to the contract
account as Cost of Extra work.
4.
5.
Work uncertified : It represents the cost of the work which has been carried out by
the contractor but has not been certified by the contractees architect. It is always
shown at cost price.
6.
Retention money : A contractor does not receive full payment of the work certified
by the surveyor. Contractee retains some amount (say 10% to 20%) to be paid, after
sometime, when it is ensured that there is no fault in the work carried out by contractor.
Work-in-progress: In Contract Accounts, the value of the work-in-progress consists of (i)
the cost of work completed, both certified and uncertified; (ii) the cost of work not yet
completed; and (iii) the amount of profit taken as credit. In the Balance Sheet, the workin-progress is usually shown under two heads, viz., certified and uncertified.
Notional profit : It represents the difference between the value of work certified and cost
of work certified.
7.
8.
Cost Accounting
9.
Estimated profit : It is the excess of the contract price over the estimated total cost
of the contract.
10. Cost plus Contract : Under Cost plus Contract, the contract price is ascertained by
adding a percentage of profit to the total cost of the work. Such type of contracts are
entered into when it is not possible to estimate the Contract Cost with reasonable
accuracy due to unstable condition of material, labour services, etc.
14. Operating Costing: It is a method of ascertaining costs of providing or operating a
service. This method of costing is applied by those undertakings which provide
services rather than production of commodities.
15. Multiple Costing: It refers to the method of costing followed by a business wherein a
large variety of articles are produced, each differing from the other both in regard to
material required and process of manufacture. In such cases, cost of each article is
computed separately by using, generally, two or more methods of costing.
Basic Formulas
1.
2.
When work on contract has not reasonably advanced, no profit is taken into account. In
practice, no profit is calculated when work certified is less than 1/4th but less than of the
contract price.
When work certified is more than 1/4th but less than of the contract price, following formula
is used to determine the figures of profit to be credited to profit and loss account:
1/3 Notional profit
3.
When work certified is more than of the contract price, but it is still not in the final stage,
following formula is used to determine the figure of profit to be credited to profit and loss
account:
2/3 Notional profit
4.
Cash receuved
Work certified
Cash receuved
Work certified
When the contract is almost complete, an estimate total profit is determined by deducting
aggregate of cost to date and estimated additional expenditure from contract price. A portion
of this estimated total profit is credited to profit and loss account. The figure to be credited to
profit and loss account is ascertained by adopting any of the following formulae:
4.1 Estimated total profit
Work certified
Contract price
Cash received
Contract price
7.2
Contract Costing
5.
The practice of cost-plus contracts is adopted in the case of those contracts where the
probable cost of the contracts cannot be ascertained in advance with a reasonable accuracy.
7.3
Cost Accounting
2.
These contracts are preferred when the cost of material and labour is not steady and the
contract completion may take number of years.
3.
The different costs to be included in the execution of the contract are mutually agreed, so that
no dispute may arise in future in this respect. Under such type of contracts, contractee is
allowed to check or scrutinize the concerned books, documents and accounts.
4.
Such a contract offers a fair price to the contractee and also a reasonable profit to the
contractor.
5.
The contract price here is ascertained by adding a fixed and mutually pre-decided component
of profit to the total cost of the work.
Question 2
Write notes on Escalation Clause
Answer
Escalation Clause: This clause is usually provided in the contracts as a safeguard against any
likely changes in the price or utilization of material and labour. If during the period of execution of a
contract, the prices of materials or labour rise beyond a certain limit, the contract price will be
increased by an agreed amount. Inclusion of such a term in a contract deed is known as an
escalation clause
An escalation clause usually relates to change in price of inputs, it may also be extended to
increased consumption or utilization of quantities of materials, labour etc. In such a situation the
contractor has to satisfy the contractee that the increased utilization is not due to his inefficiency.
Question 3
Discuss briefly the principles to be followed while taking credit for profit on incomplete contracts
Answer
Principles to be followed while taking credit for profit on incomplete contracts:
The portion of profit to be credited to, profit and loss account should depend on the stage of
completion of the contract. This stage of completion of the contract should refer to the certified
work only. For this purpose, uncertified work should not be considered as for as possible. For
determining the credit for profit, all the incomplete contracts should be classified into the following
four categories.
(i)
(ii)
Contract Costing
The transfer of profit to the profit and loss account in each of the above cases is done as under:
(i)
Contract less than 25% complete: if the contract has just started or it is less than 25%
complete, no profit should be taken into account.
(ii)
Contract between 25% and 50% complete: In this case one third of the notional profit reduced
in the ratio of cash received to work certified, may be transferred to the profit and loss
account. The amount of profit to be transferred to the profit and loss account may be
determined by using the following formula:
Cash received
1
Notional profit
3
Work certified
(iii) Contract between 50% and 90% complete: In this case, two third of the notional profit,
reduced by the portion of cash received to work certified may be transferred to the profit and
loss account. In this case the formula to be used is as under:
Cash received
2
Notional profit
3
Work certified
(iv) Contract nearing completion: When a contract is nearing completion or 90% or more work
has been done on a contract. The amount of profit to be credited to profit and loss account
may be determined by using any one of the following formula.
(a) Estimated profit
Work certified
Contract price
Work certified
Cash received
Contract price
Work certified
or Estimated profit
(c)
Estimated Profit
Work certified
Contract price
Work certified
Contract price
Question 4
Discuss the process of estimating profit/loss on incomplete contracts
7.5
Cost Accounting
Answer
Process of estimating profit / loss on incomplete contracts
(i)
If completion of contract is less than 25% no profit should be taken to profit and loss
account.
(ii)
If completion of contract is upto 25% or more but less than 50% then
1/3 Notional Profit
Cash received
Work certified
Cash received
Work certified
Estimated Profit
Work certified
Contract price
2.
Estimated Profit
3.
Estimated Profit
4.
Estimated Profit
5.
Notional Profit
Work certified
Contract price
Question 5
Brock Construction Ltd. commenced a contract on November 1,2003. The total contract was for
Rs. 39,37,500. It was decided to estimate the total profit on the contract and to take to the credit of
P/L A/c that proportion of estimated profit on cash basis, which work completed bore to the total
contract. Actual expenditure for the period November 1, 2003 to October 31, 2004 and estimated
expenditure for November 1,2004 to March 31, 2005 are given below:
7.6
Contract Costing
November 1,2003 to
October 31, 2004
(Actuals)
Rs.
November 1,2004 to
March 31 , 2005
(Estimated)
Rs.
12,37,500
6,75,000
Material issued
5,62,500
4,50,000
Labour
Paid
25,000
Prepaid
2,500
Outstanding
3,75,000
Plant purchased
3,50,000
Expenses Paid
2,00,000
25,000
Outstanding
50,000
3,00,000
Plant return to store
75,000
(on March 31, 2005)
(on March 31, 2004)
(Historical cost)
Full
20,00,000
Work certified
Work uncertified
75,000
17,50,000
Cash received
37,500
75,000
Material at site
The plant is subject to annual depreciation @ 33% on written down value method. The contract is
likely to be completed on March 31, 2005.
Required
Prepare the contract A/.c Determine the profit on the contract for the year November, 2003 to
October, 2004 on prudent basis, which has to be credited to P/L A/C
Answer
Brock Construction Ltd. Contract A/c
(November 1, 2003 to Oct. 31, 2004)
Dr.
Dr.
Particulars
To Materials issued
To Labour paid
Prepaid
To Plant Purchased
Amount
(Rs.)
6,75,000
4,50,000
25,000
Amount
(Rs.)
4,25,000
By Plant returned to
store on 31/03/04
at cost
75,000
3,75,000
10,417
7.7
64,583
Cost Accounting
To Expenses paid
To Outstanding
To Notional profit
c/d
2,00,000
50,000
2,50,000
6,89,583
24,14,583
By WIP
Certified
Uncertified
By Plant at site
20,00,000
75,000
20,75,000
1,04,136
31/10/04 at
To P/L A/c
3,00,000
Cost
2,34,305
1,00,000
Less: Dep (1/3)
(17,50,000 /
2,00,000
By Materials at site
20,00,000)
75,000
24,14,583
(20,00,000 /
By Notional Profit
39,37,500)
b/d
5,85,447
6,89,583
To Work-in-progress
(Profit in reserve)
6,89,583
6,89,583
Brock Construction Ltd. Contract A/c (November 1, 2003 to March 31, 2005)
(For computing estimated profit)
Dr.
Particulars
To Material issued
(6,75,000+12,37,500)
To Labour (paid &
outstanding)
(4,25,000+5,87,500+2,500)
To Plant purchased
To Expenses
(2,50,000 + 3,25,000)
To Estimated profit
Cr.
Amount
(Rs.)
Amount
(Rs.)
19,12,500
By Material at site
37,500
10,15,000
By Plant returned to
stores on 31/3/04
By Plant returned to
stores on 31/3/05
Cost
Less: Dep.
Less: 5 month Dep.
By Contractee A/c
64,583
3,75,000
5,75,000
2,34,305
42,11,805
1,72,222
3,00,000
1,00,000
27,778
39,37,500
______
42,11,805
Question 6
A lorry starts with a load of 20 tonnes of goods from station A. It unloads 8 tonnes at station B and
rest of goods at station C. It reaches back directly to station A after getting reloaded with 16 tonnes
7.8
Contract Costing
of goods at station C. The distance between A to B, B to C and then from C to A are 80 kms. 120,
and 160 kms respectively. Compute Absolute tones kms and Commercial tones kms.
Answer
Absolute tones kms: It is the sum total of tones kms. arrived at by multiplying various
distances by respective load quantities carried. Mathematically it is:
= 20 tonnes 80 kms + 12 tonnes 120 kms + 16 tonnes 160 kms.
= 5,600 tonnes kms.
Commercial tones kms
Rs. In Lakhs
280
100
60
440
Erection costs to date
110
550
The contract price is Rs. 11 crores and the cash received on account till 31.03.2001 was Rs.6
crores.
The technical estimate of the contract indicates the following degree of completion of work.
Fabrication Direct Material 70%, Director Labour and Overheads 60% Erection 40%.
You are required to estimate the profit that could be taken to Profit and Loss Account against this
partly completed contract as at 31.03.2001.
Answer
Estimation of Profit to be taken to Profit and Loss Account against partly completed
contract as at 31.03.2001.
Profit to be taken to P/L Account =
Cash received
2
Notional profit
3
Work certified
Cost Accounting
Rs.600 lakhs
2
Rs. 92.48 lakhs
3
Rs.642.48 lakhs
= Rs.57.576 lakhs
Working Notes
1.
Particulars
Cost to date
%
Completion
to date
Fabrication costs:
Direct material
Direct labour
Overheads
Total Fabrication cost (A)
Erection cost: (B)
Total estimated costs: (A+B)
Profit
(Refer to working note 2)
2.
Amount
Rs.
(a)
Further Costs
% completion to be
done
120.00
66.67
40.00
226.67
165.00
391.67
65.85
______
400.00
166.67
100.00
666.67
275.00
491.67
158.33
______
642.48
457.52
Profit to date (Notional Profit) and future profit are calculated as below:
1,100.00
70
60
60
280.00
100.00
60.00
440.00
110.00
550.00
92.48
______
40
Rs.158.33 Rs.550
Rs.941.67
3.
60
30
40
40
Amount
Rs.
(b)
Total Cost
Rs.
(a) + (b)
Work certified:
=
Contract Costing
4.
Rs .642.48 lakhs
100
Rs .1,100 lakhs
58.40%
Question 8
A contractor commenced a building contract on October 1, 1997. The contract price is Rs.
4,40,000. The following data pertaining to the contract for the year 1998-99 has been compiled
from his books and is as under:
Rs.
April 1998
199899
55,000
2,000
Expenses incurred:
Materials issued
1,12,000
Wages paid
1,08,000
Hire of plant
20,000
Other expenses
34,000
Materials at site
4,000
8,000
Work-in-progress: Certified
4,05,000
The cash received represents 80% of work certified. It has been estimated that further costs to
complete the contract will be Rs.23,000 including the materials at site as on March 31, 1999.
Required
Determine the profit on the contract for the year 1998-99 on prudent basis, which has to be
credited to P/L A/c.
7.11
Cost Accounting
Answers
Contract Account
For the year 1998-99
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
Rs.
01.04.98
To Work in-progress
(not certified)
55,000
To Materials at site
2,000
1998-99
To Materials issued
To Wages paid
To Hire of plant
To Other expenses
1,12,000
1,08,000
20,000
24,000
Particulars
Rs.
By Materials at site
4,000
By Cost of contract
c/d (to date)
3,27,000
_______
3,31,000
3,31,000
31.03.99
To Cost of contract b/d
(to date)
3,27,000
66,273
To Profit in reserve
19,727
By Work-certified
By Work-not certified
4,13,000
8,000
4,13,000
4,05,000
3,27,000
23,000
the contract
Total cost : (A)
3,50,000
4,40,000
7.12
Contract Costing
Estimated profit on the
Completion of contract: [(A)(B))
Work certified
Since
Contract price
100
90,000
=
Rs.4,05,000
100 = 92.05%
Rs.4,40,000
This implies that contract is nearing completing. Hence the profit to be taken to Profit and
Loss Account on prudent basis will be given by the formula:
=
Estimated profit
Rs. 90,000
Rs. 66,273
Rs.4,05,000 Rs.3,24,000
Rs.4,40,000 Rs.4,05,000
Question 9
A construction company undertook a contract at an estimated price of Rs.108 lacs, which includes
a budgeted profit of Rs. 18 lacs. The relevant data for the year ended 31.03.2002 are as under:
(Rs. 000)
Materials issued to site
5,000
3,800
Plant hired
700
270
100
Direct expenses
500
Work certified
10,000
7,200
A special plant was purchased specifically for this contract at Rs. 8,00,000 and after use on this
contract till the end of 31.02.2002, it was valued at Rs.5,00,000. This cost of materials at site at the
end of the year was estimated at Rs. 18,00,000. Direct wages accrued as on 31.03.2002 was Rs.
1,10,000.
Required
Prepare the Contract Account for the year ended 31st March, 2002 and compute the profit to be
taken to the Profit and Loss account.
7.13
Cost Accounting
Answer
Contract Account for the year ended 31st March, 2002
Dr.
Cr.
Rs. 000
Rs. 000
By Materials at site
By Materials returned
By Cost of contract
5,000
3,800
110
700
270
500
300
_____
10,680
10,680
To Cost of contract
8,780
1,200
1.
2.
By Work certified
10,000
20
_____
10,000
10,000
To Work-in-progress c/d
(Profit in reserve)
Working notes
1,800
100
8,780
100 lacs
100 = 92.59%
108 lacs
Since the percentage of Contract completion is more than 90% therefore the profit to
be taken to Profit and Loss Account can be computed by using the following formula.
Profit to be taken to P & L A/c = Budged/Estimated Profit
= 1,800
7,200 10,000
10,000 10,800
= 1,800
7,200
10,800
= Rs. 1,200
7.14
Contract Costing
Question 10
MNP Construction Ltd. commenced a contract on April 1,1999. The total contract was for Rs.
17,50,000. It was decided to estimate the total profit and to take to the credit of P/L A/c the
proportion of estimated profit on cash basis, which work completed bore to the total contract.
Actual expenditure in 1999-2000 and estimated expenditure in 2000-2001 are given below:
1999-2000
2000-2001
(Actuals)
(Estimated)
Rs.
Rs.
Materials issued
3,00,000
5,50,000
Labour
2,00,000
2,50,000
20,000
30,000
1,50,000
: Paid
75,000
1,50,000
: Prepaid at end
15,000
50,000
1,00,000
: Paid
: Outstanding at end
Plant purchased
Expenses
50,000
Work certified
Work uncertified
Cash received
8,00,000
Full
25,000
6,00,000
Full
The plant is subject to annual depreciation @ 25% of WDV Cost. The contract is likely to be
completed on Dec. 31, 2000. Prepare the Contract A/c Determine the profit on the contract for the
year 1999-2000 on prudent basis, which has to be credited to P/L A/c.
7.15
Cost Accounting
Answer
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
(Rs.)
To Materials issued
To Labour : Paid
Outstanding
To Plant purchased
(Refer to working note 4)
To Expenses
To Notional profit c/d
2,00,000
20,000
Amount Particulars
(Rs.)
3,00,000 By Plant returned to store
(Refer to working note 1)
2,20,000 By Materials at site
1,50,000 By Work certified
By Work uncertified
60,000 By Plant at site
2,27,500 (Refer to working note 2)
9,57,500
66,321.43 By Notional profit b/d
1,61,178.57
_________
2,27,500.00
MNP Construction Ltd.
Contract Account (1st April, 1999 to 31st December, 2000)
(For computing estimated profit)
Amount
(Rs.)
37,500
20,000
8,00,000
25,000
75,000
_______
9,57,500
2,27,500
_________
2,27,500.00
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
To Material issued
(Rs. 3,00,000 + Rs. 5,50,000)
To Labour (Paid and outstanding)
(Rs.2,20,000 + Rs. 2,30,000 +
Rs. 30,000)
To Plant purchased
To Expenses
(Rs. 60,000 + Rs. 1,65,000)
To Estimated profit
Amount
Rs.
Particulars
Amount
Rs.
50,000
37,500
60,937.50
17,50,000
18,98,437.50
Contract Costing
Working notes:
1.
2.
Rs.
50,000
12,500
37,500
Rs.
3.
1,00,000
25,000
75,000
Rs.
4.
5.
75,000
14,062.50
60,937.50
Expenses paid
Total expenses paid
75,000
15,000
60,000
Profit to be credited to P/L A/c on 31st March, 2000 for the contract likely to be completed on
31st December 2000
Estimated profit
Cash received
Work certified
Work certified Total contract price
Rs. 1,93,437.50
Rs. 66,321.43
Rs.6,00,000
Rs.8,00,000
Rs.8,00,000 Rs.17,50,000
Answer
Working Notes
1.
Rs.
Contract price
Rs.
3,06,000
1,70,000
7.17
Cost Accounting
Less: Estimated further expenditure to complete the contract
(including contingencies)
Estimated profit
2.
34,000
2,04,000
1,02,000
2,00,000
1,53,000
47,000
Four methods of computing the conservative estimates of profits (when 89% of the contract
is complete)
(i)
Estimated profit
=
(ii)
Rs. 1,02,000
Estimated profit
Rs. 1,02,000
Rs. 54,400
Rs. 47,000
Rs.2,00,000
= Rs. 66,666.66
Rs.3,06,000
(iv)
Work Certified
(Refer to working note 1)
Contract price
Rs.2,00,000 Rs.1,63,2000
Rs.3,06,000 Rs.2,00,000
Work certified
(Refer to working note 2)
Contract price
Rs.2,00,000
= Rs. 30,718.95
Rs.3,06,000
Cash received
2
Notional Profit
3
Work certified
Rs.1,63,200
2
Rs. 47,000
Rs.2,00,000
3
Rs. 25.568
7.18
Contract Costing
Question 11
RST Construction Limited commenced a contract on April 1, 2005. The total contract was for Rs.
49,21,875. It was decided to estimate the total Profit on the contract and to take to the Credit of
Profit and Loss Account that proportion of estimated profit on cash basis, which work completed
bore to total Contract. Actual expenditure for the period April 1, 2005 to March 31, 2006 and
estimated expenditure for April 1, 2006 to September 30, 2006 are given below:
April 1, 2005 to
March 31, 2006
April 1, 2006 to
September 30, 2006
(Actuals)
(Estimated)
Rs.
Rs.
Materials Issued
7,76,250
12,99,375
Labour: Paid
5,17,500
6,18,750
: Prepaid
37,500
: Outstanding
12,500
5,750
Plant Purchased
4,00,000
Expenses: Paid
2,25,000
3,75,000
: Outstanding
25,000
10,000
: Prepaid
15,000
1,00,000
3,00,000
22,50,000
Full
Work certified
Work uncertified
Cash received
Materials at site
25,000
18,75,000
82,500
42,500
The plant is subject to annual depreciation @ 25% on written down value method. The contract is
likely to be completed on September 30, 2006.
Required:
Prepare the contract A/c. Determine the profit on the contract for the year 2005-06 on prudent
basis, which has to be credited to Profit and Loss Account..
7.19
Cost Accounting
Answer
(a) Contract Account for the year ending March 31, 2006
Rs.
To
Materials issued
To
Labour
7,76,250
12,500
Less: Prepaid
37,500
Plant
To
Expenses
By
5,17,500
Add: Outstanding
To
Rs.
Certified
4,92,500
By
4,00,000
25,000
Less: Prepaid
15,000
25,000
By
2,35,000
87,500
Plant at site
(3,00,000 25%)
2,25,000
Materials at site
82,500
7,66,250
26,70,000
To
10,21,125
To
22,50,000 18,75,000
49,21,875 22,50,000
WIP (Reserve)
22,75,000
(1,00,000 25% )
By
To
22,50,000
Uncertified
2,25,000
Add: Outstanding
Work-in-progress
26,70,000
By
7,66,250
3,89,000
3,77,250
7,66,250
7,66,250
Contract Account (for entire life period April 1, 2005 to September 30, 2006)
Rs.
To
Materials issued
(7,76,250 + 12,99,375)
To
20,75,625
By
Contractee A/c
By
Materials at site
By
Rs.
Plant
4,00,000
To
Expenses
6,10,000
By
returned
42,500
on
11,42,000
To
Plant
49,21,875
Plant
returned
September 30, 2006
on
3,00,000
10,21,125
Depreciation
2007(1/2)
52,48,750
87,500
75,000
2,25,000
200628,125
1,96,875
52,48,750
7.20
Contract Costing
Question 12
Explain the following:
(i)
(ii)
Answer
(i)
31.3.2008
Rs.
Rs.
9,40,000
30,00,000
Work-in-progress:
Work certified
Work uncertified
11,200
32,000
Materials at site
8,000
20,000
Accrued wages
5,000
3,000
4,00,000
1,50,000
Wages paid
6,00,000
7.21
Cost Accounting
Architects fees
51,000
50,000
Indirect expenses
10,000
18,000
25,000
15,000
12,000
The contractee pays 80% of work certified in cash. You are required to prepare:
(i)
Contract Account showing clearly the amount of profits transferred to Profit and Loss
Account.
(ii)
Contractees Account.
(iii)
Balance Sheet
Answer
(a)
WIP b/d
(9,40,000 + 11,200)
To
To
Materials issued
To
Rs.
By
5,000
9,51,200
8,000 By
25,000
4,00,000 By
Materials
suppliers
15,000
Materials purchased
1,50,000 By
WIP c/d -
To
Wages paid
6,00,000
Work Certified
To
3,000
returned
30,00,000
Uncertified
work
To
Architects fees
51,000 By
To
50,000
To
Indirect expenses
10,000
7.22
to
32,000
30,32,000
20,000
Contract Costing
To
General overheads
To
To
To
18,000
8,55,800
________
30,97,000
30,97,000
By
8,55,800
80
2
8,55,800
100
3
4,56,427
3,99,373
_______
8,55,800
8,55,800
Note:
Fines and penalties are not shown in contract accounts.
Contractees Account
Rs.
To
Balance c/d
Rs.
24,00,000 By
________ By
Bank
7,52,000
16,48,000
24,00,000
24,00,000
4,56,427
12,000
Rs.
Materials stock at site
20,000
25,000
3,000 WIP:
Work Certified
30,00,000
Work Uncertified
32,000
30,32,000
Less: Advance
24,00,000
6,32,000
Less:
Reserve
7.23
WIP
3,99,373
2,32,627
Cost Accounting
Question 14
Compute a conservative estimate of profit on contract (which has been 90% complete) from the
following particulars:
Rs.
Total expenditure to date
22,50,000
2,50,000
Contract Price
32,50,000
Work certified
27,50,000
Work uncertified
1,75,000
Cash received
21,25,000
Answer
The contract is 90% complete, the method used for transfer of profit to Profit and Loss Account for
the current year will be on the basis of estimated profit on completed contract basis.
Credit to Proift and Loss Account Estimated profit on completed contract
Estimated profit on completed contract basis = Contract Price (Total expenditure to date +
27,50,000 21,25,000
Rs. 4,90,385
32,50,000 27,50,000
Question 15
What is cost plus contract? State its advantages.
Answer
Cost plus contract: Under cost plus contract, the contract price is ascertained by adding a
percentage of profit to the total cost of the work. Such types of contracts are entered into when it is
not possible to estimate the contract cost with reasonable accuracy due to unstable condition of
material, labour services etc.
7.24
Contract Costing
Following are the advantages of cost plus contract:
(i)
The contractor is assured of a fixed percentage of profit. There is no risk of incurring any loss
on the contract.
(ii)
It is useful specially when the work to be done is not definitely fixed at the time of making the
estimate.
(iii) Contractee can ensure himself about the cost of contract as he is empowered to examine
the books and documents of the contractor to ascertain the veracity of the cost of contract.
Question 16
AKP Builders Ltd. Commenced a contract on April 1, 2005. The total contract was for Rs. 5,00,000.
Actual expenditure for the period April 1, 2005 to March 31, 2006 and estimated expenditure for
April 1, 2006 to December 31, 2006 are given below:
2005-06
(Actuals)
Rs.
2006-07 (9 months)
(Estimated)
Rs.
Material Issued
90,000
85,750
Labour : Paid
75,000
87,325
6,250
8,300
Plant
25,000
7,250
6,875
625
Establishment charges
14,625
A part of the material was unsuitable and was sold for Rs. 18,125 (Cost being Rs. 15,000) and a
part of plant was scrapped and disposed of for Rs. 2,875. The value of plant at site on 31 March,
2006 was Rs. 7,750 and the value of material at site was Rs. 4,250. Cash received on account to
date was Rs. 1,75,000, representing 80% of the work certified. The cost of work uncertified was
valued at Rs. 27,375.
The contractor estimated further expenditure that would be incurred in completion of the contract:
A further sum of Rs. 31,250 would have to be spent on the plant and the residual value of
the pant on the completion of the contract would be Rs. 3,750.
Establishment charges would cost the same amount per month as in the previous year.
Cost Accounting
Required:
Prepare Contract account and calculate estimated total profit on this contract. Profit transferrable
to Profit and Loss account is to be calculated by reducing estimated Profit in proportion of work
certified and contract price.
Answer
(a)
To
Material issued
To
Labour
Rs.
90,000 By
Add: Outstanding
To
Plant
To
Sundry Expenditure
Establishment charges
To
To
Balance b/d
To
Balance c/d
sale
18,125
75,000
By
Plant (sold)
2,875
6,250
81,250 By
Plant at site
7,750
25,000 By
Material at site
4,250
625
To
Material (sold)
Rs.
7,250
Less: Pre-paid
(Profit on
material)
Particulars
6,625
14,625 By
of
Balance c/d
1,87,625
3,125
_______
2,20,625
2,20,625
1,87,625 By
58,500
_______
Work in progress
Certified
Uncertified
2,46,125
2,18,750
27,375
2,46,125
To
29,960.55 By
To
Work in progress
28,539.45
_______
58,500
58,500
7.26
Balance
58,500
Contract Costing
Work certified
Contract price
68,481.25
2,18,750
Rs. 29,960.55
5,00,000
To
To
Particulars
By
3,125
85,750
22,125
Add: New
(+) 31,250
Less: Closing
( ) 3,750
Establishment charges
10,968.75
(+) 6,875
Previous prepaid
(+) 625
Labour
(+) 81,075
Outstanding
(+) 8,300
Estimated Profit
49,625
25,593.75
14,125.00
81,250
To
1,60,750
6,625
Add: New
Reserve
contingencies
5,00,000
14,625
Sundry Expenditure
To
Contractees A/c
Rs.
75,000
Rs.
Material
(90,000
18,125)
To
Rs.
for
1,70,625
10,800
68,481.25
_______
5,00,000
5,00,000
Question 17
Explain the importance of an Escalation Clause in contract cost.
7.27
Cost Accounting
Answer
During the execution of a contract, the prices of materials, or labour etc., may rise beyond a certain
limit. In such a case the contract price will be increased by an agreed amount. Inclusion of such a
clause in a contract deed is called an Escalation Clause.
Question 18
What are the main advantages of cost plus contract?
Answer
Costs plus contracts have the following advantages:
1.
The contractor is assured of a fixed percentage of profit. There is no risk of incurring any loss
on the contract.
2.
It is useful especially when the work to be done is not definitely fixed at the time of making the
estimate.
3.
Contractee can ensure himself about the cost of the contract, as he is empowered to
examine the books and document of the contractor to ascertain the veracity of the cost of the
contract.
Question 19
State the method of costing that would be most suitable for
(a) Oil refinery
(b) Bicycle manufacturing
(c)
Interior decoration
7.28
Contract Costing
Question 20
A contract expected to be completed in year 4, exhibits the following information:
End of Year
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
1.
50,000
50,000
2.
3,00,000
2,30,000
10,000
2,75,000
3.
8,00,000
6,60,000
20,000
7,50,000
The contract price is Rs. 10,00,000 and the estimated profit is 20%.
You are required to calculate, how much profit should have been credited to the Profit and Loss A/c
by the end of years 1, 2 and 3.
Answer
End of Value of work Cost of work Notional
profit**
certified*
year
certified
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
3,00,000
2,20,000
80,000
2,75,000
1
80,000
24,444
3
3,00,000
8,00,000
6,40,000
1,60,000
7,50,000
2
1,60,000
1,00,000
3
8,00,000
7.29
Cost Accounting
Workings:
End of Completion of Contract
year
year 1
No profit credited
Year 2
Year 3
Cumulative profit
Cumulative profit
1
3
2
3
notional profit
notional profit
Cash received
Value of work certified
Cash received
Value of work certified
* Cost of work certified = Cost of work to date Cost of work not yet certified
** Notional profit
= Value of work certified (Cost of work to date Cost of work not yet certify
7.30
Contract Costing
EXERCISE
Question 1
(i)
Discuss the implications of cost-plus contracts from the view points of:
(a) the manufacturer
(b) the customer.
(ii)
Rs. 4,90,000
Vehicles at cost
Rs. 2,00,000
V.24
V.25
7.00
5.60
16.00
6.40
7.70
12.00
Wages
2.40
2.00
1.20
Materials
1.00
1.10
0.44
1.44
1.46
0.58
4.84
4.56
2.22
7.31
Cost Accounting
Value certified by architects
7.20
4.20
2.40
5.00
3.20
2.00
Depreciation of Plant and Equipment and Vehicle should be charged at 20% to the three contracts
in proportion to work certified.
You are required to prepare statements to show contractwise and total:
(i)
Profit/loss to be taken to the P&L A/c for the year ended 31st March 1983;
(ii)
Answer (i)
V.20
V.24
1.40
V.25
Total
0.06
0.46
1.56
0.38
0.40
2.34
Question 5
Deluxe Limited undertook a contract for Rs.5,00,000 on 1st July, 1986. On 30th June, 1987 when
the accounts were closed, the following details about the contract were gathered:
Rs.
Materials Purchased
1,00,000
Wages Paid
45,000
General Expenses
10,000
Plant Purchased
50,000
25,000
5,000
Work Certified
2,00,000
Cash Received
1,50,000
Work Uncertified
15,000
Depreciation of Plant
5,000
Contract Costing
It was found that since the date of signing the agreement the prices of materials and wage rates
increased by 25%. The value of the work certified does not take into account the effect of the
above clause.
Prepare the contract account. Workings should form part of the answer.
Answer Profit to be transferred Rs. 20,000
Question 6
Rex Limited commenced a contract on 01.07.1988. The total contract price was Rs. 5,00,000 but
Rex Limited accepted the same for Rs. 4,50,000. It was decided to estimate the total profit and to
take to the credit of profit and loss account that proportion of estimated profit on cash basis which
the work completed bore to the total contract. Actual Expenditure till 31.12.1988 and estimated
expenditure in 1989 are given below:
Expenses
Materials
Labour
Plant Purchased (original cost)
Misc. Expenses
Plant Returned to Stores on 31.12.88 at
original cost
Actuals
Till 31.12.88
Rs.
Estimate
For 1989
Rs.
75,000
55,000
40,000
20,000
10,000
1,30,000
60,000
35,500
35,500
As on 30.09.89
Materials at Site
5,000
Work Certified
2,00,000
Work Uncertified
7,500
Cash Received
1,80,000
The Plant is subject to annual depreciation @ 20% of original cost. The contract is
completed on 30.09.1989.
Nil
Full
Nil
Full
likely to be
You are required to prepare the contract account for the year ended 31.12.88. Workings should be
clearly given.
It is the policy of the company to charge depreciation on time basis.
Answer Profit to be transferred to P/L A/c Rs. 26,400
Profit in reserve Rs. 32,100
Plant returned to stores Rs. 27,750
7.33
Cost Accounting
Question 7
A contractor, who prepares his account on 31st December each year, commenced a contract on 1st
April 1990. The costing records concerning the said contract reveal the following information on
31st December, 1990;
Rs.
Materials charged to site
2,58,100
Labour engaged
5,60,500
Foremens salary
79,300
Plants costing Rs. 2,60,000 had been on site for 146 days. Their working life is estimated at 7 years
and their final scrap value at Rs. 15,000. A supervisor, who is paid Rs. 4,000 p.m. has devoted
approximately three-fourths of his time to this contract. The administrative and other expenses
amount to Rs. 1,40,000. Materials in hand at site on 31st December, 1990 cost Rs. 25,400. Some of
the material costing Rs. 4,500 was found unsuitable and was sold for Rs. 4,000 and a part of the
plant costing Rs. 5,500 (on 31.12.90) unsuited to the contract was sold at a profit of Rs. 1,000.
The contract price was Rs. 22,00,000 but it was accepted by the contractor for Rs. 20,00,000. On
31st December, 1990, two thirds of the contract was completed. Architects certificate had been
issued covering 50% of the contract price and Rs. 7,50,000 had so far been paid on account.
Prepare contract account and state how much profit or loss should be included in the financial
accounts to 31st December, 1990. Workings should be clearly given. Depreciation is charged on
time basis.
Also prepare the Contractees account and show how these accounts should appear in the Balance
Sheet as on 31st December, 1990.
Answer Notional Profit Rs. 2,13,250
Profit & Loss A/c Rs. 1,06,625
Profit Reserve Rs. 1,06,625
Question 8
One of the building contracts currently engaged in by a construction company commenced 15
months ago and remain unfinished . The following information relating to the work on the contract
has been prepared for the year just ended:
Rs.000
Contract Price
2,500
2,200
40
Contract Costing
Costs incurred:
Opening balances:
Case of work completed
300
10
610
Wages
580
Hire of plant
110
Other expenses
90
Closing balance
Materials on site (physical stock)
20
As soon as materials are delivered to the site, they are charged to the contract account. A record is
also kept of materials as they are actually used on the contract. Periodically a stock check is
maintained and any discrepancy between book stock and physical stock is transferred to a general
contract material discrepancy account. This is absorbed back to each contract, currently at the rate
of 0.5 of materials booked. The stock check at the year end revealed a stock shortage of Rs.
5,000.
In addition to the direct charges listed above, general overheads are charged to contract at 5% of
the value of work certified. General overheads of Rs. 15,000 had been absorbed into the cost of
work completed at the beginning of the year.
It has been estimated that further costs to complete the contract will be Rs. 2,20,000. this estimate
includes the cost of materials on site at the end of the year finished and also a provision for
rectification.
Required:
(a) Explain briefly the distinguishing features of contract costing.
(b) Determine the profitability of the above contract and recommend how much profit to nearest
Rs.000) should be taken for the year just ended. (Provide a detailed schedule of costs)
(c) State how your recommendation in (b) would be affected if the contract price Rs. 40,00,000
(rather than rs. 25,00,000) and if no estimate has been made of costs to completion. (If
required, suitable assumption should be made by the candidate).
Answer (a) Refer to Chapter No. 6 Method of Costing
7.35
Cost Accounting
(b)Estimated Profit Rs. 5,07,000
Profit to be taken to Costing P/L A/c Rs. 4,51,034
(c) Notional Profit Rs. 4,67,000
Question 9
A construction company under-taking a number of contracts, furnished the following data relating to
its uncompleted contracts as on 31st March, 1996.
(Rs. In Lacs)
Contract Numbers
723
726
729
731
28.80
10.08
23.20
14.40
Total Contract Price
21.60
12.60
20.50
11.52
Estimated Costs on completion of Contract
Expenses for the year ended 31.03.96
0.80
1.98
Direct Materials
1.80
5.22
2.16
3.90
Direct wages
4.32
2.32
1.05
2.62
Overheads (Excluding Depreciation)
2.60
1.06
1.50
3.00
2.75
Plant issued at Cost
3.50
5.00
0.75
0.05
0.08
0.20
Materials at Site on 31.03.96
0.45
Determine the profit/loss in respect of each contract for the year ended 31st March, 1996.
(ii)
State the profit/loss to be carried to Profit & Loss A/c for the year ended 31st March, 1996
Answer (i)
723
5.20
2.60
726
4.28
1.80
729
(1.27)
-
731
(0.06)
-
Contract Costing
Question 10
A company undertook a contract for construction of a large building complex. The construction
work commenced on 1st April 1993 and the following data are available for the year ended 31 st
March 1994.
Rs. 000
Contract Price
35,000
Work certified
20,000
15,000
7,500
1,000
4,000
250
1,750
500
678
375
902
149
The contractors own a plant which originally cost Rs.20 lacs has been continuously in use in this
contract throughout the year. The residual value of the plant after 5 years of life is expected to be
Rs. 5 lacs. Straight line method of depreciation is in use.
As on 31st March, 1994 the direct wages due and payable amounted to Rs. 2,70,000 and the
materials at site were estimated at Rs. 2,00,000.
Required:
(i)
Prepare the contract account for the year ended 31st March, 1994.
(ii)
Show the calculation of profit to be taken to the profit and loss account of the year.
7.37
Cost Accounting
Question 11
Compute a conservative estimate of profit on a contract (which has been 80% complete) from the
following particulars. Illustrate four methods of computing the profit:
Rs.
Total expenditure to date
1,70,000
34,000
Contract Price
3,06,000
Work Certified
2,00,000
17,000
Cash Received
1,63,200
7.38
CHAPTER 8
OPERATING COSTING
BASIC CONCEPTS AND FORMULAE
Basic Concepts
1.
2.
Cost units:
Transport service
Supply service
Hospital
Patient per day, room per day or per bed, per operation etc.
Canteen
Cinema
Per ticket.
Composite units i.e. tonnes kms., quintal kms. etc. may be computed in two ways.
3..
Basic Formulas
1.
2.
Question 1
Mr. X owns a bus which runs according to the following schedule:
(i)
Cost Accounting
Number of days run each month: 8
Seating capacity occupied 90%
(ii)
Rs. 6,00,000
Road tax
Lubricant oil
Permit fee
@ 20% p.a.
50 persons.
Passenger tax is 20% of the total takings. Calculate the bus fare to be charged from each
passenger to earn a profit of 30% on total takings. The fares are to be indicated per passenger for
the journeys:
(i)
Delhi to Chandigarh
(ii)
Delhi to Agra
8.2
Operating Costing
Answer
Working Notes
(1) Total running Kms per month:
Delhi to Chandigarh
Delhi to Agra
Delhi to Jaipur
Km. per
trip
Trips per
day
Days per
month
Km. per
month
150
120
270
2
2
2
8
10
6
2,400
2,400
3,240
8,040
Capacity
utilized
% Seats
Km.per
trip
Passenger
Kms. per
month
800
90
720
150
1,08,000
1,000
85
850
120
1,02,000
600
100
600
270
1,62,000
Total
3,72,000
Rs.
Rs.
2,800
2,200
200
20
1
)
100 12
10,000
400
125
1,000
Permit Fee
315
8.3
_____
Cost Accounting
17,040
Variable Costs
Diesel (
8,040 Kms.
Rs. 6)
4 Kms.
12,060
8,040 Kms.
Rs.10 )
100 Kms.
804
29,904
29,904
______
Total takings
59,808
11,961.60
17,942.60
Rs.59,808
0.1607741 passenger Km.
Rs. 3,72,000
Fare to be charged
Delhi to Chandigarh, per passenger
Question 2
A Mineral is transported from two mines A and B and unloaded at plots in a Railway Station.
Mine A is at a distance of 10 kms, and B is at a distance of 15 kms. from railhead plots. A fleet of
lorries of 5 tonne carrying capacity is used for the transport of mineral from the mines. Records
reveal that the lorries average a speed of 30 kms. per hour, when running and regularly take 10
minutes to unload at the railhead. At mine A loading time averages 30 minutes per load while at
mine B loading time averages 20 minutes per load.
Drivers wages, depreciation, insurance and taxes are found to cost Rs. 9 per hour operated. Fuel,
oil, tyres, repairs and maintenance cost Rs. 1.20 per km.
Draw up a statement, showing the cost per tonne-kilometer of carrying mineral from each mine.
8.4
Operating Costing
Answer
Statement showing the cost per tonne-kilometer of
carrying mineral from each mine
Mine A
Rs.
Mine B
Rs.
B:
12
13.50
24
B:
___
36.00
36
49.50
0.72
0.66
(Rs.49.50/75 tonnes
kms)
Working notes
Mine A
1.
40 minutes
60 minutes
60 min utes
20 kms. 30 kms
60 min utes
30 kms. 30 kms
Unloading time
10 minutes
10 minutes
Loading time
30 minutes
20 minutes
Mine B
80 minutes or
90 minutes or
1 hour 20 minutes
1 hour 30 minutes
50
(5 tonnes 10 kms)
8.5
75
(5 tonnes 15 kms.)
Cost Accounting
Question 3
EPS is a Public School having 25 buses each plying in different directions for the transport of its
school students. In view of large number of students availing of the bus service, the buses work
two shifts daily both in the morning and in the afternoon. The buses are garaged in the school. The
workload of the students has been so arranged that in the morning, the first trip picks up senior
students and the second trip plying an hour later picks up junior students. Similarly, in the
afternoon, the first trip takes the junior students and an hour later the second trip takes the senior
students home.
The distance travelled by each bus, one way is 16 kms. The school works 24 days in a month and
remains closed for vacation in May and June. The bus fee, however, is payable by the students for
all the 12 months in a year.
The details of expenses for the year 2003-2004 are as under:
Drivers salary payable for all the 12 in month.
Cleaners salary payable for all the 12 months
Insurance Premium
16 years
Scrap value
Rs. 1,50,000
Diesel Cost
Each bus gives an average of 10 kms per litre of diesel. The seating capacity of each bus is 60
students. The seating capacity is fully occupied during the whole year.
The school follows differential bus fees based on distance traveled as under:
Students picked up and
dropped within the range of
distance from the school
4 kms
8 kms
16 kms
Bus fee
Percentage of students
availing this facility
25% of Full
50% of Full
Full
15%
30%
55%
8.6
Operating Costing
Ignore interest. Since the bus fees has to be based on average cost, you are required to
(i)
Prepare a statement showing the expenses of operating a single bus and the fleet of 25
buses for a year.
(ii)
Work out average cost per student per month in respect of:
(a) Students coming from a distance of upto 4 kms from the school.
(b) Students coming from a distance of upto 8 kms from the school; and
(c)
Answer
(a) (i)
Per bus
per annum
(Rs.)
Fleet of 25 buses
per annum
(Rs.)
56,832
14,20,800
16,400
4,10,000
Drivers salary
60,000
15,00,000
Cleaners salary
7,200
1,80,000
2,300
57,500
Insurance
15,600
3,90,000
Depreciation
93,750
23,43,750
1,78,850
44,71,250
2,52,082
63,02,050
(iii) Average cost per student per month in respect of students coming from a distance of:
a)
Rs. 59.34
8.7
Cost Accounting
b)
Rs. 118.68
c)
Rs. 237.36
Working notes:
1.
32 kms
128 kms
3,072 kms
30,720 kms
3,072 litres
Rs. 56,832
120 students
18 students
72 students
264 students
354 students
8.8
Operating Costing
Question 4
A transport company has a fleet of three trucks of 10 tonnes capacity each plying in different
directions for transport of customers goods. The trucks run loaded with goods and return empty.
The distance travelled, number of trips made and the load carried per day by each truck are as
under:
Truck No.
One way
Distance Km
1
2
3
The analysis of maintenance cost
under
No. of trips
per day
Load carried
per trip / day
tonnes
16
4
6
40
2
9
30
3
8
and the total distance travelled during the last two years is as
Year
Total distance
travelled
Maintenance Cost
Rs.
1,60,200
1,56,700
46,050
45,175
The following are the details of expenses for the year under review:
Diesel
Drivers salary
Insurance
General Overhead
(ii)
(iii) Determine the freight rate per tonne km. to yield a profit of 10% on freight
8.9
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
3,36,960
33,696
39,696
72,000
15,000
Insurance 5,000
Depreciation
87,000
11,084
6,00,436
Rs.6,00,436
Rs.4.4548
1,34,784 Kms
(iii) Freight rate per tonne km (to yield a profit of 10% on freight)
Cost per tonne km.
8.10
Operating Costing
Rs.6,00,436
Rs.1.143
5,25,312 kms
Rs. 1.27
Rs.1.143
10
9
Working notes:
1.
Total kilometre travelled and tonnes kilometre (load carried) by three trucks in one year
Truck
number
One way
distance in
kms
No. of trips
Total distance
covered in km
per day
1
16
4
128
2
40
2
160
3
30
3
180
468
Total
Total kilometre travelled by three trucks in one year
Load carried
per trip / day
in tonnes
Total effective
tonnes km
6
9
8
384
720
720
1824
1,34,784
Rs.46,050 Rs.45,175
1,60,200 kms 1,56,700 kms
Rs. 0.25
Rs. 6,000
Question 5
In order to develop tourism, ABCL airline has been given permit to operate three flights in a week
between X and Y cities (both side). The airline operates a single aircraft of 160 seats capacity.
8.11
Cost Accounting
The normal occupancy is estimated at 60% through out the year of 52 weeks. The one-way fare is
Rs. 7,200. The cost of operation of flights are:
Fuel cost (variable)
Commission
Fixed cost:
Aircraft lease
Landing Charges
Required:
(i)
(ii)
The airline expects that its occupancy will increase to 108 passengers per flight if the fare is
reduced to Rs. 6,720. Advise whether this proposal should be implemented or not.
Answer
No. of passengers 16060/100 = 96
(i)
Rs
Rs.
6,91,200
Variable costs:
Fuel
96,000
Food 96125
12,000
Commission 5%
34,560
1,42,560
5,48,640
3,50,000
Crew
(ii)
72,000
4,22,000
1,26,640
7,25,760
Variable costs:
Fuel
96,000
Food 108125
13,500
8.12
Operating Costing
Commission @ 5%
36,288
Contribution
5,79,972
There is an increase in contribution
by Rs. 31,332. Hence the proposal is
acceptable
Question 6
A Club runs a library for its members. As part of club policy, an annual subsidy of upto Rs. 5 per
member including cost of books may be given from the general funds of the club. The management
of the club has provided the following figures for its library department.
Number of Club members
5,000
1,000
Rs. 100
500
5 days
50,000 books
1,200 books
Rs. 10
Staff details
No.
Per Employee
Salary per month (Rs.)
Librarian
01
10,000
Assistant Librarian
03
7,000
Clerk
01
4,000
the cost of maintaining the library per year excluding the cost of new books;
(ii)
the cost incurred per member per month on the library excluding cost of new books; and
8.13
Cost Accounting
(iii) the net income from the library per year.
If the club follows a policy that all new books must be purchased out of library revenue
(a) What is the maximum number of books that can be purchased per year and (b) How
many excess books are being purchased by the library per year?
Also, comment on the subsidy policy of the club.
Answer
Computation of total revenue
No. of library members
No
1,000
Rs.
1,00,000
Rs.
2,500
Rs.
1,02,500
Rs.
12,30,000
No.
Total cost
Rs.
Rs.
Librarian
10,000
10,000
Assistant Librarian
7,000
21,000
Clerk
4,000
4,000
35,000
4,20,000
8.14
No.
50,000
Rs. 10
5,00,000
9,20,000
Operating Costing
Rs.
920
76.67
Cost incurred
(9,20,000/5,000)
per
club
member
per
annum
Rs.
184
Rs.
15.33
(12,30,000 9,20,000)
Rs.
3,10,000
Rs.
300
No.
1033.333
No.
1200
No.
166.6667
Rs.
50,000
Rs.
50
Rs.
10
Maximum number
(3,10,000/300)
of
new
books
per
annum
Comment:
The club is exceeding its subsidy target to members by Rs. 45 (Rs. 50 5) per library member and
Rs. 5 (Rs. 10 5) per club member.
Question 7
A company runs a holiday home. For this purpose, it has hired a building at a rent of Rs. 10,000
per month alongwith 5% of total taking. It has three types of suites for its customers, viz., single
room, double rooms and triple rooms.
Following information is given:
Type of suite
Number
Occupancy percentage
Single room
100
100%
Double rooms
50
80%
Triple rooms
30
60%
8.15
Cost Accounting
The rent of double rooms suite is to be fixed at 2.5 times of the single room suite and that of triple
rooms suite as twice of the double rooms suite.
The other expenses for the year 2006 are as follows:
Rs.
Staff salaries
14,25,000
4,50,000
2,15,000
1,23,500
Laundry charges
80,500
Interior decoration
74,000
Sundries
1,53,000
Provide profit @ 20% on total taking and assume 360 days in a year.
You are required to calculate the rent to be charged for each type of suite.
Answer
(i)
Occupancy
36,000 1 =
6,480 5 =
Total
(ii)
36,000
32,400
1,04,400
14,25,000
4,50,000
2,15,000
1,23,500
Laundry charges
80,500
8.16
Operating Costing
Interior decoration
74,000
Sundries
1,53,000
25,21,000
1,20,000
+ 5% on takings
Total cost
Profit is 20% of total takings
9 tonne
12 tonne
15 tonne
20 tonne
The company provides the goods transport service between stations A to station B. Distance
between these stations is 200 kilometres. Each vehicle makes one round trip per day an average.
Vehicles are loaded with an average of 90 per cent of capacity at the time of departure from station
A to station B and at the time of return back loaded with 70 per cent of capacity. 10 per cent of
vehicles are laid up for repairs every day. The following informations are related to the month of
October, 2008:
8.17
Cost Accounting
Rs. 30,000
Salary of 30 drivers
Wages of 25 Helpers
Wages of 20 Labourers
Consumable stores
Rs. 45,000
Insurance (Annual)
Rs. 24,000
Rs. 60,000
Rs. 35
5 Km.
Rs. 23,500
Rs. 1,25,000
Rs. 90,000
Rs. 10,000
Rs. 5,000
Depreciation of vehicles
Rs. 2,00,000
There is a workshop attached to transport department which repairs these vehicles and other
vehicles also. 40 per cent of transport managers salary is debited to the workshop. The transport
department is charged Rs. 28,000 for the service rendered by the workshop during October, 2008.
During the month of October, 2008 operation was 25 days.
You are required:
(i)
(ii) Find out the freight to be charged per ton-km, if the company earned a profit of 25
per cent on freight.
Answer (a)
(i)
Particulars
A.
Amount
(Rs.)
Fixed Charges:
Managers salary: Rs. 30,000
60
100
18,000
1,20,000
8.18
Operating Costing
B.
C.
D.
E.
(ii)
50,000
30,000
2,000
5,000
7,500
10,000
28,000
2,70,500
12,60,000
23,500
2,00,000
1,25,000
45,000
5,000
16,58,500
19,29,000
18,86,400
1.022
Rs. 1.022
Re. 0.341
Workings:
1.
Cost of Diesel:
Distance covered by each vehicle during October, 2008 = 200 2 25 90/100 = 9,000 km.
Consumption of diesel =
9,000 20
36,000 litres.
5
8.19
Cost Accounting
2.
8.20
Operating Costing
EXERCISE
Question 1
Distinguish between Operating Costing and Operation Costing.
Answer
Refer to Chapter No. 6 i.e. Method of Costing I of Study Material.
Question 2
(a) What do you understand by Operating Costs? Describe its essential features and state
where it can be usefully implemented.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 6 i.e. Method of Costing I of Study Material.
(b) A chemical factory runs its boiler on furnace oil obtained from Indian Oil and Bharat
Petroleum, whose depots are situated at a distance of 12 and 8 miles from the factory
site. Transportation of Furnace Oil is made by the Companys own tank lorries of 5 tons
capacity each. Onward trips are made only on full load and the lorries return empty. The
filling-in time takes an average 40 minutes for Indian Oil and 30 minutes for Bharat
Petroleum. But the emptying time in the factory is only 40 minutes for all. From the
record available it is seen that the average speed of the companys lorries works out to
24 miles per hour. The varying operating charges average 60 paise per mile covered and
fixed charges give an incidence of Rs. 7.50 per hour of operation. Calculate the cost per
ton mile for each source.
Answer
Cost per ton mile
Indian Oil
Bharat Petroleum
53 paise (Approx.)
Question 3
SMC is a public school having five buses each plying in different directions for the transport of
its school students. In view of a large number of students availing of the bus service, the
buses work two shifts daily both in the morning and in the afternoon. The buses are garaged in
the school. The work-load of the students has been so arranged that in the morning the first
trip picks up the senior students and the second trip plying an hour later picks up the junior
students. Similarly in the afternoon the first trip drops the junior students and an hour later the
second trip takes the senior students home.
The distance travelled by each bus one way in 8 kms. The school works 25 days in a month
and remains closed for vacation in May, June and December. Bus fee, however, is payable by
the students for all the 12 months of the year.
The details of expenses for a year are as under:
8.21
Cost Accounting
Drivers salary
Rs.
Cleaners salary
Rs.
Rs.
Insurance
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
1,50,000 each
Scrap value
Rs.
30,000
Diesel cost
Rs.
(Life 12 years)
Prepare a statement showing the expenses of operating a single bus and the fleet of five
buses for a year.
(ii) Work out the average cost per student per month in respect of
(A) Students coming from a distance of upto 4 kms. from the school and
(B) Students coming from a distance beyond 4 kms. from the school
Answer
Total Cost (Rs.)
Cost per student (full fee)
Question 4
SHANKAR has been promised a contract to run a tourist car on a 20 km. long route for the
chief executive of a multinational firm. He buys a car costing Rs. 1,50,000. The annual cost of
insurance and taxes are Rs. 4,500 and Rs. 900 respectively. He has to pay Rs. 500 per month
for a garage where he keeps the car when it is not in use. The annual repair costs are
8.22
Operating Costing
estimated at Rs. 4,000. The car is estimated to have a life of 10 years at the end of which the
scrap value is likely to be Rs. 50,000.
He hires a driver who is to be paid Rs. 300 per month plus 10% of the takings as commission.
Other incidental expenses are estimated at Rs. 200 per month.
Petrol and oil will cost Rs. 100 per 100 kms. The car will make 4 round trips each day.
Assuming that a profit of 15% on takings is desired and that the car will be on the road for 25
days on an average per month, what should he charge per round-trip?
Answer charge per round trip Rs. 88.22
Question 5
The Union Transport Company has been given a twenty kilometer long route to play a bus.
The bus costs the company Rs. 1,00,000. It has been insured at 3% per annum. The annual
road tax amounts to Rs. 2,000. Garage rent is Rs. 400 per month. Annual repair is estimated
to cost Rs. 2,360 and the bus is likely to last for five years.
The salary of the driver and the conductor is Rs.600 and Rs. 200 per month respectively in
addition to 10% of takings as commission to be shared equally by them. The managers salary
is Rs.1,400 per month and stationery will cost Rs. 100 per month. Petrol and oil cost Rs. 50
per 100 kilometers. The bus will make three round trips per day carrying on an average 40
passengers in each trip. Assuming 15% profit on takings and that the bus will ply on an
average 25 days in a month, prepare operating cost statement on a full year basis and also
calculate the bus fare to be charged from each passenger per kilometer.
Answer Rate to be charged per kilometer from
7.2 Paise
each passenger
Question 6
A company is considering three alternative proposals for conveyance facilities for its sales
personnel who have to do considerable travelling, approximately 20,000 kilometers every
year. The proposals are as follows:
(i)
Purchase and maintain of its own fleet of cars. The average cost of a car is Rs. 1,00,000.
(ii) Allow the executive to use his own car and reimburse expenses at the rate of Rs. 1.60
paise per kilometre and also bear insurance costs.
(iii) Hire cars from an agency at Rs. 20,000 per year per car. The Company will have to bear
costs of petrol, taxes and tyres.
The following further details are available:
Petrol Rs. 0.60 per km.
8.23
Cost Accounting
Repairs and maintenance Rs. 0.20 P per km.
Tyre rs. 0.12 P per km.
Insurance Rs. 1,200 per car per annum.
Taxes Rs. 800 per car per annum.
Life of the car: 5 years with annual mileage of 20,000 kms.
Resale value : Rs. 20,000 at the end of the fifth year.
Work out the relative costs of three proposals and rank them.
Answer
Cost for 2,000 Kms.
Ranking of alternative proposals
II
III
Rs.36,400
Rs. 33,200
Rs. 35,200
III
II
Question 7
Prakash Automobiles distributes its goods to a regional dealer using a single Lorry. The
dealers premises are 40 kilometres away by road. The lorry has a capacity of 10 tonnes and
makes the journey twice a day fully loaded on the outward journeys and empty on return
journeys. The following information is available for a Four Weekly period during the year
1990:
Petrol consumption
Petrol cost
Oil
Drivers wages
Repairs
Garage rent
Rs. 4,50,000
Life of Lorry
80,000 kilometres
Insurance
Cost of Tyres
Rs. 6,250
Life of Tyres
Rs.50,000
8.24
Operating Costing
The Lorry operates on a five day week.
Required:
(a) A statement to show the total cost of operating the vehicle for the four weekly period
analysed into running costs and fixed costs.
(b) Calculate the vehicle cost per kilometer and per tonne kilometer.
Answer (a) Total running cost (Rs.)
24,400
Grade of worker
A
B
C
D
E
The factory works 40 hours a week and the production target is 600 dozens per week. Prepare
a statement showing for each operation and in total the number of operators required, the
labour cost per dozen and the total labour cost per week to produce the total targeted output.
Answer Total number of operators required 300
Labour cost of 600 dozens per week Rs. 5130
Labour cost per dozen Rs. 8.55
Question 9
A truck starts with a load of 10 tonnes of goods from station P. It unloads 4 tonnes at station Q and
rest of the goods at station R. It reaches back directly to station P after getting reloaded with 8
tonnes of goods at station R. The distances between P to Q, Q to R and then from R to P are 40
kms, 60 kms, and 80 kms, respectively. Compute Absolute tonne-km and Commercial tonne-km.
Answer
Absolute tonnes-kms 1,400 tonnes kms.
Commercial tonnes-kms 1,440 tonnes-kms
8.25
Cost Accounting
Question 10
Global Transport Ltd. charges Rs. 90 per ton for its 6 tons truck lorry load from city A to city
B. The charges for the return journey are Rs.84 per ton. No concession or reduction in these
rates is made for any delivery of goods at intermediate station C. In January 1997 the truck
made 12 outward journeys for city B with full load out of which 2 tones were unloaded twice in
the way of city C. The truck carried a load of 8 tons in its return journey for 5 times but once
caught by police and Rs.1,200 was paid as fine. For the remaining trips the truck carried full
load out of which all the goods on load were unloaded once at city C. The distance from city
A to city C and city B are 140 kms and 300 kms respectively. Annual fixed costs and
maintenance charges are Rs. 60,000 and Rs. 12,000 respectively Running charges spent
during January, 1997 are Rs. 2,944.
You are required to find out the cost per absolute ton-kilometre and the profit for January,
1997
Answer Cost per absolute ton km
Rs. 0.20
Profit (Rs.)
3,224
Question 11
A transport service company is running five buses between two towns which are 50 kms apart.
Seating capacity of each bus is 50 passengers. The following particulars were obtained from
their books for April, 1998:
Rs.
Wages of drivers, conductors and cleaners
24,000
10,000
35,000
8,000
16,000
Depreciation
26,000
20,000
1,39,000
Actually, passengers carried were 75 percent of seating capacity. All buses ran on all days of
the month. Each bus has made one round trip per day.
Find out the cost per passenger km.
Answer Cost per passenger Km.
Rs. 0.2471
8.26
CHAPTER 9
Process Costing:- Used in industries where the material has to pass through two or more
processes for being converted into a final product.
2.
Normal process loss - The cost of normal process loss is absorbed by good units
produced under the process. The amount realised by the sale of normal process loss
units should be credited to the process account.
(ii) Abnormal process loss - The total cost of abnormal process loss is credited to the
process account from which it arise. the total cost of abnormal process loss is debited
to costing profit and loss account.
(iii) Abnormal gain- The process account under which abnormal gain arises is debited
with the abnormal gain and credited to Abnormal gain account which will be closed by
transferring to the Costing Profit and loss account.
3.
4.
Equivalent production means converting the incomplete production units into their
equivalent completed units.
Valuation of work-in-progress : there are three methods for the valuation of work-inprogress which are as follows:
(i)
First-in-First Out (FIFO) method. Under this method the units completed and
transferred include completed units of opening work-in-progress and subsequently
introduced units. Proportionate cost to complete the opening work-in-progress and
Cost Accounting
that to process the completely processed units during the period are derived
separately. The cost of opening work-in-progress is added to the proportionate cost
incurred on completing the same to get the complete cost of such units. In this
method the closing stock of Work in progress is valued at current cost.
(ii)
Last-in-First Out (LIFO) method. According to this method units lastly entering in the
process are the first to be completed. This assumption has a different impact on the costs
of the completed units and the closing inventory of work-in-progress. The completed units
will be shown at their current cost and the closing inventory of work-in-progress will
continue to appear at the cost of the opening inventory of work-in-progress.
(iii) Average Cost method (or weighted average cost method). Under this method, the
cost of opening work-in-progress and cost of the current period are aggregated and
the aggregate cost is divided by output in terms of completed units. The equivalent
production in this case consists of work-load already contained in opening work-inprocess and work-load of current period.
6.
Inter-Process Profits
The output of one process is transferred to the next process not at cost but at market value
or cost plus a percentage of profit. The difference between cost and the transfer price is
known as inter-process profits.
Question 1
Following information is available regarding process A for the month of February, 1999: Production
Record.
Units in process as on 1.2.1999
4,000
16,000
Units completed
14,000
6,000
Rs.
Materials
6,000
Labour
1,000
Overhead 1,000
8,000
9.2
25,600
Labour
15,000
Overhead 15,000
55,600
Presuming that average method of inventory is used, prepare:
(i)
(ii)
Particulars
Input
(Units)
Output
20,000
Completed
_____
WIP
20,000
(ii)
Equivalent Production
Units
Materials
Labour
Overheads
Equivalent
units
%
completion
Equivalent
units
%
completion
Equivalent
units
%
completion
14,000
100
14,000
100
14,000
100
14,000
6,000
100
6,000
33-1/3
2,000
33-1/3
2,000
20,000
20,000
16,000
16,000
Particulars
Materials
Labour
Overhead
Total
6,000
1,000
1,000
8,000
25,600
15,000
15,000
55,600
31,600
16,000
16,000
63,600
20,000
16,000
16,000
1.58
9.3
3.58
Cost Accounting
(iii)
Rs.
50,120
9,480
Labour
2,000
Overhead
2,000
13,480
63,600
4,000
16,000
To Labour
To Overhead
Rs.
8,000 By Completed units
25,600 By Closing WIP
Units
Rs.
14,000
50,120
6,000
13,480
15,000
_____
15,000
_____
_____
20,000
63,600
20,000
63,600
Question 2
Explain briefly the procedure for the valuation of Work-in-process.
Answer
Valuation of Work-in process:
The valuation of work-in-process can be made in the following three ways, depending upon the
assumptions made regarding the flow of costs.
A brief account of the procedure followed for the valuation of work-in-process under the above
three methods is as follows;
9.4
Actual number of
= units in the process
Percentage of
work completed
of manufacture
It consists of balance of work done on opening work-in-process, current production done fully and
part of work done on closing WIP with regard to different elements of costs viz., material, labour
and overhead.
Question 4
From the following Information for the month ending October, 2005, prepare Process Cost
accounts for Process III. Use First-in-fist-out (FIFO) method to value equivalent production.
Direct materials added in Process III (Opening WIP)
Transfer from Process II
Transferred to Process IV
48,000 units
5,000 units
9.5
Cost Accounting
Units scrapped
2,000 units
Rs. 1,97,600
Direct wages
Rs. 97,600
Production Overheads
Rs. 48,800
Degree of completion:
Opening Stock
Closing Stock
Scrap
Materials
80%
70%
100%
Labour
60%
50%
70%
Overheads
60%
50%
70%
The normal loss in the process was 5% of production and scrap was sold at Rs. 3 per unit.
Answer
(a)
Process III
Period..
(FIFO Method)
Op. Stock : 2000 units
Introduced : 53000 units
Statement of Equivalent Production
Input
Item
Output
Units
Item
Equivalent production
Units
Material A
Material B
Op stock
2,000
400
20
800
40
Process
II transfer
Introduced
&
completed during
53,000 the
period
(48,000 2000)
46,000
46,000
100
46,000
100
46,000
100
2,500
5,000
5,000
100
3,500
70
2,500
50
55,500
51,000
500
500
55,000
50,500
48,000
Normal Loss
(2000+53000
5000) x 5%
55,000 Cl WIP
Ab. Gain
9.6
49,900
100
500
49,400
49,300
100
500
48,800
100
Cost
(Rs.)
Equivalent
Production.
Cost
per unit
Rs.
Material A
Transfer from previous. Process
4,11,500
7,500
4,04,000
50,500
1,97,600
49,400
Wages
97,600
48,800
Overheads
48,800
48,800
Material B
7,48,000
15
Mat B
400 Rs. 4
1,600
Wages
800 Rs. 2
1,600
OHs.
800 Re. 1
800
4,000
Mat A
5,000 8
40,000
Mat B
3,500 4
14,000
Wages
2,500 2
5,000
OHs
2,500 1
2,500
61,500
Abnormal Gain
500 Rs. 15
7,500
2,000
53,000
Amount
Units
process
2,500
IV
A/c
Amount
7,500
Cost Accounting
(6,90,000 + 4000 +
25,750)
To Direct Material
To Direct Wages
97,600
To Prodn. OHs
48,800
To Abnormal Gain
500
7,500
55,500
7,88,750
48,000
7,19,750
5,000
61,500
55,500
7,88,750
Question 5
A Company produces a component, which passes through two processes. During the month of
April, 2006, materials for 40,000 components were put into Process I of which 30,000 were
completed and transferred to Process II. Those not transferred to Process II were 100% complete
as to materials cost and 50% complete as to labour and overheads cost. The Process I costs
incurred were as follows:
Direct Materials
Rs.15,000
Direct Wages
Rs.18,000
Factory Overheads
Rs.12,000
Of those transferred to Process II, 28,000 units were completed and transferred to finished goods
stores. There was a normal loss with no salvage value of 200 units in Process II. There were
1,800 units, remained unfinished in the process with 100% complete as to materials and 25%
complete as regard to wages and overheads.
No further process material costs occur after introduction at the first process until the end of the
second process, when protective packing is applied to the completed components. The process
and packing costs incurred at the end of the Process II were:
Packing Materials
Rs.4,000
Direct Wages
Rs.3,500
Factory Overheads
Rs.4,500
Required:
(i)
Prepare Statement of Equivalent Production, Cost per unit and Process I A/c.
(ii)
Prepare statement of Equivalent Production, Cost per unit and Process II A/c.
9.8
Labour and
Overheads
Units completed
30,000
30,000
Closing Inventory
10,000
5,000
Equivalent Production
40,000
35,000
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
15,000
30,000
45,000
Cost/unit
0.375
0.8571
3,750
4,286
Total
8,036
36,964
Process I Account
Units
Units
Rs.
30,000
36,964
Direct wages
10,000
8,036
Factory
overheads
12,000
40,000
45,000
Direct material
40,000
40,000
Rs.
45,000
Process II
Units completed
28,000
28,000
Closing Inventory
1,800
450
Equivalent Production
29,800
28,450
Process cost
36,964
8,000
1.24
0.2812
Cost/unit
9.9
Total
44,964
Cost Accounting
Closing inventory
2,232
127
2,359
42,605
4,000
Rs. 46,605
Process II Account
To
Material transferred
from Process I
Units
Rs.
30,000
36,964
By
Finished
stores A/c
Units
Rs.
28,000
46,605
1,800
2,359
200
goods
To
Packing Material
4,000
By
WIP stock
To
Direct wages
3,500
By
Normal loss
To
Factory overheads
4,500
______
______
48,964
30,000
48,964
30,000
Question 6
A Chemical Company carries on production operation in two processes. The material first pass
through Process I, where Product A is produced.
Following data are given for the month just ended:
Material input quantity
2,00,000 kgs.
40,000 kgs.
1,60,000 kgs.
30,000 kgs.
Rs. 75,000
Processing cost
Rs. 1,02,000
Rs. 20,000
Processing cost
Rs. 12,000
Normal process loss in quantity may be assumed to be 20% of material input. It has no realisable
value.
Any quantity of Product A can be sold for Rs. 1.60 per kg.
9.10
Rs.
Rs.
1,32,000
1,76,000
1,20,000
1,40,000
Materials Cost
Processing Costs
Required:
(i)
Determine, using the weighted average cost method, the cost per kg. of Product A in
Process I and value of both work completed and closing work-in-progress for the month just
ended.
(ii)
Answer
(i)
Process I
Statement of equivalent production
Inputs
Particulars
Output
Units
Particulars
Kg.
Opening
W.I.P.
New material
introduced
Equivalent output
Units
Material
Kg.
%
Conversion
Unit kg.
%
Units kg.
40,000
Normal loss
40,000
2,00,000
Units
introduced &
completed
1,60,000
100%
1,60,000
100%
1,60,000
Abnormal loss
10,000
100%
10,000
100%
10,000
30,000
2/3rd
20,000
_______
2,40,000
Closing WIP
30,000
2,40,000
9.11
100%
2,00,000
1,90,000
Cost Accounting
Process I
Statement of cost for each element
Elements of
cost
Costs of Costs
opening
in
WIP
process
Total
cost
Equivalent
units
Cost/Unit
(Kg.)
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Kg.
Rs.
Material
20,000
75,000
95,000
2,00,000
0.475
Conversion cost
12,000
1,02,000 1,14,000
1,90,000
0.600
32,000
1,77,000 2,09,000
1.075
Elements
Equivalent units
Cost/unit
Cost
Total cost
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Material
1,60,000
.475
76,000
Conversion
1,60,000
.600
96,000
Material
30,000
.475
14,250
Conversion
20,000
.600
12,000
1,72,000
26,250
(ii) Statement showing comparative data to decide whether 1,20,000 kg. of product A
should be processed further into AX.
Alternative I To sell product A after Process I
Rs.
1,92,000
1,29,000
Gain
63,000
4,80,000
Rs. 1,29,000
Material in Process II
= Rs. 1,32,000
= Rs. 1,20,000
Gain
3,81,000
99,000
9.12
Rs. 36,000
Rs.
44,000
20,000
43,000
21,000
Total cost
1,28,000
1,28,000
=
80,000
80,000
Rs. 1.60
Question 7
Following details are related to the work done in Process A of XYZ Company during the month of
March, 2007:
Opening work-in-progress (2,000 units)
Rs.
Materials
80,000
Labour
15,000
Overheads
45,000
14,80,000
3,59,000
Overheads
10,77,000
100%
80%
9.13
Cost Accounting
Degree of Completion:
Materials
100%
80%
(ii)
Statement of cost;
Opening WIP
Units introduced
Units
2,000
38,000
_____
40,000
(ii)
Output
Units
Completed and
transfer to
Process B
Normal loss
(5% of 40,000)
Abnormal loss
Closing WIP
35,000
Equivalent production
Material
Labour &
Overheads
%
Units
%
Units
100
35,000 100
35,000
2,000
1,000
2,000
40,000
100
100
1,000
2,000
38,000
80
80
800
1,600
37,400
Statement of Cost
Details
Material
Less: Value of
normal loss
Cost at the
beginning of
process
Rs.
80,000
Cost
added
Total cost
Rs.
14,80,000
Rs.
15,60,000
(20 2,000 = 40,000)
15,20,000
9.14
Equival
ent
Units
Rs.
Cost
per
unit
Rs.
38,000
40
15,000
3,59,000
3,74,000
37,400
10
Overheads
45,000
10,77,000
11,22,000
37,400
30
80
= Rs. 40,000
= Rs. 32,000
Rs. 72,000
(c)
Closing WIP
2,000 units
= Rs. 80,000
= Rs. 64,000
Rs. 1,44,000
(iv)
Process A Account
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
To
Opening WIP
Material
introduced
Units
Amount
Particulars
Units
Amount
2,000
1,40,000*
By
Normal Loss
2,000
40,000
38,000
14,80,000
By
Abnormal loss
1,000
72,000
By
35,000
28,00,000
2,000
1,44,000
40,000
30,56,000
Direct labour
3,59,000
Overheads
10,77,000
______
________
40,000
30,56,000
By
Closing WIP
Cr.
Process A A/c
2,000
40,000
2,000
40,000
By
9.15
2,000
40,000
2,000
40,000
Cost Accounting
Abnormal Loss Account
Dr.
To
Process A A/c
Cr.
1,000
72,000
By
1,000
20,000
_____
______
By
____
52,000
1,000
72,000
1,000
72,000
Question 8
RST Limited processes product Z through two distinct process Process I and Process II. On
completion, it is transferred to finished stock. From the following information for the year 2006-07,
prepare Process I, Process II and Finished Stock A/c:
Particulars
Process I
Process II
7,500 units
Rs. 60
7,050 units
6,525 units
5%
10%
Direct wages
Rs. 1,35,750
Rs. 1,29,250
Direct expenses
60% of
65% of
direct wages
direct wages
20% of
15% of
direct wages
direct wages
Rs. 12.50
Rs. 37.50
Manufacturing overheads
6,000 units of finished goods were sold at a profit of 15% on cost. Assume that there was no
opening or closing stock of work-in-progress.
Answer
Process I Account
Qty.
To Raw material
7,500
Rate
60
Amount
Qty.
Rate
Amount
375
12.50
4,688
75
96.79
7,260
7,050
96.79
6,82,402
(5% 7,500)
To Direct wages
To Direct expenses
60% of direct
9.16
wages
To Manufacturing
Overheads
(20% of direct
wages)
_____
27,150
_____
_______
7,500
6,94,350
7,500
6,94,350
6,94,350 4,688
Rs. 96.7947.
7,125
(96.80 approx.)
Process II Account
Qty.
To
Process I
7,050
Rate
96.79
Amount
6,82,402 By
Qty.
Normal Loss
Rate
Amount
705
37.50
26,438
6,525
140.05
9,13,823
(10%)
To
Direct wages
1,29,250 By
Finished
Stock A/c
To
84,013
of direct wages
To
19,387
Manufacturing
Overheads (15% of
direct wages)
To
Abnormal gain
9,15,052
180
140.05
7,230
25,209
____
_______
9,40,261
7,230
9,40,261
Abnormal gain
9,15,052 26,438
Rs. 140.05.
6,345
9.17
Cost Accounting
Finished Stock Account
Qty.
To
Process II
To
Profit and
Loss
Account
6,525
Rate
140.05
Amount
9,13,823 By Sales A/c
By Balance
c/d
Qty.
Rate
Amount
6,000
161.06
9,66,341
140.05
73,526
525
1,26,044
6,525
10,39,867
6,525
10,39,867
Question 9
(a) A product passes through three processes X, Y and Z. The output of process X and Y is
transferred to next process at cost plus 20 per cent each on transfer price and the output of
process Z is transferred to finished stock at a profit of 25 per cent on transfer price. The
following informations are available in respect of the year ending 31st March, 2008:
Process
Process
Process
Finished
Stock
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Opening stock
15,000
27,000
40,000
45,000
Material
80,000
65,000
50,000
Wages
1,25,000
1,08,000
92,000
Manufacturing Overheads
96,000
72,000
66,500
Closing stock
20,000
32,000
39,000
50,000
NIL
4,000
10,000
20,000
Stock in processes is valued at prime cost. The finished stock is valued at the price at which it is
received from process Z. Sales of the finished stock during the period was Rs. 14,00,000.
You are required to prepare:
(i)
Process accounts and finished stock account showing profit element at each stage.
(ii)
(iii)
9.18
Process X Account
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
Cost
Profit
Rs.
To
Opening Stock
Total
Rs.
Rs.
15,000
Particulars
15,000 By
Process Y A/c
Cost
Profit
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
2,96,000
74,000
3,70,000
(Transfer)
To
Material
To
Wages
Total
1,25,000
Prime Cost
2,20,000
20,000
20,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
96,000
Manufacturing
80,000
1,25,000
2,20,000
To
80,000
96,000
Overheads
Total cost
To
2,96,000
2,96,000
_______
74,000
74,000
_______
______
_______
2,96,000
74,000
3,70,000
2,96,000
74,000
3,70,000
Process Y Account
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
To
Opening Stock
Cost
Profit
Rs.
Rs.
23,000
4,000
Total
Particulars
Rs.
27,000 By
Process Z A/c
(Transfer)
To
Process X A/c
To
Material
To
Wages
Total
Less: Closing stock
2,96,000
65,000
1,08,000
74,000
3,70,000
65,000
1,08,000
4,92,000
78,000
5,70,000
27,621
4,379
32,000
9.19
Cost
Profit
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
5,36,379
2,26,121
7,62,500
Cost Accounting
Prime Cost
To
4,64,379
73,621
5,38,000
Manufacturing
Overheads
Total cost
Profit and Loss
To
72,000
5,36,379
72,000
73,621
6,10,000
1,52,500
1,52,500
_______
_______
_______
_______
______
_______
5,36,379
2,26,121
7,62,500
5,36,379
2,26,121
7,62,500
A/c
(20% on transfer Price
or 25% on cost)
Process Z Account
Dr.
Cr.
Particulars
To
Opening Stock
Cost
Profit
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
30,000
10,000
40,000 By
Particulars
Finished Stock
A/c (Transfer)
To
Process Y A/c
To
Material
50,000
To
Wages
92,000
Total
Less: Closing stock
Prime Cost
To
2,26,121
7,62,500
50,000
92,000
7,08,379
2,36,121
9,44,500
29,250
9,750
39,000
6,79,129
2,26,371
9,05,500
Manufacturing
Overheads
Total cost
To
5,36,379
66,500
7,45,629
66,500
2,26,371
9,72,000
3,24,000
3,24,000
A/c
(25% on transfer Price
9.20
Cost
Profit
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
7,45,629
5,50,371
12,96,000
or 33 1/3% on
cost)
______
_______
_______
_______
_______
_______
7,45,629
5,50,371
12,96,000
7,45,629
5,50,371
12,96,000
Cr.
Particulars
Cost
Profit
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Particulars
Cost
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
7,41,862
6,58,138
14,00,000
Opening Stock
25,000
20,000
To
Process Z A/c
7,45,629
5,50,371
12,96,000
7,70,629
5,70,371
13,41,000
28,767
21,233
50,000
7,41,862
5,49,138
12,91,000
_______
1,09,000
1,09,000
_______
_______
________
7,41,862
6,58,138
14,00,000
7,41,862
6,58,138
14,00,000
Total
To
Total
45,000 By
Profit
Cr.
Particulars
Amount
Particulars
Rs.
To
To
Net Profit
Rs.
By
_______
35,362
6,58,138
Amount
34,000
By
Process X A/c
74,000
By
Process Y A/c
1,52,500
By
Process Z A/c
3,24,000
By
1,09,000
6,93,500
6,93,500
9.21
Cost Accounting
Workings:
Calculation of amount of unrealized profit on closing stock:
Process X = Nil
Process Y
Rs. 78,000
Rs. 32,000 Rs. 4,379.
Rs. 5,70,000
Process Z
Rs. 2,36,121
Rs. 39,000 Rs. 9,750.
Rs. 9,44,500
Finished stock
Rs. 5,50,371
Rs. 50,000 Rs. 21,233.
Rs. 12,96,000
Amount
Assets
Amount
Rs.
Net profit
Amount
Rs.
Rs.
20,000
Process Y
32,000
Process Z
39,000
Finished stock
50,000
1,41,000
Less: Provision
unrealized profit
for
35,362
1,05,638
Question 10
Operation costing is defined as refinement of Process costing. Explain it.
Answer
Operation costing is concerned with the determination of the cost of each operation rather than the
process:
In the industries where process consist of distinct operations, the operation costing method is
applied.
It offers better control and facilitates, the computation of unit operation cost at the end of each
operation.
9.22
(ii)
Output
units
14,400
9.23
Equivalent Production
Material
% units
14,400
100%
Conversion cost
units
14,400
100%
Cost Accounting
and transfer to next
Normal spoilage
Abnormal Spoilage
Closing WIP
1,440
1,160
3,000
20,000
20,000
1,440
1,160
3,000
20,000
100%
100%
100%
1,440
1,160
2,000
19,000
100%
100%
66.67%
Cost in
Process
Total
Equivalent
Units
Cost per
units
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
Materials
30,000
1,20,000
1,50,000
20,000
7.50
Conversion cost
29,200
1,60,800
1,90,000
19,000
10.00
Material
14,400
7.50
Conversion cost
14,400
10.00
25,200
Material
3,000
7.50
Conversion cost
2,000
10.00
Material
1,160
7.50
1,160
Process Account
10.00
Conversion cost
Rs.
To
Opening WIP
59,200
2,52,000
42,500
20,300
Rs.
By
Profit and
(Abnormal)
Loss
To
Material
1,20,000
By
To
Conversion cost
1,60,800
By
Closing WIP
3,40,000
Account
20,300
2,77,200
42,500
3,40,000
Question 12
JK Ltd. produces a product AZE, which passes through two processes, viz., process I and
process II. The output of each process is treated as the raw material of the next process to which it
is transferred and output of the second process is transferred to finished stock. The following data
related to December, 2007:
9.24
Process I
Process II
Rs. 2,00,000
Material consumed
Rs. 1,92,000
96,020
Direct labour
Rs. 2,24,000
1,28,000
Manufacturing expenses
Rs. 1,40,000
60,000
10%
10%
Rs. 9.90
8.60
Output in Units
22,000
20,000
Required:
(i) Prepare Process I and Process II account.
(ii) Prepare Abnormal effective/wastage account as the case may be each process.
Answer
Process I Account
Particulars
Units
Amount
Particulars
Units
25,000
2,00,000
By
Normal wastage
2,500
24,750
500
16,250
22,000
7,15,000
(in Rs.)
(in Rs.)
To
Input
To
Material
1,92,000
By
Abnormal wastage
To
Direct Labour
2,24,000
By
Process II
To
Manufacturing Exp.
Amount
_____
1,40,000
_____
_______
25,000
7,56,000
25,000
7,56,000
7,56,000 24,750
Rs. 32.50 per unit
25,000 2,500
Process II Account
Particulars
Units
Amount
Particulars
Units
(in Rs.)
To
Process I
22,000
To
Material
To
Direct Labour
1,28,000
To
Manufacturing
Exp.
60,000
To
Abnormal effect
Amount
(in Rs.)
7,15,000
By
Normal wastage
96,020
By
Finished stock
2,200
18,920
20,000
9,90,000
200
9,900
_____
_______
22,200
10,08,920
22,200
10,08,920
9.25
Cost Accounting
9,99,020 18,920
Rs. 49.50 per unit
22,000 2,200
Abnormal Wastage Account
Particulars
To
Process I A/c
Units
500
___
500
Amount Particulars
(in Rs.)
16,250 By Cash (Sales)
By Costing
Profit
_____
and Loss A/c
16,250
Abnormal Effectives Account
Particulars
Unit
To
200
Normal wastage
To
___
200
Amount Particulars
(in Rs.)
1,720 By Process II
A/c
8,180
9,900
Units
500
Amount
(in Rs.)
4,950
___
500
11,300
16,250
Units
Amount
(in Rs.)
200
___
200
9,900
____
9,900
Question 13
A product passes from Process I and Process II. Materials issued to Process I amounted to
Rs. 40,000, Labour Rs. 30,000 and manufacturing overheads were Rs. 27,000. Normal loss
was 3% of input as estimated. But 500 more units of output of Process I were lost due to the
carelessness of workers. Only 4,350 units of output were transferred to Process II. There
were no opening stocks. Input raw material issued to Process I were 5,000 units. You are
required to show Process I account.
Answer
Process I Account
Units
To
Material
To
Labour
To
Overhead
5,000
____
Rs.
Rs.
40,000 By
Normal loss*
150
30,000 By
Abnormal loss**
500
10,000
27,000 By
Process II
4,350
87,000
5,000
97,000
5,000
97,000
* 3% of input = 3% 5,000 = 150
**
Units
97,000
97,000
Rs. 20 per unit. for 500 units, Rs. 500 20 = Rs. 10,000.
(5,000 150) 4,850
9.26
EXERCISE
Question 1
Distinguish between job costing and process costing.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 7 (Method of Costing II) of Study Material
Question 2
Write a short note on unit costing method for ascertaining product cost
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 7 (Method of Costing II) of Study Material
Question 3
"The value of scrap generated in a process should be credited to the process account." Do you
agree with this statement? Give reasons.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 7 (Method of Costing II) of Study Material
Question 4
Explain normal wastage, abnormal wastage and abnormal gain and state, how they should be
dealt within process Cost Accounts.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 7 (Method of Costing II) of Study Material
Question 5
Write short note on Abnormal gain in Process Costing
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 7 (Method of Costing II) of Study Material
Question 6
Compare Process Costing with Job Costing
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 7 (Method of Costing II) of Study Material
Question 7
A company within the food industry mixes powdered ingredients in two different processes to
produce one product. The output of Process I becomes the input of Process 2 and the output of
Process 2 is transferred to the packing department.
From the information given below, you are required to open accounts for Process 1, Process 2,
abnormal loss and packing department and to record the transactions for the week ended 11th
May,1985.
9.27
Cost Accounting
Process 1
Input:
Material A
Material B
Mixing Labour
Normal Loss
Output
9,200 kilograms.
Material D
Flavouring Essence
Rs. 330
Mixing Labour
Normal Waste
Output
18,000 kilograms.
No work in process at the beginning of the week but 1,000 kilograms in process at the end of the
week and estimated to be only 50% complete so far as labour and overhead were concerned.
Overhead of Rs. 3,200 incurred by the two processes to be absorbed on the basis of mixing labour
hours.
Answer Transfer to Process 2
To Packing Deptt.
To P/L A
Question 8
Rs. 9,200
Rs. 21,690
Rs. 252
In a manufacturing unit, raw material passes through four processes I, II, III & IV and the output of
each process is the input of the subsequent process. The loss in the four processes I, II, III & IV
are respectively 25%, 20%, 20% and 16-2/3% of the input. If the end product at the end of the
process IV is 40,000 kg, what is the quantity of raw material required to be fed at the beginning of
Process I and the cost of the same at Rs. 4 per kg.?
Find out also the effect of increase or decrease in the material cost of the end product for variation
of every rupee in the cost of the raw material.
9.28
1,00,000 kg.
Question 9
A company is manufacturing building bricks and fire bricks. Both the products require two
processes:
Brick-forming
Heat treating
Time requirements for the two bricks are:
Building Bricks
Forming per 100 Bricks
3 Hrs.
Heat treatment per 100 Bricks
2 Hrs.
Total costs of the two departments in one month were
Fire
Bricks
2 Hrs.
5 Hrs.
Forming
Rs. 21,200
Heat treatment
Rs. 48,800
1,30,000 Nos.
Fire Bricks
70,000 Nos.
Fire Bricks
36,400
33,600
Question 10
An article passes through three successive operations from the raw material to the finished product
stage. The following data are available from the production records of a particular month:
Operation
No.
No. of Pcs.
Input
No. of Pcs.
Rejected
No. of Pcs.
Output
60,000
20,000
40,000
66,000
6,000
60,000
48,000
8,000
40,000
9.29
Cost Accounting
(i)
Determine the input required to be introduced in the first operation in number of pieces in
order to obtain finished output of 100 pieces after the last operation.
(ii)
Calculate the cost of raw material required to produce one piece of finished product, given the
following information.
Weight of the finished piece is 0.10 kg. and the price of raw material is Rs. 20 per kg.
Answer
(i) Input required for final output of 100 units 198
(ii) the cost of raw material required to produce one piece of finished product Rs.3.96
Question 11
A Ltd. produces product AXE which passes through two processes before it is completed and
transferred to finished stock. The following data relate to October 1981.
Process
Particulars
Finished stock
II
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Opening stock
7,500
9,000
Direct materials
15,000
15,750
Direct wages
11,200
11,250
Factory overheads
10,500
4,500
3,700
4,500
11,250
1,500
8,250
Closing stock
22,500
Inter-process profit
Included in opening stock
Output of process I is transferred to process II.
at 25% profit on the transfer price.
Output of process II is transferred to finished stock at 20% profit on the transfer price. Stocks in
process are valued at prime cost. Finished stock is valued at the price at which it is received from
the process II. Sales during the period are Rs. 1,40,000.
Required:
Process cost accounts and finished goods account showing the profit element at each stage.
Answer Profit in Process I(Rs.) 13,500
9.30
1,500 units at
Rs. 15,000
18,500 Units at
Rs. 52,000
Degree of completion
Materials 100% ; Labour and Overheads 33 31 %
Input of Materials
Direct Labour
Rs. 14,000
Overheads
Rs. 28,000
5,000 units
9.31
Cost Accounting
Answer
(a)
Material
Equivalent units
16,000
(b)
Material
Overheads
100%
Labour
60%
Overheads
60%
(3) Input of materials at a total cost of Rs. 36,800 for 9,200 units.
(4) Direct wages incurred Rs. 16,740
(5) Production overhead Rs. 8,370.
(6) Units scrapped 1,200 units. The stage of completion of these units was:
Materials
100%
Labour
80%
Overheads
80%
(7) Closing work in process; 900 units. The stage of completion of these units was:
Material
100%
Labour
70%
Overheads
70%
(8) 7,900 units were completed and transferred to the next process.
(9) Normal loss is 8% of the total input (opening stock plus units put in)
(10) Scrap value is Rs. 4 per unit.
9.32
Calculate the cost of abnormal loss (or gain), closing work in process and the units
transferred to the next process using the FIFO method,
Material
Equivalent units
8,400
8,370
(b)
Material
Labour
Overheads
1
Polishing
1,200
1,000
Units completed
1,000
500
200
500
Rs., 96,000
Rs. 8,000
Opening Stock
Conversion Cost
Rs. 3,36,000
Rs. 54,000
For incomplete units in process, charge materials cost at 100 percent and conversion cost at
60 percent in the Pressing Process and 50 percent in Polishing Process. Prepare a statement of
cost and calculate the selling price per unit which will result in 25 percent profit on sale price.
Answer
Selling price (p.u.)
Rs. 613.33
9.33
Cost Accounting
Question 15
A product passes through three processes A, B and C. The details of expenses incurred on the
three processes during the year 1992 were as under:
Process
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Sundry Materials
10,000
15,000
5,000
Labour
30,000
80,000
65,000
6,000
18,150
27,200
10,000
Direct Expenses
9.34
Process II
NIL
NIL
Rs.
Rs.
60,000
Labour
12,000
16,000
Factory overheads
24,000
20,000
Received in Process
40,000
36,000
36,000
32,000
Closing work-in-progress
2,000
2,000
1,500
Opening work-in-progress
Units of production:
100%
Labour
50%
Overheads
50%
9.35
Cost Accounting
Question 17
In a manufacturing company, a product passes through 5 operations. The output of the 5 th
operation becomes the finished product. The input, rejection, output and labour and overheads of
each operation for a period are as under:
Operation
Input
(units)
Rejection
(units)
Output
(units)
Labour and
Overhead
(Rs.)
21,600
5,400
16,200
1,94,400
20,250
1,350
18,900
1,41,750
18,900
1,350
17,550
2,45,700
23,400
1,800
21,600
1,40,400
17,280
2,880
14,400
86,400
5
You are required to:
(i)
Determine the input required in each operation for one unit of final output.
(ii)
Calculate the labour and overhead cost at each operation for one unit of final output and the
total labour and overhead cost of all operations for one unit of final output.
Answer
(i) Operation
2.00 1.50
1.40
1.30
1.20
18.00 10.50
18.20
7.80
6.00
Rs. 5,000
Rs. 8,600
(ii)
(ii)
Materials
100%
Rs. 24,000
Labour
60%
Rs. 14,400
Overheads
60%
Rs. 7,200
Rs. 1,71,000
9.37
Cost Accounting
(iii) Expenses incurred in Process Q during the month:
Material
Rs. 79,000
Labour
Rs. 1,38,230
Overheads
Rs. 69,120
(v)
Material
100%
50%
Units scrapped
4,000 units
Degree of completion:
Materials
100%
80%
(ii)
Material
Equivalent units
38,000
37,700
(ii)
Material
6.50
4,50,400
Question 21
Write short note on operation costing.
Answer Refer to Chapter No. 7 (Method of Costing II) of Study Material
9.38
CHAPTER 10
Basic Concepts
1.
2.
3.
Cost Accounting
This method may be adopted where the by-product is not saleable in the condition in
which it emerges or comparative prices of similar products are not available.
4.
(c)
(d)
Re-use basis- The value put on the by-product should be same as that of the
materials introduced into the process.
(ii)
The sales value of the by-products may be credited to the Profit and Loss
Account and no credit be given in the Cost Accounts. The credit to the Profit
and Loss Account here is treated either as miscellaneous income or as
additional sales revenue.
2.
The sale proceeds of the by-product may be treated as deductions from the
total costs. The sale proceeds in fact should be deducted either from the
production cost or from the cost of sales.
When the by-products are of considerable total value - The joint costs may
be divided over joint products and by-products by using relative market values ;
physical output method (at the point of split off) or ultimate selling prices (if
sold).
(iii) Where they require further processing -The net realisable value of the byproduct at the split-off point may be arrived at by subtracting the further
processing cost from the realisable value of by-products.
If total sales value of by-products at split-off point is small, it may be treated as per the
provisions discussed above under (i).
In the contrary case, the amount realised from the sale of by-products will be
considerable and thus it may be treated as discussed under (ii).
Question 1
Pokemon Chocolates manufactures and distributes chocolate products. It purchases Cocoa beans
and processes them into two intermediate products:
These two intermediate products become separately identifiable at a single split off point. Every
500 pounds of cocoa beans yields 20 gallons of chocolate powder liquor base and 30 gallons of
milk-chocolate liquor base.
10.2
7,500 pounds
Rs. 7,12,500
Production
Sales
Selling price
3,000 pounds
3,000 pounds
Milk chocolate
5,100
5,100
Rs. 237.50 per pound
The October, 2004 separable costs of processing chocolate-powder liquor into chocolate powder
are Rs. 3,02,812.50. The October 2004 separable costs of processing milk-chocolate liquor base
into milk-chocolate are Rs. 6,23,437.50.
Pokemon full processes both of its intermediate products into chocolate powder or milk-chocolate.
There is an active market for these intermediate products. In October, 2004, Pokemon could have
sold the chocolate powder liquor base for Rs. 997.50 a gallon and the milk-chocolate liquor base
for Rs. 1,235 a gallon.
Required:
(i)
Calculate how the joint cost of Rs. 7,12,500 would be allocated between the chocolate
powder and milk-chocolate liquor bases under the following methods:
(a) Sales value at split off point
(b) Physical measure (gallons)
(c) Estimated net realisable value, (NRV) and
(d) Constant gross-margin percentage NRV.
(ii)
What is the gross-margin percentage of the chocolate powder and milk-chocolate liquor
bases under each of the methods in requirements (i) ?
(iii) Could Pokemon have increased its operating income by a change in its decision to fully
process both of its intermediate products? Show your computations.
10.3
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
Milk chocolate
liquor base
liquor base
Rs. 2,99,250
Rs. 5,55,750
Rs. 8,55,000
0.35
0.65
1.00
Rs. 7,12,,500 x
0.65
= Rs. 2,49,375
= Rs. 4,63,125
Total
Milk chocolate
Total
liquor base
liquor base
Output
300 gallons
450 gallons
750 gallons
Weight
300/750 = 0.40
450/750 = 0.60
1.00
Rs. 7,12,500
=Rs. 2,85,000
Final
sales
production
value
Chocolate powder
Milk chocolate
liquor base
liquor base
Total
Rs. 3,02,812.50
Rs. 6,23,437.50
Rs. 9,26,250
Rs. 2,67,187,50
Rs. 5,87,812.50
Rs. 8,55,000
2,67,187.50/8,55.000
5,87,812.5/8,55,000
= 0.3125
= 0.6875
= Rs. 2,22,656.25
= Rs. 4,89,843.75
10.4
Rs. 7,12,500
Final
sales
production
value
Chocolate powder
Liquor base
Base
of Rs. 5,70,000
Rs. 12,11,250
Total
Rs. 17,81,250
(Chocolate Powder)
(Milk Chocolate)
Rs. 45,600
Rs. 96,900
Rs 1,42,500
Rs. 11,14,350
Rs. 16,38,750
Rs. 3,02,812.50
Rs. 6,23,437.50
Rs. 9,26,250
Rs. 2,21,587.50
Rs. 4,90,912.50
Rs. 7,12,500
= Rs. 17,81,250
Gross Margin
= Rs. 1,42,500
Gross margin %
= Rs 1,42,500 = 8%
Rs.17,81,250
(ii)
Physical
Estimated net
Constant
Split off
Measure
Realisable
gross
Value
Margin NRV
5,70,000
5,70,000
5,70,000
5,70,000
3,02,812.50
3,02,812.50
3,02,812.50
3,02,812.50
2,49,375
2,85,000
2,22,656.25
2,21,587.50
17,812.50
(17,812.50)
44,531.25
45,600
3.125%
(3.125%)
7.8125%
8%
10.5
Cost Accounting
Sales value at
split off
Physical
measure
Estimated net
realisable
Constant
Gross margin
NRV
12,11,250
12,11,250
12,11,250
12,11,250
6,23,437.50
6,23,437.50
6,23,437.50
6,23,437.50
4,63,125
4,27,500
4,89,843.75
4,90,912
1,24,687.50
1,60,312.50
97,968.75
96,900.50
10.29%
13.23%
8.08%
8%
2,70,750
Incremental costs
3,02,812.50
(32,062.50)
6,55,500
Incremental cost
6,23,437.50
32,062.50
The above computations show that Pokemon Chocolates could increase operating income by Rs.
32,062.50 if chocolate liquor base is sold at split off point and milk chocolate liquor base is
processed further.
Question 2
Inorganic Chemical purchases salt and processes it into more-refined products such as caustic
soda, chlorine, and PVC (Polyvinyl chloride). During the month of April, 2000, Inorganic Chemicals
purchased salt for Rs. 10,00,000. Conversion cost of Rs. 15,00,000 were incurred upto the split-off
point, at which time two saleable products wee produced: Caustic soda and chlorine. Chlorine can
be further processed into PVC. The April production and sales information are as follows:
10.6
Production
Sales
Caustic Soda
1,200 tons
1,200 tons
Rs. 1,250
Chlorine
800 tons
PVC
500 tons
500 tons
Rs. 5,000
All 800 tons of chlorine were further processed, at an incremental cost of Rs. 5,00,000 to yield 500
tons of PVC. There were no byproducts or scrap from this further processing of chlorine. There
were no beginning or ending inventories of caustic soda, chlorine or PVC in April.
There is an active market for chlorine. Inorganic Chemicals could have sold all its April production
of chlorine at Rs. 1,875 a ton.
Required:
(i)
Calculate, how the joint costs of Rs. 25,00,000 would be allocated between Caustic soda and
Chlorine under each of the following methods:
(1) sales value at split off;
(2) physical measure (tone); and
(3) estimated net realizable value.
(ii)
What is the gross margin percentage of Caustic soda and PVC under the three methods cited
in requirement (i)?
(iii) Lifetime Swimming Pool Products offer to purchase 800 tons of Chlorine in May, 2000 at Rs.
1,875 a ton. This sale would mean that no PVC would be produced in May. How would
accepting the offer affect May Operating Income?
Answer
(i)
(1)
Products
Sales value at split off (Rs.)
Weightage
Joint costs allocated (Rs.)
Caustic soda
Chlorine
Total
15,00,000
15,00,000
30,00,000
0.5
0.5
12,50,000
12,50,000
10.7
25,00,000
Cost Accounting
(2)
Products
Physical measure (tons)
Weightage
Joint costs allocated (Rs.)
(3)
Caustic soda
Chlorine
Total
1,200
800
2,000
0.6
0.4
15,00,000
10,000,000
25,00,000
Products
Caustic soda
Chlorine
15,00,000
(1,200 tons x Rs. 1,250)
25,00,000
(500 tons x Rs. 5,000)
40,00,000
_________
5,00,000
_________
5,00,000
_________
15,00,000
20,00,000
35,00,000
3/7
4/7
10,71,429
14,28,571
Weightage
Joint cost allocated (Rs.)
3
x Rs. 25,00,000
7
(ii)
Total
25,00,000
4
x Rs. 25,00,000
7
Physical Measure
Estimated net
realizable value
Sales (Rs.)
15,00,000
15,00,000
15,00,000
12,50,000
15,00,000
10,71,429
2,50,000
4,28,571
16.67
28.57
Caustic soda:
Rs.2,50,000
x100
Rs.15,00,000
10.8
Rs.4,28,571
x100
Rs.15,00,000
PVC:
Sales (Rs.)
(500 tons x Rs.5,000)
25,00,000
25,00,000
25,00,000
12,50,000
10,00,000
14,28,571
5,00,000
5,00,000
5,00,000
7,50,000
10,00,000
5,71,429
30
40
22.86
Less: Further
Rs.7,50,000
x100
Rs.25,00,000
Rs.10,00,000
x100
Rs.25,00,000
Rs.5,71,429
x100
Rs.25,00,000
Rs. 10,00,000
Rs. 5,00,000
Rs. 5,00,000
Decision: The operating income of Inorganic Chemicals which converts chlorine into PVC
after further processing will be reduced by Rs. 5,00,000 in May, if it accepts the offer of Lifetime
Swimming Pool Products, of selling to them 800 tons of Chlorine at Rs. 1875 per ton.
Question 3
The Sunshine Oil Company purchases crude vegetable oil. It does refining of the same. The
refining process results in four products at the split off point: M, N, O and P.
Product O is fully processed at the split off point. Product M, N and P can be individually further
refined into Super M, Super N and Super P. In the most recent month (October, 1999), the
output at split off point was:
Product M
3,00,000 gallons
Product N
1,00,000 gallons
Product O
50,000 gallons
Product P
50,000 gallons
The joint cost of purchasing the crude vegetable oil and processing it were Rs. 40,00,000.
10.9
Cost Accounting
Sunshine had no beginning or ending inventories. Sales of Product O in October were Rs.
20,00,000. Total output of products M, N and P was further refined and then sold. Data related to
October, 1999 are as follows:
Further Processing Costs to
Sales
Rs. 80,00,000
Rs. 1,20,00,000
Super N
Rs. 32,00,000
Rs. 40,00,000
Super P
Rs. 36,00,000
Rs. 48,00,000
Sunshine had the option of selling products M, N and P at the split off point. This alternative would
have yielded the following sales for the October, 1999 production:
Product M
Rs. 20,00,000
Product N
Rs. 12,00,000
Product P
Rs. 28,00,000
How the joint cost of Rs. 40,00,000 would be allocated between each product under each of
the following methods (a) sales value at split off; (b) physical output (gallons); and (c)
estimated net realizable value?
(ii)
Could Sunshine have increased its October, 1999 operating profits by making different
decisions about the further refining of product M, N or P? Show the effect of any change you
recommend on operating profits.
Answer
(i)
(a)
Products
M
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
20,00,000
10,00,000
Rs.40,000
x Rs.20,00,000
Rs.80,000
12,00,000
6,00,000
Rs.40,000
x Rs.12,00,000
Rs.80,000
10.10
20,00,000
10,00,000
Rs.40,000
x Rs.20,00,000
Rs.80,000
28,00,000
14,00,000
Rs.40,000
x Rs.28,00,000
Rs.80,000
Total
(b)
80,00,000
40,00,000
Products
3,00,000
24,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
x.3,00,000
5,00,000 gallons
1,00,000
8,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
5,00,000 gallons
x.1,00,000
50,000
4,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
5,00,000 gallons
x.50,000
50,000
4,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
5,00,000 gallons
x.50,000
Total
5,00,000
40,00,000
10.11
Cost Accounting
(c)
Products
(a)
Super
M
Sales
revenue
after further
processing
Sales
revenue at
the point
of split off
Further
processing
costs
Net
realizable
value
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)=[(b)
(d)] or (c)
80,00,000
40,00,000
1,20,00,000
20,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
xRs.40,00,000
Rs.80,00,000
Super N
40,00,000
32,00,000
8,00,000
4,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
xRs.8,00,000
Rs.80,00,000
--
20,00,000
--
20,00,000
10,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
xRs.20,00,000
Rs.80,00,000
Super P
48,00,000
36,00,000
12,00,000
6,00,000
Rs.40,00,000
xRs.12,00,000
Rs.80,00,000
(ii)
Total
80,00,000
40,00,000
Decision about the further refining of Product M, N or P.
Products
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
1,20,00,000
40,00,000
48,00,000
20,00,000
12,00,000
28,00,000
1,00,00,000
28,00,000
20,00,000
80,00,000
32,00,000
36,00,000
20,00,000
(4,00,000)
(16,00,000)
10.12
180 tons
60 Tons
25 tons
Compute the cost of inventories of X, Y and Z for Balance Sheet purposes and cost of goods
sold for income statement purpose as of March 31, 2003, using:
(a) Net realizable value (NRV) method of joint cost allocation
(b) Constant gross-margin percentage NRV method of joint-cost allocation.
10.13
Cost Accounting
(ii)
Compare the gross-margin percentages for X, Y and Z using two methods given in
requirement (i)
Answer
(i)
(a)
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
5,49,000
6,60,375
5,70,750
17,80,125
(366 tons x
(587 tons x
(761 tons x
Rs. 1,500)
Rs. 1,125)
Rs. 750)
3,10,000
3,10,000
5,49,000
6,60,375
2,60,750
14,70,125
2,33,398
2,80,748
1,10,854
6,25,000
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
2,33,378
2,80,748
1,10,854
6,25,000
3,10,000
3,10,000
2,33,398
2,80,748
4,20,854
9,35,000
Additional costs
Cost of goods available for sale
(CGAS)
10.14
1,14,785
28,692
13,846
(1,57,323)
2,52,056
4,07008
7,77,677
X : 49.18%
Y : 10.22% x (CGAS)
Z : 3.29%
(Refer to working note)
Cost of goods sold
1,18,613
Income Statement
Total
2,79,000
5,92,875
5,52,000
14,23,875
(186 tons x
(527 tons x
(736 tons x
Rs. 1,500)
Rs. 1,125)
Rs. 750)
1,18,613
2,52,056
4,07,008
7,77,677
1,60,387
3,40,819
1,44,992
6,46,198
57.49%
57.49%
26.26%
(b)
Total
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs
5,49,000
6,60,375
5,70,750
17,80,125
2,60,641
3,13,517
2,70,967
8,45,125
2,88,359
3,46,958
2,99,783
9,35,000
10.15
Cost Accounting
(Refer to working note 3)
Less: Additional Cost
_______
_______
3,10,000
3,10,000
2,88,359
3,46,858
(10,217)
6,25,000
Note:
The negative joint cost allocation to product Z illustrates one unusual feature of the
constant gross margin NRV method.
Cost of goods sold for income statement purpose
(By using constant gross margin percentage net-realisable value method)
Products
2,88,359
3,46,858
(10,217)
Joint Cost
Total
6,25,000
3,10,000
3,10,000
2,88,359
3,46,858
2,99,783
9,35,000
1,41,815
35,449
9,863
1,87,127
1,46,544
3,11,409
2,89,920
7,47,873
X: 49.18%
Y: 10.22% x CCGS
Z: 3.29%
Cost of goods sold
Income Statement
(Showing gross margin and gross margin percentage by using
constant gross margin percentage NRV method)
Product
X
Total
2,79,000
5,92,875
5,52,000
14,23,875
1,46,544
3,11,409
2,89,920
7,47,873
1,32,456
2,81,466
2,62,080
6,76,002
47.475%
47.475%
47.478%
47.478%
10.16
(ii)
Method
Net realisable
57.49
57.49
26.26
47.48
47.48
47.48
Working notes
1.
Quantity of
ending inentory
in tons
Total producion
Ending inventory
percentage
(1)
(2)
(3)
186
180
366
49.18
527
60
587
10.22
25
761
3.29
Items/Products
Z
2.
736
Joint cost apportioned to each product:
Rs.6,25,000
x Rs.5,49,000
Rs.14,70,125
Similarly, the joint cost of inventories of products Y and Z comes to Rs. 2,80,748 and
Rs. 1,10,854 respectively.
1.
17,80,125
9,35,000
Gross margin
8,45,125
47.4756%
Cost Accounting
Question 5
In a chemical manufacturing company, three products A, B and C emerge at a single split off stage
in department P. Product A is further processed in department Q, product B in department R and
product R and product C in department S. There is no loss in further Processing of any of the three
products. The cost data for a month are as under:
Cost of raw materials introduced in department P
Rs. 12,68,800
Rs.
3,84,000
96,000
64,000
36,000
Factory overheads of Rs 4,64,000 are to be apportioned to the departments on direct wage basis.
During the month under reference, the company sold all three products after processing them
further as under:
Products
Output sold kg.
Selling Price per kg. Rs.
44,000
40,000
20,000
32
24
16
There are no Opening or Closing Stocks If these products were sold at the split off stage, that is,
without further processing, the selling prices would have been Rs. 20,, Rs 22 and
Rs. 10 each per kg respectively for A, B and C.
Required:
(i)
(ii)
Present a statement showing product-wise and total profit for the month under reference as
per the companys current processing policy.
(iii) What processing decision should have been taken to improve the profitability of the company.
(iv) Calculate the product-wise and total profit arising from your recommendation in (iii)
above.
10.18
44,000
40,000
20,000
20
22
10
8,80,000
8,80,000
2,00,000
19,60,000
8,80,000
8,80,000
2,00,000
19,60,000
Total
44,000
40,000
20,000
32
24
16
14,08,000
9,60,000
3,20,000
26,88,000
8,80,000
8,80,000
2,00,000
19,60,000
1,72,800
1,15,200
64,800
3,52,800
10,52,800
9,95,200
2,64,800
23,12,800
3,55,200
(35,200)
55,200
3,75,200
Total
10.19
Cost Accounting
Alternatively:
Incremental
revenue (Rs.)
sales
5,28,000
80,000
1,20,000
1,72,800
1,15,200
64,800
3,55,200
(35,200)
55,200
Total
3,55,200
55,200
4,10,400
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Working notes:
1.
Raw materials
12,68,800
Wages
3,84,000
96,000
64,000
36,000
Overheads
3,07,200
76,800
51,200
28,800
19,60,000
1,72,800
1,15,200
64,800
(i)
Costs incurred in the department P are joint costs of products A, B and C and are equal
to Rs. 19,60,000.
10.20
Costs incurred in the departments Q, R and S are further processing costs of products A, B
and C respectively. Further processing costs of products A, B and C thus are
Rs. 1,72,800; Rs. 1,15,200 and Rs. 64,800 respectively.
Question 6
A companys plant processes 1,50,000 kgs. of raw material in a month to produce two products,
viz, P and Q. The cost of raw material is Rs. 12 per kg. The process costs month are:
Rs.
Direct Materials
90,000
Direct Wages
1,20,000
Variable Overheads
1,00,000
Fixed Overheads
1,00,000
The loss in process is 5% of input and the output ratio of P and Q which emerge simultaneously is
1:2. The selling prices of the two products at the point of split off are: P
Rs. 12 per kg. And Q Rs.20 Per kg. A proposal is available to process P further by mixing it with
other purchased materials. The entire current output of the plant can be so processed further to
obtain a new product S. The price per kg. of S is Rs. 15 and each kg of output of S will require
one kilogram of input P. The cost of processing of P into S (including other materials) is Rs.
1,85,000 per month.
You are required to prepare a statement showing the monthly profitability based both on the
existing manufacturing operations and on further processing.
Will you recommend further processing?
Answer
Working Notes:
Kgs.
1. Material input
1,50,000
7,500
Total output
2. Output of P and Q are in the ratio of 1 : 2 of the total output:
P = 1,42,500 x 1 = 47,500 kg.
3
10.21
1,42,500
Cost Accounting
Q = 1,42,500 x 2 = 95,000 kg.
3
3. Joint Costs:
Rs.
Material (input) (1,50,000 kg. X Rs. 12)
18,00,000
Direct materials
90,000
Direct Wages
1,20,000
Variable overheads
1,00,000
Fixed overheads
1,00,000
22,10,000
2.
3.
Apportionment of joint costs viz. Rs. 22,10,000 over P and Q in proportion of their sales value
i.e. Rs. 5,70,000 and Rs. 19,00,000, i.e., 3 : 10 is:
Joint
apportionment
Total
Rs
Rs.
Rs.
5,10,000
17,00,000
Rs.22,10,000 x 3
13
Rs. 22,10,000 x 10
13
cost 22,10,000
In the ratio of 3 : 10
4.
10.22
Sales Revenue
Total
Total
47,500
95,000
1,42,500
47,500
95,000
1,42,500
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
5,70,000
19,00,000 24,70,000
5,10,000
17,00,000 22,10,000
______
_______
_______
_______
_______
_______
Profit
60,000
2,00,000
2,60,000
17,500
2,00,000
2,17,500
Process 2
Rs. 10,000
Direct labour
Rs. 6,250
Rs. 6,900
Overheads
Rs. 4,500
Rs. 6,900
Normal Loss
10% of input
2,300 kilos
Joint products
Output
A 900 Kilos
B 800 Kilos
C 600 Kilos
10.23
Cost Accounting
There were no opening or closing stocks in either process and the selling prices of the output from
process 2 were:
Joint product A
Joint product B
Joint product C
Required:
(a) Prepare an account for process 1 together with any Loss or Gain Accounts you consider
necessary to record the months activities.
(b) Calculate the profit attributable to each of the joint products by apportioning the total costs
from process 2
(i)
(ii)
Answer
Working Notes:
(1) Joint Cost of three products under Process 2
Rs.
By Transfer of output from process-I
20,700
Direct Labour
6,900
Overhead
6,900
Total
34,500
(2)
Joint Products
A
Output in
Kg.
900
800
600
10.24
Output
S.P.
Sales
Products
In Kg.
(p.u.)
Revenue
Rs.
Rs.
24
21,600
900
Rs. 34,500 x 3
= Rs. 17,250
6
B
800
18
14,400
Rs. 34,500 x 2
= Rs. 11,500
6
C
600
12
7,200
Rs. 34,500 x 1
= Rs. 5,750
______
_______
43,200
(a)
Process 1 Account
Kg.
To Direct material
Rate Amount
per
kg.
Rs.
(Rs.)
2,500
To Direct labour
To Overhead
50
To Abnormal gain
34,500
10,000 By Process 2
Rate Amount
per
kg.
Rs.
(Rs.)
2,300
20,700
250
500
___
___
2,550
21,200
Kg.
Rate Amount
per
kg.
Rs.
(Rs.)
21,200
2,550
Kg.
To Process I
250
Rate Amount
per
kg.
Rs.
(Rs.)
2
500 By Sales
___
250
500
10.25
200
400
50
100
250
500
Cost Accounting
Kg.
50
To Costing Profit
and
Loss Account
___
Kg.
100 By Process I
Rate Amount
per
kg.
Rs.
(Rs.)
50
350
450
___
___
50
450
50
450
Note: Normal output = 2,500 kg. 250 kg. = 2,250 kg
Total Cost = Direct material cost + Direct labour cost + Overheads
Recovery from scrap sales
= Rs.10,000 + Rs.6,250 + Rs.4,500 Rs.500 = Rs.20,250
Rs.20,250
Rs. 9
2,250 kg
Statement of Profit
(attributable to each of the Joint Products according to
weight of output and market value of production)
Joint
products
Output
S.P.
(p.u.)
Sales
value
Rs.
Profit
(Loss)
Profit
Market
value of
production
Kg.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
2x3=4
4-5=7
4-6=8
900
24
21,600
13,500*
17,250**
8,100
4,350
800
18
14,400
12,000
11,500
2,400
2,900
600
12
7,200
9,000
5,750
(1,800)
1,450
43,200
34,500
34,500
8,700
8,700
2,300
* Refer to working note 2
** Refer to working note 3
10.26
10.27
Product X
Product Y
90,000
1,15,000
10
Cost Accounting
There were no opening stocks. If these products sold at split-off-point, the selling price of X and Y
would be Rs. 8 and Rs. 4 per kg respectively.
Required:
(i)
(ii)
Prepare a statement showing the cost per kg of each product indicating joint cost,
processing cost and total cost separately.
(iii)
Prepare a statement showing the product wise profit for the year.
(iv)
On the basis of profits before and after further processing of product X and Y, give your
comment that products should be further processed or not.
Answer
Calculation of quantity produced
Dept I
Dept II
Dept III
Input (kg)
2,00,000
1,20,000
60,000
(20,000)
(20,000)
60,000
1,80,000
1,00,000
1,20,000
Production of X
1,20,000
1,00,000
Production of Y
60,000
(i)
1,20,000
Product Y
1,20,000
60,000
9,60,000
2,40,000
7,00,000
1,75,000
(ii)
Product Y
7,00,000
1,75,000
1,00,000
1,20,000
10.28
7.00
1.458
1.80
1.250
8.80
2.708
Product X
Product Y
1,00,000
1,20,000
Sales (kg)
90,000
1,15,000
Closing stock
10,000
5,000
Rs.
Rs.
9,00,000
4,60,000
88,000
13,540
Value of production
9,88,000
4,73,540
7,00,000
1,75,000
1,80,000
1,50,000
1,08,000
1,48,540
Further processing
Profit
(iv) Profitability statement, before and after processing
Product X
Product X
Product Y
Product Y
Before
(Rs.)
After
(Rs.)
Before
(Rs,)
After
(Rs)
Sales Value
9,60,000
2,40,000
7,00,000
1,75,000
Profit
2,60,000
1,08,000
(as per iii above)
65,000
1,48,540
(as per iii above)
Product X should be sold at split off point and product Y after processing because of higher
profitability.
Question 10
Discuss the treatment of by-product Cost in Cost Accounting.
10.29
Cost Accounting
Answer
Treatment of by-product cost in Cost Accounting:
(i)
When they are of small total value, the amount realized from their sale may be dealt as
follows:
Sales value of the by-product may be credited to Profit and Loss Account and no credit
be given in Cost Accounting. The credit to Profit and Loss Account here is treated either
as a miscellaneous income or as additional sales revenue.
The sale proceeds of the by product may be treated as deduction from the total costs.
The sales proceeds should be deducted either from production cost or cost of sales.
(ii)
In this case, the net realizable value of the by product at the split-off point may be arrived at by
subtracting the further processing cost from realizable value of by products. If the value is small, it
may be treated as discussed in (i) above.
10.30
EXERCISE
Question 1
How would you account for by-product in cost accounting:
(i)
(ii)
By-products
Sales
Rs.
90,000
60,000
40,000
Rs.
6,000
5,000
4,000
Prepare a statement showing the apportionment of joint costs to the main product and the
two-by-products.
(ii)
If the by-product A is not subjected to further processing and is sold at the point of
separation for which there is a market, at Rs. 58,500 without incurring and selling expenses,
would you advise its disposal at this stage? Show the workings.
Answer
Main Product
58,510
10.31
By-Product
A
37,020
24,020
Cost Accounting
Question 4
In an Oil Mill four products emerge from a refining process. The total cost of input during the
quarter ending March, 1983 in Rs. 1,48,000. The output, sales and additional processing costs are
as under:
Product
Output
Additional
Sales
In Litres
Processing
value
Costs after
Split off point
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
AOXE
8,000
43,000
1,72,500
BOXE
4,000
9,000
15,000
COXE
2,000
6,000
DOXE
4,000
1,500
45,000
In case these products were disposed of at the split off point that is before further processing the
selling price would have been:
AOXE
BOXE
COXE
DOXE
Rs. 15.00
Rs.6.00
Rs. 3.00
Rs. 7.50
AOXE
BOXE
COXE
DOXE
30,833
(13,733) 1,067
18,833
21,333
4,267
5,333
1,067
Question 5
A company processes a raw material in its Department 1 to produce three products, viz. B and X at
the same split-off stage. During a period 1,80,000 kgs of raw materials were processed in
Department 1 at a total cost of Rs. 12,88,000 and the resultant output of A, B and X were 18,000
kgs, 10,000 kgs and 54,000 kgs respectively. A and B were further processed in Department 2 at a
cost of Rs. 1,80,000 and Rs. 1,50,000 respectively.
10.32
Quantity Sold
(kgs.)
17,000
5,000
44,000
Sales Value
(Rs.)
12,24,000
2,50,000
7,92,000
There were no opening stocks. If these products were sold at split-off stage, the selling prices of A,
B and X would have been Rs. 50, Rs. 40 and Rs. 10 per kg respectively. Required:
(i)
(ii)
Present a statement showing the cost per kg of each product indicating joint cost and further
processing cost and total cost separately.
(iii) Prepare a statement showing the productwise and total profit for the period.
(iv) State with supporting calculations as to whether any or all the products should be further
processed or not
Answer Products
6, 30,000
45
4,59,000
12
2, 80,000
3, 78,000
43
35,000
3,96,000
(5)
Question 6
Two products P and Q are obtained in a crude form and require further processing at a cost
of Rs. 5 for P and Rs. 4 for Q per unit before sale. Assuming a net margin of 25 percent on cost,
their sale prices are fixed at Rs. 13,75 and Rs. 8.75 per unit respectively. During the period, the
joint cost was Rs. 88,000 and the outputs were:
P
8,000 units
6,000 units
Products
8.00
4.00
10.33
Cost Accounting
Question 7
SUNMOON Ltd. produces 2,00,000; 30,000; 25,000; 20,000 and 75,000 units of its five products A,
B, C and E respectively in a manufacturing process and sells them at Rs. 17, Rs. 13, Rs. 8, Rs 10
and Rs. 14 per unit. Except product D remaining products can be further processed and then can
be sold at Rs. 25, Rs. 17, Rs. 12 and Rs. 20 per unit in case of A, B, C and E respectively.
Raw material costs Rs. 35,90,000 and other manufacturing expenses cost Rs. 5,47,000 in the
manufacturing process which are absorbed on the products on the basis of their. Net realisable
value. The further processing costs of A, B, C and E are Rs, 12,50,000, Rs. 1,50,000; Rs. 50,000
and Rs. 1,50,000 respectively. Fixed costs are Rs. 4,73,000.
Your are required to prepare the following in respect of the coming year.
(a) Statement showing income forecast of the company assuming that none of its products are to
be further processed.
(b) Statement showing income forecast of the company assuming that products A, B, C and E
are to be processed further.
Can you suggest any other production plan whereby the company can maximise its profits. If
yes, then submit a statement showing income forecast arising out of adoption of that plan.
Answer (a) Profit (Rs.)
6,30,000
13,00,000
Question 8
J B Limited produces four joint products A, B, C and D, all of which emerge from the processing of
one raw material. The following are the relevant data:
Production for the period:
Joint Product
Number of units
500
18.00
900
8.00
400
4.00
200
11.00
10.34
1,000
Direct wages
3,000
Manufacturing overhead
2,000
Administration overhead
Number of units
(ii)
Sales value.
Answer (a) Maximum price to be paid for the raw material (Rs.)
10,000
(b)
4,500
8,100
3,600
1,800
8,100
6,480
1,440
1,980
Question 9
A company operates a chemical process which produces four products: K, L M and N from a basic
raw material. The companys budget for a month is as under:
Rs.
Raw materials consumption
17,520
16,240
16,240
Product
Production
Sales
Kgs.
Rs.
Rs.
16,000
1,09,600
28,800
10.35
Cost Accounting
200
5,600
2,000
30,000
16,000
360
21,600
6,600
Product
Selling Price Rs. Per kg.
4.00
28.00
8.00
40.00
The joint costs are to be apportioned on the basis of the sales value realisation at the point of splitoff.
Required:
(i)
(ii)
Present a statement showing the productwise and total budgeted profit or loss based on the
proposal to sell product L at the split-off point and products K, M and N after further
processing.
(iii) Prepare a statement to show the productwise and total profit or loss if the alternative strategy
to sell all the products at split-off stage was adopted.
(iv) Recommend any other alternative which in your opinion can increase the total profit further.
Calculate the total profit as also the poductwise profit or loss, based on your
recommendation.
Answer (i) Products
32,000
2,800
8,000
7,200
48,800
2,800
6,000
7,800
32,000
2,800
8,000
7,200
16,800
(2,000)
600
Question 10
The yield of a certain process is 80% as to the main product, 15% as to the by-product and 5% as
to the process loss. The material put in process (5,000 units) cost Rs. 23,75 per unit and all other
10.36
Separate
Expenses
BOMEX
BRUCIL
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
1,00,000
6,000
4,000
Labour
50,000
20,000
18,000
Overheads
30,000
10,000
6,000
98
34
98
34
Units
Units
Materials
(ii)
The product-wise and overall profitability of the factory for April 1990.
BOMEX
BRUCIL
12,000
8,000
10.37
1,48,000
CHAPTER 11
BASIC CONCEPTS AND FORMULAE
Basic Concepts
1.
Standard Costing : A technique which uses standards for costs and revenues for the
purposes of control through variance analysis.
2.
3.
Standard Time : The total time in which task should be completed at standard
performance.
4.
5.
Variance Analysis : The analysis of variances arising in standard costing system into
their constituent parts.
6.
Revision Variance : It is the difference between the original standard cost and the
revised standard cost of actual production.
7.
8.
9.
Estimated Cost : An estimate of what the cost is likely to be during a given period of
time.
10. Ideal Cost : A cost which should be incurred during a period under ideal conditions.
Basic Formulas
1.
Material Variance
1.1
Material costs variance = (Standard quantity x Standard Price) (Actual quantity x Actual
price)
MCV = (SQ SP) (AQ AP)
1.2 Material price variance = Actual quantity (Standard price Actual price)
MPV
= AQ (SP AP)
1.3 Material usage variance = Standard price (Standard quantity Actual quantity)
MUV
= SP (SQ AQ)
Cost Accounting
Check:
1.4 Material cost variance = Material usage variance + Material price variance
MCV
= MUV + MPV
= (RSQ AQ) SP
Where
Revised standard quantity =
Standard quantity of one material
Total of actual quantities of all materials
Total of standard quantitiets of all materials
1.6 Material revised usage variance = (Standard quantity Revised standard quantity)
Standard
price
MRUV
= (SQ RSQ) SP
1.7 Material yield variance = (Actual yield Standard yield) Standard output price
MYV
Check:
Material usage variance = Material mix variance + Material yield variance
MUV
= MMV + MYV
Or
1.8 Material usage variance = Material mix variance + Material revised usage variance
MUV
= MMV + MRUV
Note: Material revised usage variance is also known as material sub usage variance.
In each case there will be only one variance either material yield or material revised
usage variance.
2.
Labour Variance
2.1
Labour Cost variance = (Std. hours for actual output x Std. rate per hour) (Actual hours
x Actual rate per hour)
LCV
2.2 Labour rate variance = Actual time (Std. rate Actual rate)
LRV
= AH x (SR AR)
11.2
Standard Costing
2.3 Labour efficiency (or time) variance = Std. rate (Std. hours for actual output Actual
hours)
LEV
= SR x (SH AH)
Check:
2.4 Labour cost variance = Labour efficiency variance + Labour rate variance
LCV
= LEV + LRV
Classification of Labour Efficiency Variance
Labour efficiency variance is further divided into the following variances:
(i) Idle time variance
(ii) Labour mix variance
(iii) Labour yield variance (or Labour revised-efficiency variance)
2.5 Idle time variance = Idle hours x Standard rate
ITV
= IH x SR
2.6
Labour mix variance = (Revised std. hours Actual hours) x Standard rate
LMV
= (RSH AH) x SR
2.7 Labour revised efficiency variance = (Std. hours for actual outputRevised std. hours)
x Standard rate
LREV
= (SH RSH) x SR
2.8 Labour yield variance = (Actual yieldStd. yield from actual input) x Std. labour cost per
unit of output
LYV
= (AY SY) x SLC
Check:
Labour efficiency variance = Idle time variance+Labour mix variance + Labour yield variance
(or lobour revised efficiency variance)
LEV
= ITV + LMV + LYV (or LREV)
3. Overhead Variance
Basic terms used in the computation of overhead variance
Standard overhead rate (per hour) = Budgeted overhead
Budgeted hours
Or
Standard overhead rate (per unit) = Budgeted Overhead
Budgeted output in units
Note: Separate overhead rates will be computed for fixed and variable overheads.
Basic calculations before the computation of overhead variances:
11.3
Cost Accounting
The following basic calculation should be made before computing variances.
(i)
(c)
Standard overhead = Std. output for actual time Std. overhead rate per unit
(d)
(e)
11.4
Standard Costing
3.3
Check:
V. O. cost variance = V.O. expenditure variance + V. O. efficiency variance
Fixed Overhead (FO) Variances
3.4
3.5
3.6
Check:
F.O. cost variance = F.O. expenditure variance + F.O. volume variance
Fixed overhead volume variance is further divided into the following variances:
(a) Efficiency variance
(b) Capacity variance
(c) Calendar variance
3.7
3.8
3.9
Calendar variance = (Actual No. of working days Std. No. of working days) Std. fixed
rate per day
Or
Where,
Revised budgeted hours = Budgeted hours Actual days
Budgeted days
Note: When calendar variance is computed, there will be a modification in the capacity variance. In
that case revised capacity variance will be calculated and the formula is:
11.5
Cost Accounting
Revised capacity variance = (Actual hours Revised budgeted hours) Std. fixed rate per hour
Check:
F. O. volume variance = Efficiency Variance + Capacity variance + Calendar variance
4
Ratio Analyses
Budgeted hours
100
Maximum possible No. of working hours in budget period
Question 1
Calculate Efficiency and Capacity ratio from the following figures:
Budgeted production
80 units
Actual production
60 units
8 hours
500
Answer
Efficiency Ratio =
Or
480
100 96%
500
11.6
Standard Costing
Capacity Ratio =
Or
500
100 78.12%
640
Question 2
KPR Limited operates a system of standard costing in respect of one of its products which is
manufactured within a single cost centre. The Standard Cost Card of a product is as under:
Standard
Direct material
21.00
Direct labour
9.00
Factory overhead
3.60
33.60
The production schedule for the month of June, 2007 required completion of 40,000 units.
However, 40,960 units were completed during the month without opening and closing work-inprocess inventories.
Purchases during the month of June, 2007, 2,25,000 kgs of material at the rate of Rs. 4.50 per kg.
Production and Sales records for the month showed the following actual results.
Material used 2,05,600 kgs.
Direct labour 1,21,200 hours; cost incurred
Rs. 3,87,840
Rs. 1,00,000
Sales
40,000 units
(ii) Calculate labour variances and the total variance for factory overhead.
(iii) Prepare Income statement for June, 2007 showing actual gross margin.
(iv) An incentive scheme is in operation in the company whereby employees are paid a
bonus of 50% of direct labour hour saved at standard direct labour hour rate. Calculate
the Bonus amount.
11.7
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
Material variances:
(a) Direct material cost variance
= AQ (SP AP)
= 2,05,600 (4.20 4.50) = 61,680 (A)
= SP (SQ AQ)
= 4.20 (40,960 5 2,05,600) = 3,360 (A)
= AH (SR AR)
= 24,240 (A)
Rs.
Direct material
21
Direct labour
Factory overhead
3.60
Factory cost
33.60
8.40
Selling price
42.00
11.8
Standard Costing
Income statement
Rs.
Sales 40,000 units 42
16,80,000
13,44,000
3,36,000
61,680
3,360
24,240
89,280
2,46,720
5,040
Factory overhead
47,456
52,496
2,99,216
Rs.
1,22,880
1,21,200
1,680
Question 3
TQM Ltd. has furnished the following information for the month ending 30th June, 2007:
Master Budget
Units produced and sold
Sales (Rs.)
Direct material (Rs.)
Direct wages (Rs.)
11.9
Actual
Variance
80,000
72,000
3,20,000
2,80,000
40,000 (A)
80,000
73,600
6,400 (F)
1,20,000
1,04,800
15,200 (F)
Cost Accounting
40,000
37,600
2,400 (F)
40,000
39,200
800 (F)
2,80,000
2,55,200
Total Cost
The Standard costs of the products are as follows:
Per unit
(Rs.)
Direct materials (1 kg. at the rate of Re. 1 per kg.)
1.00
1.50
Prepare Flexible budget for the month and compare with actual results.
(ii) Calculate material, labour, sales price, variable overhead and fixed overhead expenditure
variances and sales volume (profit) variance.
Answer
(i)
A.
Sales
B.
Direct material
C.
Direct wages
D.
Actual for
72,000
units
Variance
72,000
units
3,20,000
4.00
2,88,000
2,80,000
8,000 (A)
80,000
1.00
72,000
73,600
1,600 (A)
1,20,000
1.50
1,08,000
1,04,800
3,200 (F)
Variable overhead
40,000
0.50
36,000
37,600
1,600 (A)
E.
2,40,000
3.00
2,16,000
2,16,000
F.
Contribution
80,000
1.00
72,000
64,000
G.
Fixed overhead
40,000
0.50
40,000
39,200
800 (F)
H.
Net profit
40,000
0.50
32,000
24,800
7,200 (A)
11.10
Standard Costing
(ii) Variances:
Sales price variance
Variable Overhead
11.11
Cost Accounting
Question 4
UV Ltd. presents the following information for November, 2008:
Budgeted production of product P = 200 units.
Standard consumption of Raw materials = 2 kg. per unit of P.
Standard price of material A = Rs. 6 per kg.
Actually, 250 units of P were produced and material A was purchased at Rs. 8 per kg and
consumed at 1.8 kg per unit of P. Calculate the material cost variances.
Answer
Actual production of P
= 250 units
= 6 Rs. (SP)
= 8 Rs. (AP)
11.12
Standard Costing
EXERCISE
Question 1 The following standards have been set to manufacture a product:
Rs.
Direct materials:
2.5 units of X at Rs. 4 per unit
3 units of Y at Rs. 3 per unit
15 units of Z at Re. 1 per unit
8.00
9.00
15.00
32.00
24.00
Direct labour 3 hours @ Rs. 8 per hour
56.00
Total standard prime cost
The company manufactured and sold 6,000 units of the product during the year 2006.
Direct material costs were as follows:
12,500 units of X at Rs. 4.40 per unit.
18,000 units of Y at Rs. 2.80 per unit.
88,500 units of Z at Rs. 1.20 per unit.
The company worked 17,500 direct labour hours during the year 2006. For 2,500 of
these hours the company paid at Rs. 12 per hour while for the remaining hours the
wages were paid at the standard rate.
Compute material price, usage variances, labour rate, and efficiency variances.
Answer
Material price variance
Usage variance
Labour rate variance
Efficiency variance
19,100
11,500
10,000
4,000
A
F
A
F
1,000 hours
Re. 0.50
900 hours
Rs. 360
Compute
(i)
Rate variance
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
Rate variance
90 (F)
(ii)
Efficiency variance
50 (F)
140(F)
100 kg
Price of materials:
Actual
Output:
2,10,000 kg
Material used:
2,80,000 kg
Cost of material:
Rs. 2,52,000
Calculate
a.
b.
c.
a.
b.
c.
Answer
11.14
CHAPTER 12
Basic Concepts
1.
2.
Absorption Costing: a method of costing by which all direct cost and applicable overheads
are charged to products or cost centers for finding out the total cost of production. Absorbed
cost includes production cost as well as administrative and other cost.
Break even chart: A mathematical or graphical representation, showing approximate profit
or loss of an enterprise at different levels of activity within a limited range.
3.
Break Even Point: This is the level of activity there is neither a profit nor a loss.
4.
Cash Break Even Point: It is the level of activity where there is neither a cash profit nor a
cash loss.
Cost Breakeven Point: It is the level of activity where the total cost under two alternatives
are the same. It is also known as Cost indifference point.
5.
6.
7.
Direct Costing: This is a principle under which all costs which are directed related are
charged to products, processes, operations or services, of which they form an integral part.
Marginal contribution: This is the difference between selling price and variable cost of
production.
8.
9.
Marginal Cost: This is the variable cost of one unit of product or a service.
10.
Marginal Costing: It is a principle whereby variable cost are charged to cost units and fixed
cost attributable to the relevant period is written off in full against contribution for that period.
Profit Volume Chart: It is a diagram showing the expected relationship between costs,
revenue at various volumes with profit being the residual.
11.
12.
Profit Volume ratio: It is the ratio establishing the relationship between the contribution and
the sales value.
13.
Margin of Safety: This is the difference between the expected level of sales and the break
even sales
Cost Accounting
Basic Formulas
1. *S V = F + P
By multiplying and dividing L.H.S. by S
2.
S(S V)
S
F P
S V
3.
( P/V Ratio
4.
5.
BES
6.
P/V Ratio =
P/V Ratio
F
7.
8.
P/V Ratio
11.
BES
S P/V Ratio = Contribution (Refer to iii)
9.
10.
Contribution
Sales
(BES + MS) P/V Ratio = contribution (Total sales = BES + MS)
(BES P/V Ratio) + (MS P/V Ratio) = F + P
By deducting (BES P/V Ratio) from L.H.S. and F from R.H.S. in x we get :
***M.S. P/V Ratio = P
Change in profit
12.
P/V Ratio =
13.
P/V Ratio =
14.
Profitability =
15.
16.
17.
Change in sales
Change in contribution
Change in sales
Contribution
Key factor
Total sales
* S = Sales, V= Variable Cost, F= Fixed Cost, P= Profit
** BES = Break Even Sales, P/V Ratio = Profit Volume Ratio
***M.S = Margin of Safety
12.2
Marginal Costing
Question 1
A company produces single product which sells for Rs. 20 per unit. Variable cost is Rs. 15 per
unit and Fixed overhead for the year is Rs. 6,30,000.
Required:
(a)
(b)
Calculate sales price per unit to bring BEP down to 1,20,000 units.
6,30,000
2,10,000 units
3
(c)
M S Sales
F
6,30,000
S 15
Rs. 20.25.
New BEP
1,20,000
Profit
60,000
C
where P/ V 100.
P/ V ratio
P/ V
S
60,000
5
100 2,40,000 Or
100 25%.
25
20
Question 2
Explain and illustrate cash break-even chart.
12.3
Cost Accounting
Answer
In cash break-even chart, only cash fixed costs are considered. Non-cash items like
depreciation etc. are excluded from the fixed cost for computation of break-even point. It
depicts the level of output or sales at which the sales revenue will equal to total cash outflow.
It is computed as under:
Cash BEP (Units)
Hence for example suppose insurance has been paid on 1st January, 2006 till 31st December,
2010 then this fixed cost will not be considered as a cash fixed cost for the period 1st January,
2008 to 31st December, 2009.
Question 3
A company has fixed cost of Rs. 90,000, Sales Rs. 3,00,000 and Profit of Rs. 60,000.
Required:
(i)
Sales volume if in the next period, the company suffered a loss of Rs. 30,000.
(ii)
Answer
P/V ratio
Contribution
100
Sales
1,50,000
100 50%
3,00,000
(i)
Marginal Costing
= Rs. 90,000 Rs. 30,000 (as it is a loss)
= Rs. 60,000.
Then Sales =
Contribution 60,000
or
Rs. 1,20,000.
P/V ratio
.50
Margin of safety
Profit
90,000
or
Rs. 1,80,000.
PV ratio
.50
Fixed Cost
90,000
= Rs. 1,80,000
PV Ratio
.5
90,000 90,000
.5
1,80,000
.5
= Rs. 3,60,000.
Margin of Safety
Question 4
ABC Ltd. can produce 4,00,000 units of a product per annum at 100% capacity. The variable
production costs are Rs. 40 per unit and the variable selling expenses are Rs. 12 per sold unit.
The budgeted fixed production expenses were Rs. 24,00,000 per annum and the fixed selling
expenses were Rs. 16,00,000. During the year ended 31st March, 2008, the company worked
at 80% of its capacity. The operating data for the year are as follows:
Production
3,20,000 units
3,10,000 units
40,000 units
12.5
Cost Accounting
Fixed production expenses are absorbed on the basis of capacity and fixed selling expenses
are recovered on the basis of period.
You are required to prepare Statements of Cost and Profit for the year ending 31st March,
2008:
(i)
(ii)
Answer
(i)
Amount
Amount
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
2,48,00,000
1,28,00,000
16,00,000
1,44,00,000
20,00,000
1,24,00,000
37,20,000
1,61,20,000
86,80,000
24,00,000
16,00,000
40,00,000
46,80,000
12.6
Marginal Costing
(ii)
Amount
(Rs.)
Amount
(Rs.)
2,48,00,000
1,28,00,000
19,20,000
1,47,20,000
1,47,20,000
3,20,000
18,40,000
1,65,60,000
1,47,20,000
3,20,000
23,00,000
1,42,60,000
Selling expenses:
Variable: Rs. 12 3,10,000 units
37,20,000
Fixed
16,00,000
Unadjusted profit
1,95,80,000
52,20,000
4,80,000
47,40,000
Rs. 24,00,000
Rs. 6 per unit.
4,00,000 units
1.
2.
12.7
Cost Accounting
Question 5
PQ Ltd. reports the following cost structure at two capacity levels:
(100% capacity)
2,000 units
1,500 units
Production overhead I
Production overhead II
If the selling price, reduced by direct material and labour is Rs. 8 per unit, what would be its
break-even point?
Answer
Computation of Break-even point in units:
2,000 units
1,500 units
6,000
6,000
Fixed cost
6,000
1,000 units
Contribution per unit
6
12.8
Marginal Costing
EXERCISE
Question 1 TAJ Ltd. manufactures a single product, MAHAL. The following figures relate to
MAHAL for a one-year period:
Activity Level
Sales and production (units)
50%
400
Rs. lakhs
8.00
100%
800
Rs. lakhs
16.00
Sales
Production costs:
Variable
3.20
6.40
Fixed
1.60
1.60
Selling and administration costs:
Variable
1.60
3.20
Fixed
2.40
2.40
The normal level of activity for the year is 800 units. Fixed costs are incurred
evenly throughout the year, and actual fixed costs are the same as budgeted. There
were no stocks of MAHAL at the beginning of the year.
In the first quarter, 220 units were produced and 160 units were sold.
Required:
(a) What would be the fixed production costs absorbed by MAHAL, if absorption
costing is used?
(b) What would be the under/over-recovery of overheads during the period?
(c) What would be the profit using absorption costing?
(d) What would be the profit using marginal costing?
Answer
a.
Rs. 44000
b.
Rs. 4000
c.
Rs. 40,000
d.
Rs. 28000
Question 2 You are given the following data for the year 2007 of Rio Co. Ltd:
Variable cost
60,000
60%
Fixed cost
30,000
30%
Net profit
10,000
10%
1,00,000
100%
Sales
Find out (a) Break-even point, (b) P/V ratio, and (c) Margin of safety. Also draw a breakeven chart showing contribution and profit.
12.9
Cost Accounting
Answer
a. Rs. 75000
b. 40%
c. Rs. 25,000
Question 3 An Automobile manufacturing company Bharti produces different models of cars.
The budget in respect of model 1000 for the month of September, 2006 is as under:
Budgeted output
40,000 units
Variable Costs:
Materials
(Rs. Lakhs)
264
Labour
52
Direct expenses
440
124
Fixed costs:
Specific fixed costs
90.00
112.50
202.50
Total costs
642.50
Add: Profit
57.50
Sales
Calculate:
700.00
(i)
Profit with 10% increase in selling price with a 10% reduction in sales volume.
(ii) Volume to be achieved to maintain the original profit after a 10% rise in material
costs, at the originally budgeted selling price per unit.
Answer
(i) 94.50 lakhs
(ii) 44521 units
12.10
CHAPTER 13
2.
Budget Centre: A section of an organization for which separate budget can be prepared and
control exercised.
3.
Budgetary Control: Guiding and regulating activities with a view to attaining predetermined
objectives, effectively and efficiently.
4.
Budget Manual: The Budget manual is a schedule, document or booklet which shows, in
written forms the budgeting organisation and procedures.
5.
Budget Period: The period of time for which a budget is prepared and used. It may be a
year, quarter or a month.
6.
Physical budgets
Those budgets which contain information in terms of physical units about
sales, production etc. for example, quantity of sales, quantity of production,
inventories, and manpower budgets are physical budgets.
2.
Cost budgets
Budgets which provide cost information in respect of manufacturing, selling,
administration etc. for example, manufacturing costs, selling costs,
administration cost, and research and development cost budgets are cost
budgets.
3.
Profit budgets
A budget which enables in the ascertainment of profit, for example, sales
budget, profit and loss budget, etc.
4.
Financial budgets
A budget which facilitates in ascertaining the financial position of a concern, for
example, cash budgets, capital expenditure budget, budgeted balance sheet etc.
Cost Accounting
7.
8.
Functional budgets - Budgets which relate to the individual functions in an organisation are
known as Functional Budgets. For example, purchase budget; sales budget; production
budget; plant-utilisation budget and cash budget.
9.
10.
Long-term budgets - The budgets which are prepared for periods longer than a year are
called long-term budgets. Such budgets are helpful in business forecasting and forward
planning. Capital expenditure budget and Research and Development budget are examples
of long-term budgets.
11. Short-term budgets - Budgets which are prepared for periods less than a year are
known as short-term budgets. Cash budget is an example of short-term budget.
Such types of budgets are prepared in cases where a specific action has to be
immediately taken to bring any variation under control, as in cash budgets.
12. Basic budgets - A budget which remains unaltered over a long period of time is
called basic budget.
13. Current budgets - A budget which is established for use over a short period of time
and is related to the current conditions is called current budget.
14. Fixed budget
According to Chartered Institute of Management Accountants of England, a fixed
budget, is a budget designed to remain unchanged irrespective of the level of
activity actually attained.
15. Flexible budget According to Chartered Institute of Management Accountants of England, a flexible budget
is defined as a budget which, by recognizing the difference between fixed, semi-variable and
variable costs is designed to change in relation to the level of activity attained.
Question 1
Explain briefly the concept of flexible budget.
Answer
Flexible Budget: A flexible budget is defined as a budget which, by recognizing the
difference between fixed, semi-variable and variable cost is designed to change in relation to
the level of activity attained. A fixed budget, on the other hand is a budget which is designed
to remain unchanged irrespective of the level of activity actually attained. In a fixed budgetary
control, budgets are prepared for one level of activity whereas in a flexibility budgetary control
13.2
Actual
Variance
80,000
72,000
3,20,000
2,80,000
40,000 (A)
80,000
73,600
6,400 (F)
1,20,000
1,04,800
15,200 (F)
40,000
37,600
2,400 (F)
40,000
39,200
800 (F)
2,80,000
2,55,200
Sales (Rs.)
Direct material (Rs.)
Direct wages (Rs.)
Total Cost
1.00
1.50
0.50
Actual results for the month showed that 78,400 kg. of material were used and 70,400 labour
hours were recorded.
Required:
(i)
Prepare Flexible budget for the month and compare with actual results.
(ii) Calculate material, labour, sales price, variable overhead and fixed overhead expenditure
variances and sales volume (profit) variance.
13.3
Cost Accounting
Answer
(i)
Per unit
A.
Sales
B.
Direct material
C.
Direct wages
D.
Actual for
72,000
units
Variance
72,000
units
3,20,000
4.00
2,88,000
2,80,000
8,000 (A)
80,000
1.00
72,000
73,600
1,600 (A)
1,20,000
1.50
1,08,000
1,04,800
3,200 (F)
Variable overhead
40,000
0.50
36,000
37,600
1,600 (A)
E.
2,40,000
3.00
2,16,000
2,16,000
F.
Contribution
80,000
1.00
72,000
64,000
G.
Fixed overhead
40,000
0.50
40,000
39,200
800 (F)
40,000
0.50
32,000
24,800
7,200 (A)
H. Net profit
(ii) Variances:
Sales price variance
13.4
Variance
= 1.5 (72,000 70,400) = 2,400 (F)
Variable Overhead
13.5
Cost Accounting
EXERCISE
Question 1 A factory is currently running at 50% capacity and produces 5,000 units at a cost
of Rs. 900 per unit as per details below:
Rs.
Material
500
Labour
150
Factory overheads
Administrative overheads
The current selling price is Rs. 1,000 per unit. At 70% working, material cost per unit
increases by 2% and selling price per unit falls by 2%.
Estimate profits of the factory at 70% working by preparing a flexible budget.
Answer Rs. 7,10,000
Question 2 Vivek Elementary School has a total of 150 students consisting of 5 sections with
30 students per section. The school plans for a picnic around the city during the week-end to
places such as the zoo, the Niko Park, the planetarium etc. A private transport operator has
come forward to lease out the buses for taking the students. Each bus will have a maximum
capacity of 50 (excluding 2 seats reserved for the teachers accompanying the students). The
school will employ two teachers for each bus, paying them an allowance of Rs. 50 per teacher.
It will also lease out the required number of buses. The following are the other cost estimates:
Cost per student
Breakfast
Rs. 5
Lunch
10
Tea
13.6
63.33 55.00
Upto 50
52
13.7
43.33 44.17
51100
84
39.33
101150
116